HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC
424B3, 1998-08-27
SURGICAL & MEDICAL INSTRUMENTS & APPARATUS
Previous: RIVER HOLDING CORP, 424B3, 1998-08-27
Next: COMMERCIAL MORTGAGE PASS THROUGH CERT SERIES 1998 GL II, 8-K, 1998-08-27



<PAGE>
 
                                                FILED PURSUANT TO RULE 424(b)(3)
                                                      REGISTRATION NO. 333-56097

PROSPECTUS

                          Hudson Respiratory Care Inc.

                             Offer to Exchange its
                  9 1/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008,
             which have been registered under the Securities Act,
                      for any and all of its outstanding
                   9 1/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008

  The Exchange Offer (as defined below) will expire at 5:00 P.M., New York City
time, on September 25, 1998, unless extended.

                              ----------------
            
  Hudson Respiratory Care Inc. (the "Company") hereby offers, upon the terms and
subject to the conditions set forth in this Prospectus (the "Prospectus") and
the accompanying Letter of Transmittal (the "Letter of Transmittal" and together
with this Prospectus, the "Exchange Offer"), to exchange $1,000 principal amount
of its 9 1/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Exchange Notes") which
have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
"Securities Act"), pursuant to a Registration Statement on Form S-4 (together
with all amendments thereto, the "Registration Statement") of which this
Prospectus is a part, for each $1,000 principal amount of its outstanding 9 1/8%
Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Notes"), of which $115,000,000
principal amount is outstanding as of the date hereof.    

  The Company will accept for exchange any and all validly tendered Notes prior
to 5:00 P.M., New York City time, on September 25, 1998, unless extended (the
"Expiration Date").  Notes may be tendered only in integral multiples of $1,000.
Tenders of Notes may be withdrawn at any time prior to 5:00 P.M., New York City
time, on the Expiration Date.  The Exchange Offer is not conditioned upon any
minimum principal amount of Notes being tendered for exchange.  However, the
Exchange Offer is subject to certain customary conditions.  In the event the
Company terminates the Exchange Offer and does not accept for exchange any
Notes, the Company will promptly return the Notes to the holders thereof.  The
Company will not receive any proceeds from the Exchange Offer.  See "The
Exchange Offer."

  The Exchange Notes will be obligations of the Company evidencing the same debt
as the Notes, and will be entitled to the benefits of the same indenture (the
"Indenture").  See "Description of Exchange Notes".  The form and terms of the
Exchange Notes are the same as the form and terms of the Notes in all material
respects except that the Exchange Notes have been registered under the
Securities Act and hence do not include certain rights to registration
thereunder and do not contain transfer restrictions or terms with respect to the
special interest payments applicable to the Notes.  The Notes were issued on
April 7, 1998 pursuant to an offering exempt from registration under the
Securities Act.  See "The Exchange Offer".

                                                   (Continued on following page)


  THIS PROSPECTUS AND THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL ARE FIRST BEING MAILED TO
HOLDERS OF THE NOTES ON AUGUST 26, 1998.

     
  SEE "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE 11 FOR INFORMATION THAT SHOULD BE CONSIDERED IN
CONNECTION WITH THIS EXCHANGE OFFER.    

                              ----------------

    THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
       AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS
         THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
            COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
                PROSPECTUS.  ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY
                             IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
                              ----------------

                THE DATE OF THIS PROSPECTUS IS AUGUST 26, 1998.
<PAGE>
 
(Continuation of cover page)
         
     The Exchange Notes are being offered hereunder in order to satisfy certain
obligations of the Company under the Registration Agreement, dated as of April
7, 1998 (the "Exchange Offer Registration Agreement"), by and among the Company,
River Holding Corp. ("Holding") and Salomon Brothers Inc and BT Alex. Brown 
Incorporated (the "Initial Purchasers"), a copy of which has been filed as an
exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part. The
Exchange Offer is intended to satisfy the Company's obligations under the
Exchange Offer Registration Agreement to register the Notes under the Securities
Act. Once the Exchange Offer is consummated, the Company will have no further
obligations to register any of the Notes not tendered by the holders of the
Notes (the "Holders") for exchange. See "Risk Factors--Consequences to Non-
Tendering Holders of Notes".     
         
     Based on interpretations by the staff of the Securities and Exchange
Commission (the "Commission") set forth in several no-action letters to third
parties, the Company believes that the Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the
Exchange Offer in exchange for Notes may be offered for resale, resold and
otherwise transferred by holders thereof without compliance with the
registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act.  However,
any Holder who is an "affiliate" of the Company or who intended to participate
in the Exchange Offer for the purpose of distributing the Exchange Notes (i)
cannot rely on the interpretation by the staff of the Commission set forth in
the above referenced no-action letters, (ii) cannot tender its Notes in the
Exchange Offer, and (iii) must comply with the registration and prospectus
delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any sale or
transfer of the Notes, unless such sale or transfer is made pursuant to an
exemption from such requirements.  See "Risk Factors--Consequences to Non-
Tendering Holders of Notes".  In addition, each broker-dealer that receives
Exchange Notes for its own account pursuant to the Exchange Offer must
acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of
such Exchange Notes.  The Letter of Transmittal states that by so acknowledging
and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that
it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.  This
Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used
by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of Exchange Notes received in
exchange for Notes where such Exchange Notes were acquired by such broker-dealer
as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities. The Company
and Holding have agreed that for the 180-day period following consummation of
the Exchange Offer they will make this Prospectus available to any broker-dealer
for use in connection with any such resale. Each broker-dealer that receives
Exchange Notes for its own account in exchange for Notes, where such Notes were
acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other
trading activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes. See "Plan of Distribution."
EXCEPT AS DESCRIBED IN THIS PARAGRAPH, THIS PROSPECTUS MAY NOT BE USED FOR AN
OFFER TO RESELL, RESALE OR OTHER TRANSFER OF EXCHANGE NOTES.     
         
     Notes were initially represented by one Note (the "Global Note") in
fully registered form, registered in the name of a nominee of The Depository
Trust Company ("DTC"), as depository.  The Exchange Notes exchanged for Notes
represented by the Global Note may be initially represented by one or more
global securities ("Global Exchange Note") in fully registered form, each
registered in the name of the nominee of DTC.  The Global Exchange Note will be
exchangeable for Exchange Notes in registered form, in denominations of $1,000
and integral multiples thereof as described herein.  The Exchange Notes in
global form will trade in The Depository Trust Company's Same-Day Funds
Settlement System, and secondary market trading activity in such Exchange Notes
will therefore settle in immediately available funds.  See "Description of
Exchange Notes--Form, Denomination and Book-Entry Procedures".     

     The Exchange Notes will bear interest at a rate equal to 9 1/8% per annum
from their date of issuance. Interest on the Exchange Notes is payable semi-
annually on April 15 and October 15 of each year, commencing October 15, 1998.
Holders whose Notes are accepted for exchange will receive, in cash, accrued
interest thereon to, but not including, the date of issuance of the Exchange
Notes. Such interest will be paid with the first interest payment on the
Exchange Notes. Interest on the Notes accepted for exchange will cease to accrue
interest upon cancellation of the Notes and issuance of the Exchange Notes.

                                                   (Continued on following page)


                                       i
<PAGE>
 
(Continuation of cover page)

    
     The Exchange Notes will be redeemable at the option of the Company, in
whole or in part, on or after April 15, 2003 at the redemption prices set forth
herein, plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the date of redemption. In
addition, prior to April 15, 2001, up to 35% of the aggregate principal amount
of the Exchange Notes originally issued may be redeemed at the option of the
Company, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time, at 109 1/8% of
the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the
date of redemption, with the net proceeds of one or more underwritten public 
offerings of common stock of the Company pursuant to an effective registration 
statement under the Securities Act (a "Public Equity Offering"), provided that
at least 65% of the aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes originally
issued remains outstanding immediately after such redemption. In the event of a
Change of Control (as defined at page 72), the Company will be required to make
an offer to repurchase all or any part of each holder's Exchange Notes at a cash
purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and
unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase. See "Description of the
Exchange Notes."     
    
     The Exchange Notes will be general unsecured obligations of the Company,
subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future Senior Debt (as
defined at page 83) of the Company. The Exchange Notes will rank pari passu with
any future Senior Subordinated Debt (as defined at page 83) of the Company and
senior to any future Subordinated Obligations (as defined at page 83) of the
Company. The Exchange Notes will also be effectively subordinated in right of
payment to all existing and future secured indebtedness of the Company to the
extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness, including the
Company's obligations under the Company's credit agreement (the "New Credit
Facility") which are secured by substantially all of the assets of the Company
and a pledge of 65% of the stock of Industrias Hudson, S.A. de C.V., the
Company's principal subsidiary ("Industrias Hudson"). The Exchange Notes will
also be effectively subordinated in right of payment to all obligations of
subsidiaries of the Company which do not guarantee the Exchange Notes, including
Industrias Hudson. The New Credit Facility is unconditionally guaranteed by
Holding, as well as any future domestic and, to the extent no negative tax
consequences would result, foreign, subsidiaries of the Company. The Exchange
Notes will be guaranteed on a senior subordinated basis by any of the Company's
subsidiaries which guarantees the New Credit Facility. As of June 26, 1998, the
Company had $38.0 million of Senior Debt, all of which represented secured
indebtedness under the New Credit Facility. The Company also had $60.0 million
of undrawn commitments available under the New Credit Facility, which when drawn
would constitute Senior Debt. The Company does not have any outstanding
Subordinated Obligations.    

     Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Notes.
Following completion of the Exchange Offer, the Company does not intend to list
the Exchange Notes on a national securities exchange or to seek approval for
quotation through the Nasdaq National Market.  The Initial Purchasers have
informed the Company that they currently intend to make a market in the Exchange
Notes.  However, the Initial Purchasers are not obligated to do so and any such
market making may be discontinued at any time without notice.  Therefore, no
assurance can be given as to whether an active trading market will develop or be
maintained for the Exchange Notes.  As the Notes were issued and the Exchange
Notes are being issued to a limited number of institutions who typically hold
similar securities for investment, the Company does not expect that an active
public market for the Exchange Notes will develop.  In addition, resales by
certain holders of the Notes or the Exchange Notes of a substantial percentage
of the aggregate principal amount of such notes could constrain the ability of
any market maker to develop or maintain a market for the Exchange Notes.  To the
extent that a market for the Exchange Notes should develop, the market value of
the Exchange Notes will depend on prevailing interest rates, the market for
similar securities and other factors, including the financial condition,
performance and prospects of the Company.  Such factors might cause the Exchange
Notes to trade at a discount from face value.  See "Risk Factors--Lack of Public
Market for the Exchange Notes".  The Company has agreed to pay the expenses of
the Exchange Offer.

     THIS PROSPECTUS DESCRIBES CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE WHICH ARE NOT
PRESENTED HEREIN OR DELIVERED HEREWITH.  THESE DOCUMENTS ARE AVAILABLE UPON
REQUEST FROM JAY R. OGRAM, CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER AND SECRETARY, HUDSON
RESPIRATORY CARE INC., 27711 DIAZ ROAD, P.O. BOX 9020, TEMECULA, CALIFORNIA
92589, TELEPHONE NUMBER (909) 676-5611.

                                                   (Continued on following page)
                                      ii
<PAGE>
 
(Continuation of cover page)


                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION

   
     The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement under
the Securities Act for the registration of the Exchange Notes offered hereby. As
permitted by the rules and regulations of the Commission, this Prospectus does
not contain all of the information set forth in the Registration Statement and
the exhibits and schedules thereto. For further information with respect to the
Company and the Exchange Notes offered hereby, reference is made to the
Registration Statement and to the exhibits and schedules filed therewith.
Statements contained in this Prospectus concerning the contents of any contract
or other document are not necessarily complete. With respect to each such
contract or other document filed with the Commission as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement, reference is made to the exhibit for a more complete
description of the matter involved, and each such statement shall be deemed
qualified in its entirety by such reference.    

     Upon consummation of the Exchange Offer, the Company will be subject to the
informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended,
and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder (the "Exchange Act") for a
period following the effectiveness of the Registration Statement.  The
Registration Statement, the exhibits and schedules forming a part thereof and
the reports and other information filed by the Company with the Commission in
accordance with the Exchange Act may be inspected and copied at the public
reference facilities maintained by the Commission at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza,
450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549 and will also be available for
inspection and copying at the regional offices of the Commission located at 7
World Trade Center, 13th Floor, New York, New York 10048 and at Northwestern
Atrium Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661.
Copies of such material may also be obtained upon written request from the
Public Reference Section of the Commission at 450 Fifth Street, N.W.,
Washington, D.C. 20549 at prescribed rates.  The Commission also maintains a
World Wide Web site (http://www.sec.gov) that contains reports, proxy and other
information regarding registrants that file electronically with the SEC.  While
any Notes remain outstanding, the Company will make available, upon request, to
any holder and any prospective purchaser of the Notes the information required
by Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act during any period in which the
Company is not subject to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act.  Any such
request should be mailed to Hudson Respiratory Care Inc., 27711 Diaz Road, P.O.
Box 9020, Temecula, California 92589.  Telephone requests may be directed to the
Corporate Secretary at (909) 676-5611.
    
     The Indenture provides that, whether or not this Registration Statement is
effective, the Company will file with the Commission the periodic reports and
such other information, documents and other reports as are specified in Section
13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act, whether or not the Company is subject
to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act.  The Company will also, upon
request, provide the Trustee (as defined herein) and the holders of the Exchange
Notes with such information, documents and other reports. If filing such
information, documents or other reports with the Commission is not permitted by
the Exchange Act, the Company will not be so obligated to file such information,
documents or other reports.     

                                      iii
<PAGE>
 
                                    SUMMARY
   
     The following is a summary of certain information contained elsewhere in
this Prospectus.  Reference is made to, and this summary is qualified in its
entirety by, the more detailed information and financial statements, including
the notes thereto, contained elsewhere in this Prospectus.  As used herein and
unless the context requires otherwise, "Hudson RCI" or the "Company" means
Hudson Respiratory Care Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries.  All references
to a fiscal year of the Company refer to a year ending on the last Friday in
December for a stated year (e.g. "fiscal 1997" or "1997" refers to the year
ended December 26, 1997).  Unless otherwise indicated, all references to non-
financial data are as of August 1, 1998.    

                                  THE COMPANY
       
     The Company is a leading manufacturer and marketer of disposable medical
products utilized in the respiratory care and anesthesia segments of the
domestic and international health care markets. In the United States, the
Company markets its products to a variety of health care providers, including
hospitals and alternate site service providers such as outpatient surgery
centers, long-term care facilities, physician offices and home health care
agencies. Internationally, the Company sells its products to distributors that
market to hospitals and other health care providers. For fiscal 1997, the
Company had net sales of $99.5 million, operating income of $12.6 million and
pro forma EBITDA before provision for the Company's Equity Participation Plan
and provision for retention payments ("EBITDA before EPP and Retention
Payments") of $26.3 million. From 1993 to 1997, the Company's net sales,
operating income and EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments increased at
compound annual rates of approximately 5.9%, 11.4% and 13.3%, respectively. See
footnote (f) to "--Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial Information of
Hudson Respiratory Care Inc." for information with respect to EBITDA before
EPP and Retention Payments.    
    
     The Company has supplied the disposable respiratory care market for over 50
years and enjoys strong brand name recognition and leading market positions. In
recent years the Company has pursued a number of growth initiatives, including
the expansion of its international and alternate site sales efforts and entry
into the anesthesia market. As a result of such initiatives, in 1997, anesthesia
sales represented approximately 6.5% of the Company's total net sales and
international and alternate site sales represented 19.1% and 14.7%, of the
Company's total net sales, respectively.    
    
     The Company offers one of the broadest respiratory care and anesthesia 
product lines in the industry, manufacturing and marketing over 1,000
respiratory care and anesthesia products. The Company believes that its broad
product offering represents a competitive advantage over suppliers with more
limited product offerings, as health care providers seek to reduce medical
supply costs and concentrate purchases among fewer vendors. The Company also
benefits competitively from its extensive relationships with leading group
purchasing organizations ("GPOs"), as large purchasing organizations play an
increasingly important role in hospitals' purchasing decisions.     
    
     See "Business--General" and "--Industry Overview."     
        
                                       1
<PAGE>
 
        
        
     The Company's senior management team has increased net sales and EBITDA
before EPP and Retention Payments by 5.9% and 13.3%, respectively, from 1993 to
1997 compounded annually, despite facing significant pricing pressure as a
result of cost containment trends affecting the health care industry generally.
These results are largely attributable to management's expertise within the
Company's markets and ability to grow the Company's business and improve
profitability margins within a dynamic health care environment. On average,
members of the senior management team have over 18 years of experience in the
health care industry. The senior management team intends to continue to expand
the Company's market position, increase cash flows and capitalize on favorable
demographic trends by pursuing the following initiatives: (i) enhancing market
position in the domestic hospital market, (ii) increasing penetration of the
anesthesia market, (iii) expanding internationally, (iv) increasing its presence
in the alternate site market and (v) developing new products. See "Business--
Business Strategy."              

                                       2
<PAGE>
 
    
      
                              THE RECAPITALIZATION
       
     On April 7, 1998, Hudson RCI consummated its recapitalization pursuant to
an Agreement and Plan of Merger (the "Recapitalization Agreement") pursuant to
which River Acquisition Corp., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Holding merged with
and into Hudson RCI, with Hudson RCI surviving as a majority-owned subsidiary of
Holding (the "Merger"). The Company engaged in the Recapitalization in order to
attract additional investors while allowing the Continuing Shareholder (as
defined below) to retain an equity interest in the Company.    

    Pursuant to the Recapitalization, Holding contributed approximately $93.0 
million in equity capital into Hudson RCI (the "Holding Equity Investment") and 
a shareholder of Hudson RCI (the "Continuing Shareholder") retained common stock
of Hudson RCI with a value of approximately $15.0 million (the "Rollover 
Equity"), based on the valuation of Hudson RCI used in the Recapitalization. In 
the Merger, a portion of the Hudson RCI common stock was converted into the 
right to receive approximately $131.1 million in cash, and management received
$68.3 million pursuant to the Company's Equity Participation Plan (the "Equity
Participation Plan"). Following the Holding Equity Investment, Holding owned
80.8% of the outstanding common stock of Hudson RCI and 100.0% of the 
outstanding preferred stock of Hudson RCI and the Continuing Shareholder owned
19.2% of the outstanding common stock of Hudson RCI.    

     The Holding Equity Investment was comprised of $63.0 million of common 
equity (the "Common Stock Investment") and $30.0 million of preferred equity 
(the "Preferred Stock Investment"). The Common Stock Investment was funded with
a $55.0 million investment by affiliates of Freeman Spogli & Co. Incorporated 
("FS&Co."), and an $8.0 million investment by management of Hudson RCI. The 
Preferred Stock Investment was funded with proceeds from the sale of 11 1/2% 
Senior Exchangeable PIK Preferred Stock due 2010 (the "Holding Preferred 
Stock") with an aggregate liquidation preference of $30.0 million offered by 
Holding (the "Preferred Stock Offering"). Immediately following consummation of 
the Recapitalization, FS&Co. beneficially owned approximately 87.3% of the 
outstanding common stock of Holding and management owned the remaining 
12.7%.     

     In connection with the Recapitalization and concurrently with the Preferred
Stock Offering, Hudson RCI offered $115.0 million aggregate principal amount of
9 1/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Subordinated Notes")(the
"Subordinated Notes Offering," and together with the Preferred Stock Offering,
the "Offerings").

     On April 7, 1998, Hudson RCI entered into an agreement (the "New Credit
Facility") providing for a $40.0 million secured term loan facility (the "Term
Loan Facility"), which was funded in connection with the consummation of the
Recapitalization, and a $60.0 million revolving loan facility (the "Revolving
Loan Facility") which will be available for Hudson RCI's future capital
requirements and to finance acquisitions.  See "Description of New Credit
Facility."

     The Offerings and the application of the net proceeds therefrom, repayment
of existing Hudson RCI debt payments to the Continuing Shareholder under the
Recapitalization Agreement and to management, the Holding Equity Investment and
the related borrowings under the New Credit Facility are collectively referred
to herein as the "Recapitalization."
   
     The following graphic presents the organizational structure of the Company
(a) before the Recapitalization and (b) after the Recapitalization:      
    
                 [ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE CHART APPEARS HERE]     
<TABLE>     

<S>                     <C>                     <C>                     <C>
Continuing                                      Holding
Shareholder                     Continuing 
                                Shareholder     
Hudson RCI                                      Hudson RCI
                                                                        IH Holding LLC
Industrias Hudson                               Industrias Hudson

Figure (a)                                      Figure (b)
</TABLE>    

                                  RISK FACTORS

     Holders of the Exchange Notes should consider carefully the information set
forth under the caption "Risk Factors" and all other information set forth in
this Prospectus in evaluating an investment in the Exchange Notes.

                                       3
<PAGE>
 
                          THE EXCHANGE NOTES OFFERING

Issuer................  Hudson Respiratory Care Inc.

Securities Offered....  $115,000,000 principal amount of 9 1/8% Senior
                        Subordinated Exchange Notes due 2008 (the "Exchange
                        Notes").

Maturity Date.........  April 15, 2008.

Interest Rate.........  The Exchange Notes will bear interest at the rate of 9
                        1/8% per annum.

Interest Payment 
Dates.................  Interest will accrue on the Exchange Notes from the
                        date of issuance (the "Issue Date") and will be payable
                        semi-annually on each April 15 and October 15,
                        commencing October 15, 1998.
        
Ranking...............  The Exchange Notes will be general unsecured obligations
                        of the Company, subordinated in right of payment to all
                        existing and future Senior Debt of the Company.  The
                        Exchange Notes will rank pari passu with any future
                        Senior Subordinated Debt of the Company and senior to
                        any future Subordinated Obligations of the Company
                        including the Company's 11 1/2% Subordinated Exchange
                        Debentures due 2010, which may be issued in exchange for
                        the Holding Preferred Stock. See "Description of Other
                        Securities--Company Exchange Debentures." The Exchange
                        Notes will also be effectively subordinated in right of
                        payment to all existing and future secured indebtedness
                        of the Company to the extent of the value of the assets
                        securing such indebtedness, including the Company's
                        obligations under the Company's New Credit Facility
                        which constitute Senior Debt and which also will be
                        secured by substantially all of the assets of the
                        Company (subject to certain exceptions), including a
                        pledge of 65% of the stock of Industrias Hudson. The New
                        Credit Facility will be unconditionally guaranteed by
                        Holding, as well as certain future domestic and, to the
                        extent no negative tax consequences would result,
                        foreign subsidiaries of the Company. The Exchange Notes
                        will be guaranteed on a senior subordinated basis by any
                        of the Company's subsidiaries which guarantees the New
                        Credit Facility (a "Subsidiary Guarantor"). The Exchange
                        Notes will also be effectively subordinated in right of
                        payment to all obligations constituting Senior Debt of
                        Subsidiary Guarantors and to all obligations of
                        subsidiaries of the Company which do not guarantee the
                        Exchange Notes, including Industrias Hudson. There are
                        currently no Subsidiary Guarantors. As of June 26, 1998,
                        the Company had $38.0 million of Senior Debt, all of
                        which represented secured indebtedness under the New
                        Credit Facility. The Company also had $60.0 million of
                        undrawn commitments available under the New Credit
                        Facility, which if drawn would constitute Senior Debt.
                        The Company had no Subordinated Obligations. As of June
                        26, 1998, Industrias Hudson had total balance sheet
                        liabilities of $0.1 million.    

Redemption............  The Exchange Notes will be redeemable at the option of
                        the Company, in whole or in part, on or after April 15,
                        2003 at the redemption prices set forth herein, plus
                        accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the date of
                        redemption.  In addition, prior to April 15, 2001, up to
                        35% of the aggregate principal amount of the Exchange
                        Notes originally issued may

                                       4
<PAGE>
 
                        be redeemed at the option of the Company at 109 1/8% of
                        the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid
                        interest, if any, to the date of redemption, with the
                        net proceeds of one or more Public Equity Offerings,
                        provided that at least 65% of the original aggregate
                        principal amount of the Exchange Notes remains
                        outstanding.
    
Change of Control.....  In the event of a Change of Control, the Company will be
                        required to make an offer to repurchase all or any part
                        of each holder's Exchange Notes at a cash purchase price
                        equal to 101% of the aggregate principal amount thereof,
                        plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of
                        purchase. There can be no assurance that the Company
                        will have sufficient funds available at the time of any
                        Change of Control to effect the repurchase of Exchange
                        Notes tendered by holders pursuant to such offer. In 
                        addition, the New Credit Facility prohibits the Company
                        from purchasing any Exchange Notes, and also provides
                        that the occurrence of certain of the events that would
                        constitute a Change of Control would constitute a
                        default under such existing debt. See "Description of
                        the Exchange Notes--Repurchase at the Option of Holders
                        Upon Change in Control" and "--Certain Definitions--
                        Change of Control."     
   
Certain Covenants.....  The Indenture for the Exchange Notes will contain
                        limitations on, among other things, (i) the ability of
                        the Company, any Subsidiary Guarantors and other
                        Restricted Subsidiaries to incur additional Debt, (ii)
                        the making of certain Restricted Payments including
                        Investments, (iii) the creation of certain Liens, (iv)
                        the issuance and sale of Capital Stock of Restricted
                        Subsidiaries, (v) Asset Sales, (vi) payment restrictions
                        affecting Restricted Subsidiaries, (vii) transactions
                        with Affiliates, (viii) the ability of the Company and
                        any Subsidiary Guarantor to incur layered Debt, (ix) the
                        ability of Holding to engage in any business or activity
                        other than those relating to ownership of Capital Stock
                        of the Company and (x) certain mergers, consolidations
                        and transfers of assets by or involving the Company (the
                        foregoing capitalized terms are defined in "Description
                        of the Exchange Notes--Certain Definitions" at pages 
                        72-82). All of these limitations will be subject to a 
                        number of important qualifications. See "Description of
                        the Exchange Notes--Certain Covenants."    

Exchange Offer;
Registration Rights...  Holders of Exchange Notes are not entitled to any
                        exchange rights with respect to the Exchange Notes.
                        Holders of Notes are entitled to certain exchange rights
                        pursuant to the Exchange Offer Registration Agreement.
                        Under the Exchange Offer Registration Agreement, the
                        Company is required to offer to exchange the Notes for
                        the Exchange Notes having substantially identical terms
                        which have been registered under the Securities Act.
                        This Exchange Offer is intended to satisfy such
                        obligation.  The form and terms of the Exchange Notes
                        are the same as the form and terms of the Notes in all
                        material respects except that the Exchange Notes have
                        been registered under the Securities Act and hence do
                        not include certain rights to registration thereunder
                        and do not contain transfer restrictions or terms with
                        respect to the special interest payments applicable to
                        the Notes.  Once the Exchange Offer is consummated, the
                        Company will have no further obligations to register any
                        of the Notes not tendered by the Holders for exchange.
                        See "Risk Factors--Consequences to Non-Tendering Holders
                        of Notes".

Use of Proceeds......   The Company will not receive any proceeds from the
                        Exchange Offer.

                                       5
<PAGE>
 
                                 THE EXCHANGE OFFER

The Exchange Offer....  $1,000 principal amount of Exchange Notes in exchange
                        for each $1,000 principal amount of Notes.  As of the
                        date hereof, $115.0 million in aggregate principal
                        amount of Notes were outstanding.  The Company will
                        issue the Exchange Notes to Holders on or promptly after
                        the Expiration Date.

                        Based on an interpretation by the staff of the
                        Commission set forth in no-action letters issued to
                        third parties, the Company believes that Exchange Notes
                        issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for
                        Notes may be offered for resale, resold and otherwise
                        transferred by Holders thereof without compliance with
                        the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of
                        the Securities Act provided that such Exchange Notes are
                        acquired in the ordinary course of such holders'
                        business and such holders have no arrangement with any
                        person to participate in the distribution of such
                        Exchange Notes.  However, the Company does not intend to
                        request the Commission to consider, and the Commission
                        has not considered, the Exchange Offer in a no-action
                        letter and there can be no assurance that the Commission
                        would make a similar determination with respect to the
                        Exchange Offer.  However, any Holder who is an
                        "affiliate" of the Company or who intends to participate
                        in the Exchange Offer for the purpose of distributing
                        the Exchange Notes (i) cannot rely on the interpretation
                        by the staff of the Commission set forth in the above
                        referenced no-action letters, (ii) cannot tender its
                        Notes in the Exchange Offer, and (iii) must comply with
                        the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of
                        the Securities Act in connection with any sale or
                        transfer of the Notes, unless such sale or transfer is
                        made pursuant to an exemption from such requirements.
                        See "Risk Factors--Consequences to Non-Tendering Holders
                        of Notes".

                        Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its
                        own account pursuant to the Exchange Offer must
                        acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in
                        connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes.  The
                        Letter of Transmittal states that by so acknowledging
                        and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not
                        be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within
                        the meaning of the Securities Act.  This Prospectus, as
                        it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may
                        be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of
                        Exchange Notes received in exchange for Notes where such
                        Notes were acquired by such broker-dealer as a result of
                        market-making activities or other trading activities and
                        not acquired directly from the Company.  The Company has
                        agreed that for a period of 180 days after the
                        Expiration Date, it will make this Prospectus available
                        to any broker-dealer for use in connection with any such
                        resale.  See "Plan of Distribution."

Expiration Date......   5:00 p.m., New York City time, on September 25, 1998,
                        unless the Exchange Offer is extended, in which case the
                        term "Expiration Date" means the latest date and time to
                        which the Exchange Offer is extended.

                                       6
<PAGE>
 
Interest on the 
 Exchange Notes;
Accrued Interest  
  on the Notes.......   The Exchange Notes will bear interest from their
                        issuance date. Holders whose Notes are accepted for
                        exchange will receive, in cash, accrued interest thereon
                        to, but excluding, the issuance date of the Exchange
                        Notes. Such interest will be paid with the first
                        interest payment on the Exchange Notes. Interest on the
                        Notes accepted for exchange will cease to accrue upon
                        cancellation of the Notes and issuance of the Exchange
                        Notes. Holders of Notes whose Notes are not exchanged
                        will receive the accrued interest payable on October 15,
                        1998 on such date in accordance with the terms of the
                        Indenture.

Condition to            
the Exchange Notes....  The Exchange Offer is subject to certain customary
                        conditions. The conditions are limited and relate in
                        general to proceedings which have been instituted or
                        laws which have been adopted that might impair the
                        ability of the Company to proceed with the Exchange
                        Offer. As of August 1, 1998, none of these events had
                        occurred, and the Company believes their occurrence to
                        be unlikely. If any such conditions do exist prior to
                        the Expiration Date, the Company may (i) refuse to
                        accept any Notes and return all previously tendered
                        Notes, (ii) extend the Exchange Offer or (iii) waive
                        such conditions. See "The Exchange Offer--Conditions."

Procedures for 
Tendering Notes......   Each Holder of Notes wishing to accept the Exchange
                        Offer must complete, sign and date the Letter of
                        Transmittal, or a facsimile thereof, in accordance with
                        the instructions contained herein and therein, and mail
                        or otherwise deliver such Letter of Transmittal, or such
                        facsimile, together with such Notes to be exchanged and
                        any other required documentation to United States Trust
                        Company of New York, as Exchange Agent, at the address
                        set forth herein and therein or effect a tender of such
                        Notes pursuant to the procedures for book-entry transfer
                        as provided for herein. By executing the Letter of
                        Transmittal, each Holder will represent to the Company
                        that, among other things, the Exchange Notes acquired
                        pursuant to the Exchange Offer are being obtained in the
                        ordinary course of business of the person receiving such
                        Exchange Notes, whether or not such person is the
                        Holder, that neither the Holder nor any such other
                        person has an arrangement or understanding with any
                        person to participate in the distribution of such
                        Exchange Notes and that neither the Holder nor any such
                        person is an "affiliate," as defined in Rule 405 under
                        the Securities Act, of the Company. Each broker-dealer
                        that receives Exchange Notes for its own account in
                        exchange for Notes, where such Notes were acquired by
                        such broker-dealer as a result of market-making
                        activities or other trading activities and not acquired
                        directly from the Company, must acknowledge that it will
                        deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of
                        such Exchange Notes. See "The Exchange Offer--Procedures
                        for Tendering" and "Plan of Distribution."

Special Procedures for
Beneficial Owners....   Any beneficial owner whose Notes are registered in the
                        name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company
                        or other nominee and who wishes to tender such Notes in
                        the Exchange Offer should contact such registered Holder
                        promptly and instruct such registered Holder to tender
                        on such beneficial owner's behalf.  If such beneficial
                        owner wishes to tender on such owner's own behalf, such
                        owner must, prior to completing and

                                       7
<PAGE>
 
                        executing the Letter of Transmittal and delivering its
                        Notes, either make appropriate arrangements to register
                        ownership of the Notes in such owner's name or obtain a
                        properly completed bond power from the registered
                        Holder.  The transfer of registered ownership may take
                        considerable time and may not be able to be completed
                        prior to the Expiration Date.  See "The Exchange Offer--
                        Procedures for Tendering."

Guaranteed Delivery 
Procedures..........    Holders of Notes who wish to tender their Notes and
                        whose Notes are not immediately available or who cannot
                        deliver their Notes, the Letter of Transmittal or any
                        other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal to
                        United States Trust Company of New York, as Exchange
                        Agent, or cannot complete the procedure for book-entry
                        transfer, prior to the Expiration Date must tender their
                        Notes according to the guaranteed delivery procedures
                        set forth in "The Exchange Offer--Guaranteed Delivery
                        Procedures."

Withdrawal Rights....   Tenders may be withdrawn at any time prior to 5:00 p.m.,
                        New York City time, on the Expiration Date.


Acceptance of Notes and
  Delivery of
  Exchange Notes.....   The Company will accept for exchange any and all Notes
                        which are properly tendered in the Exchange Offer prior
                        to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration
                        Date. The Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange
                        Offer will be delivered promptly following the
                        Expiration Date. Any Notes not accepted for exchange
                        will be returned without expense to the tendering Holder
                        thereof as promptly as practicable after the expiration
                        or termination of the Exchange Offer. See "The Exchange
                        Offer--Terms of the Exchange Offer."
   
Material Tax   
Considerations.......   The exchange pursuant to the Exchange Offer will not be
                        a taxable event for Federal income tax purposes. See
                        "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences."    

Exchange Agent.......   United States Trust Company of New York is serving as
                        Exchange Agent in connection with the Exchange Offer.


GENERAL

     The Company's principal executive offices are located at 27711 Diaz Road,
Temecula, California 92589 and its telephone number is (909) 676-5611.

                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
   
     For additional information regarding the Exchange Notes, see "Description
of Exchange Notes" and "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences."    

                                       8
<PAGE>
 
________________________________________________________________________________
 
           SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF
                          HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC.
    
     The following summary fiscal year end historical financial data has been
derived from the audited financial statements of the Company.  The summary pro
forma financial data has been derived from the pro forma financial information
included elsewhere in this Prospectus and gives effect to the Recapitalization
as if it had occurred at the beginning of the period presented with respect to
the operating and other financial data, and as of June 26, 1998 with respect to
balance sheet data.  The financial data for the six months ended June 27, 1997
and June 26, 1998 and as of June 26, 1998 has been derived from unaudited
financial statements included elsewhere in this Prospectus.  The summary pro
forma financial data does not necessarily represent what the Company's financial
position and results of operations would have been if these transactions had
actually been completed as of the dates indicated, and is not intended to
project the Company's financial position or results of operations for any future
period.  Fiscal 1993 was a 53 week year and fiscal years 1994, 1995, 1996 and
1997 were 52 week years.  The information contained in this table should be read
in conjunction with the Company's audited consolidated financial statements and
notes thereto at December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997 and for each of the
three years in the period ended December 26, 1997, unaudited financial
statements and notes thereto for the six months ended June 27, 1997 and June 26,
1998 and as of June 26, 1998, and the pro forma consolidated financial
statements and notes thereto, included elsewhere in this Prospectus.      
<TABLE>      
<CAPTION>
                                                                      FISCAL YEAR
                                          ------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                      PRO
                                                                                                     FORMA
                                            1993        1994        1995       1996       1997        1997
                                          --------    --------    --------   --------   --------    --------
 OPERATING DATA:                                           (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)                  
 <S>                                      <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>
Net sales..............................   $ 79,111    $ 82,772    $ 86,825   $ 93,842   $ 99,509    $ 99,509
Cost of sales..........................     46,476      47,631      47,582     49,405     51,732      51,732
                                          --------    --------    --------   --------   --------    --------
Gross profit...........................     32,635      35,141      39,243     44,437     47,777      47,777
Operating expenses:
  Selling expenses......................     7,070       7,499       8,283      8,961      9,643       9,643
  Distribution expenses.................     4,743       4,543       4,595      4,829      5,240       5,240
  General and administrative
   expenses.............................     9,732      10,426       9,769     11,277     11,456      10,617(b)
  Research and development expenses.....     2,880       1,983       2,064      2,253      1,845       1,845

Provision for equity participation
   plan.................................        --          --      11,415      8,249      6,954          --(d)

Provision for retention payments........        --          --          --         --         --          --
                                          --------    --------    --------   --------   --------    --------
Operating income (loss).................  $  8,210    $ 10,690    $  3,117   $  8,868   $ 12,639    $ 20,432
                                          ========    ========    ========   ========   ========    ========

OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Net cash provided by (used in) 
  operating activities.................   $ 12,784    $ 12,017    $ 15,939   $ 16,133   $ 19,269           
Net cash used in investing activities..   $ (6,073)   $ (2,607)   $ (6,088)  $(11,354)  $ (3,673)
Net cash provided by (used in)
   financing activities................   $ (5,910)   $ (9,653)   $(11,880)  $ (3,668)  $(16,398)
EBITDA before EPP and Retention
   Payments(f).........................   $ 15,422    $ 17,354    $ 21,205   $ 23,194   $ 25,440    $ 26,279
EBITDA before EPP and Retention
   Payments margin(g)..................       19.5%       21.0%       24.4%      24.7%      25.6%       26.4%
Operating margin before EPP and 
   Retention Payments(h)...............       10.4%       12.9%       16.7%      18.2%      19.7%       20.5%
Depreciation & amortization(i).........   $  7,630    $  7,033    $  6,820   $  6,133   $  5,847    $  7,190(j)
Capital expenditures...................   $  9,112    $  4,898    $  5,850   $  6,395   $  4,659    $  4,659
Ratio of EBITDA before EPP and 
   Retention Payments to cash interest 
   expense(k)..........................       6.8x        7.5x        8.7x      10.7x      13.9x        1.9x
Ratio of total debt to EBITDA
   before EPP and Retention Payments...       2.3x        1.8x        1.2x       1.2x       0.8x        5.9x
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(l)..       2.7x        3.6x        1.0x       3.7x       6.0x        1.3x
Deficiency in earnings to fixed 
   charges(l)..........................

BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital........................    $18,187    $ 18,926    $ 18,641   $ 24,188    $ 6,430
Working capital as adjusted(m).........     20,423      20,588      22,461     26,768     29,960
Total assets...........................     66,870      66,576      64,387     76,910     77,554
Total debt.............................     35,167      31,607      25,364     28,146     20,250
Shareholders' equity (deficit).........     23,693      25,269      19,112     19,872     22,515














<CAPTION>
                                              SIX MONTHS ENDED (UNAUDITED)
                                          ------------------------------------
                                                                   PRO FORMA
                                           JUNE         JUNE         JUNE 
                                            27,          26,          26,
                                           1997         1998         1998
                                          --------    --------     ---------
OPERATING DATA:                                     
<S>                                      <C>        <C>           <C>
Net sales..............................  $ 49,093    $ 46,697     $  46,697
Cost of sales..........................    25,388      25,142(a)     25,142
                                         --------    --------     ---------
Gross profit...........................    23,705      21,555        21,555
Operating expenses:
   Selling expenses....................     4,789       4,691         4,691
   Distribution expenses...............     2,547       2,698         6,698
   General and administrative
   expenses............................     5,498       5,676(c)      5,504(b)
   Research and development expenses...       895         940           940

Provision for equity participation
   plan................................     3,654      63,939            --(d)

Provision for retention payments.......        --       4,754(e)         --
                                         --------    --------     ---------
Operating income (loss)................  $  6,322    $(61,643)    $   7,722
                                         ========    ========     =========

OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Net cash provided by (used in) 
   operating activities................  $ 12,273    $(78,011)
Net cash used in investing activities..  $   (994)     (1,646)
Net cash provided by (used in)             
   financing activities................  $(13,745)   $ 84,509
EBITDA before EPP and Retention
   Payments(f).........................  $ 12,846    $ 10,061      $ 10,233
EBITDA before EPP and Retention
   Payments margin(g)..................      26.2%       21.5%         21.9%
Operating margin before EPP and
   Retention Payments(h)...............      20.3%       16.2%         16.5%
Depreciation & amortization(i).........  $  2,901    $  2,992         3,215(j)
Capital expenditures...................  $  2,049    $  1,646      $  1,646
Ratio of EBITDA before EPP and
   Retention Payments to cash interest 
   expense(k)..........................
Ratio of total debt to EBITDA
   before EPP and Retention Payments...
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(l)..       6.1x                     
Deficiency in earnings to fixed
   charges.............................              $ (65,037)    $    (82)
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital........................  $ 24,639    $  23,509     
Working capital as adjusted(m).........    26,654       18,842     
Total assets...........................    74,828      165,032     
Total debt.............................    23,625      153,000     
Shareholders' equity (deficit).........    42,531      (31,864)    
</TABLE>      

                                                     footnotes on following page

________________________________________________________________________________


                                       9
<PAGE>
 
    
(a) For a discussion of the change in cost of goods sold, see "Management's
    Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations--
    Results of Operations--Six Months Ended June 26, 1998 Compared to Six
    Months Ended June 27, 1997."     
(b) Adjustments reflect the elimination of results for OxyAir LLC ("OxyAir"),
    the entity that held the Company's corporate aircraft and elimination of
    Continuing Shareholder's compensation expense due to the Recapitalization.
    See Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements.
    
(c) Includes $0.3 million of legal fees related to patent litigation in which
    the Company was granted favorable summary judgment during the six months
    ended June 26, 1998. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
    Condition and Results of Operations--Results of Operations--Six Months Ended
    June 26, 1998 Compared to Six Months Ended June 27, 1997."     
        
(d) Reflects the elimination of the Equity Participation Plan. For purposes of
    compliance with the Indenture, the Company's Consolidated Net Income (as
    defined at page 75) and EBITDA will not be reduced by the amount of any
    contingent payments made by the Company to former participants in the Equity
    Participation Plan. See "Summary--The Recapitalization" and "Certain
    Transactions." Additional payments to former Equity Participation Plan
    participants will be expensed as earned.     
    
(e) Reflects retention payments made to substantially every employee of the
    Company in connection with the Recapitalization. These payments were
    intended to ensure the continued employment of all employees after the
    Recapitalization and no future payments are anticipated.    
    
(f) EBITDA represents income before depreciation and amortization, interest
    expense, and income tax expense and EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments
    further excludes charges related to the Equity Participation Plan, which was
    terminated upon consummation of the Recapitalization, and retention payments
    made to employees. The Company has included a measurement based on EBITDA
    because it is one way in which the Company monitors its performance and
    because it is commonly used by certain investors and analysts to (i) analyze
    and compare companies on the basis of operating performance, leverage and
    liquidity and (ii) determine a company's ability to service debt. Companies
    calculate EBITDA differently and, therefore, EBITDA measures as presented by
    the Company may not be comparable to EBITDA measures reported by other
    companies. EBITDA and EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments are not
    measures of performance under generally accepted accounting principles, and
    should not be considered as a substitute for net income, cash flows from
    operating activities and other income or cash flow statement data prepared
    in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, or as a measure
    of profitability or liquidity. The Company's EBITDA before EPP and Retention
    Payments calculation excludes payments under the Equity Participation Plan
    and retention payments to present comparable figures for all historical
    periods presented, and to provide a useful measure of assessing the
    Company's ongoing operations and ability to service its debt without the
    impact of nonrecurring items. In addition, certain covenants in the
    Indenture are based upon a calculation analogous to EBITDA before EPP and
    Retention Payments. For purposes of compliance with the Indenture, the
    Company's Consolidated Net Income and EBITDA will not be reduced by
    retention payments, payments made pursuant to the Equity Participation Plan
    or by the amount of any contingent payments made by the Company to former
    participants in the Equity Participation Plan. See "Summary--The
    Recapitalization" and "Certain Transactions."    
    
(g) Represents ratio of EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments to net
sales.    
    
(h) Represents ratio of operating income before EPP and retention payments to
    net sales.     
   
(i) Includes amortization of deferred financing fees of $0.4 million in 1993,
    $0.4 million in 1994, $0.1 million in 1995 and $0.1 million in 1996, which
    should be excluded from depreciation and amortization in calculating EBITDA
    before EPP and Retention Payments since such fees are reflected below the
    operating income line.    
    
(j) Actual 1997 amortization of deferred financing fees has been replaced with
    pro forma non-cash amortization of deferred financing fees of approximately
    $1.4 million associated with the Recapitalization. Actual amortization for
    the six months ended June 26, 1998 has been replaced by pro forma
    amortization of $0.7 million associated with the Recapitalization.     
        
(k) Excludes approximately $1.4 million of non-cash amortization expense for
    1997, relating to deferred debt financing costs relating to the
    Recapitalization. This amount is also excluded from the calculation of the
    Company's Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio (as defined at page 73) under
    the Indenture.     
    
(l) For the purpose of determining the ratio of earnings to fixed charges,
    earnings consist of earnings before income taxes and fixed charges.  Fixed
    charges consist of interest on indebtedness, the amortization of debt issue
    costs and that portion of operating rental expense representative of the
    interest factor.     
        
(m) Working capital as adjusted represents current assets, excluding cash, less
    current liabilities, excluding the current portion of long-term debt. Actual
    1997 current liabilities excludes the management bonus liability of $20.0
    million. See Note 7(c) to Consolidated Financial Statements.          

                                       10
<PAGE>
 
                                  RISK FACTORS

     This Prospectus includes "forward-looking statements" within the meaning of
Section 27A of the Securities Act and Section 21E of the Exchange Act.  All
statements other than statements of historical facts included in this
Prospectus, including without limitation, certain statements under the sections
"Summary", "Selected Historical and Pro Forma Consolidated Financial
Information", "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and
Results of Operations", "Business" and Pro Forma Consolidated Financial
Statements and the notes thereto located elsewhere herein regarding the
Company's financial position, business strategy, prospects and other related
matters, may constitute such forward-looking statements.  Although the Company
believes that the expectations reflected in such forward-looking statements are
reasonable, it can give no assurance that such expectations will prove to be
correct.  Actual results could differ materially from the Company's expectations
as a result of a number of factors, including without limitation those set forth
below and those located elsewhere in this Prospectus.

       In evaluating the Exchange Offer, Holders of the Notes should carefully
consider the following factors in addition to the other information contained in
this Prospectus.


SUBSTANTIAL LEVERAGE; SHAREHOLDERS' DEFICIT
    
     As of June 26, 1998, the Company had $153.0 million of outstanding
indebtedness and a shareholders' deficit of approximately $31.9 million. See
"Capitalization." This level of indebtedness is substantially higher than the
Company's historical debt levels and may reduce the flexibility of the Company
to respond to changing business and economic conditions. In addition, subject to
the restrictions in the New Credit Facility and the Indenture, the Company may
incur additional senior or other indebtedness from time to time to finance
acquisitions or capital expenditures or for other general corporate purposes.
See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations--Liquidity and Capital Resources." The New Credit Facility and the
Indenture restrict, but do not prohibit, the payment of dividends by the Company
to Holding to finance the payment of dividends on the Exchange Preferred Stock.
See "Description of Other Securities--Exchange Preferred Stock."     
    
     The Company's high degree of leverage may have important consequences for
the Company, including:  (i) the ability of the Company to obtain additional
financing for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other
purposes, if necessary, may be impaired; (ii) a substantial portion of the
Company's cash flow will be dedicated to the payment of interest and principal
on its indebtedness and will not be available to the Company for its operations
and future business opportunities; (iii) the covenants contained in the
Indenture and the New Credit Facility will limit the Company's ability to, among
other things, borrow additional funds, dispose of assets or make investments and
may affect the Company's flexibility in planning for, and reacting to, changes
in business conditions; (iv) indebtedness under the New Credit Facility will be
at variable rates of interest, which will cause the Company to be vulnerable to
increases in interest rates; and (v) the Company's high degree of leverage may
make it more vulnerable to a downturn in its business or the economy generally
or limit its ability to withstand competitive pressures. If the Company is
unable to generate sufficient cash flow from operations in the future to service
its indebtedness, it may be required to refinance all or a portion of its
existing debt or to obtain additional financing. There can be no assurance that
any such actions could be effected on a timely basis or on satisfactory terms or
that these actions would enable the Company to continue to satisfy its capital
requirements. The Company's ability to meet its debt service obligations and to
reduce its total indebtedness will be dependent upon the Company's future
performance, which will be subject to general economic conditions and to
financial, business and other factors effecting the operations of the Company,
many of which are beyond its control. The terms of the Company's indebtedness,
including the New Credit Facility and the Indenture, also may prohibit the
Company from taking such actions.     

SUBORDINATION OF NOTES, EXCHANGE NOTES AND SUBSIDIARY GUARANTIES

     The Notes are, and the Exchange Notes will be, general unsecured
obligations of the Company, subordinated in right of payment to all existing and
future Senior Debt of the Company, including the New Credit Facility.  The Notes
rank, and the Exchange Notes will rank, pari passu with any future Senior
Subordinated Debt

                                       11
<PAGE>
 
        
of the Company and senior to any future Subordinated Obligations of the Company.
The Notes are, and the Exchange Notes will also be, effectively subordinated in
right of payment to all existing and future secured indebtedness of the Company
to the extent of the value of the assets securing such indebtedness, including
the Company's obligations under the New Credit Facility which are secured by a
first priority lien on substantially all of the assets of the Company and its
domestic subsidiaries now owned or hereafter acquired, as well as a pledge of
65% of the stock of Industrias Hudson.  The Notes are, and the Exchange Notes
will also be, effectively subordinated in right of payment to all obligations of
subsidiaries of the Company which do not guarantee the Notes, including
Industrias Hudson. Any Subsidiary Guaranties (as defined at page 83) of any
future domestic subsidiaries of the Company could also be effectively
subordinated to all the obligations of such subsidiaries under certain
circumstances. The New Credit Facility is unconditionally guaranteed by Holding
and any future domestic and, to the extent no negative tax consequences would
result, foreign, subsidiaries of the Company. There are currently no Subsidiary
Guarantors, and thus no Subsidiary Guaranties of the New Credit Facility or the
Notes, and the Company has no present intention of creating or acquiring
subsidiaries that will be Subsidiary Guarantors. As of June 26, 1998, the
Company had $38.0 million of Senior Debt, all of which represented secured
indebtedness under the New Credit Facility. The Company also had $60.0 million
of undrawn commitments available under the New Credit Facility, which when drawn
will constitute Senior Debt. As of June 26, 1998, Industrias Hudson had total
balance sheet liabilities of $0.1 million. The Company had no outstanding
Subordinated Obligations. The Indenture permits the Company and the Subsidiary
Guarantors to incur significant additional indebtedness, all of which may be
Senior Debt, under certain circumstances. In the event of a bankruptcy,
liquidation or reorganization of the Company, the assets of the Company will be
available to pay obligations on the Notes or Exchange Notes only after all
Senior Debt has been paid in full, and there may not be sufficient assets
remaining to pay all or any amounts due on the Notes or Exchange Notes then
outstanding. The Company may not pay principal or premium, if any, or interest
on the Notes or Exchange Notes if Senior Debt is not paid when due or any other
default on such Senior Debt occurs and the maturity of such Senior Debt is
accelerated in accordance with its terms unless, in either case, such amount has
been paid in full or the default has been cured or waived and such acceleration
has been rescinded. In addition, if any default occurs with respect to certain
Senior Debt, including indebtedness under the New Credit Facility, and certain
other conditions are satisfied, the Company may not make any payments on the
Notes or Exchange Notes for a designated period of time. See "--Fraudulent
Conveyance and Distribution Limitation Considerations" and "Description of the
Exchange Notes--Subordination."     

FRAUDULENT CONVEYANCE AND DISTRIBUTION LIMITATION CONSIDERATIONS

     The payments made in connection with the Recapitalization to shareholders
of the Company, the repayment of the Company's existing indebtedness and the
related incurrence by the Company of indebtedness (including indebtedness under
the Notes and the New Credit Facility) may be subject to review under relevant
state and federal fraudulent conveyance laws, as well as other similar laws
regarding creditors rights generally.  Under these laws, if a court were to find
that, after giving effect to the Recapitalization, either (a) the Company
incurred such indebtedness with the intent of hindering, delaying or defrauding
creditors or (b) the Company received less than reasonably equivalent value or
consideration for incurring such indebtedness and (i) was insolvent or rendered
insolvent by reason of such transaction, (ii) was engaged in a business or
transaction for which the assets remaining with the Company constituted
unreasonably small capital or (iii) intended to incur, or believed that it would
incur, debts beyond its ability to pay such debts as they matured, such court
may subordinate the Exchange Notes to presently existing and future creditors of
the Company, avoid the issuance of the Exchange Notes and direct the repayment
of any amounts paid thereunder to the Company's creditors or take other action
detrimental to the holders of the Exchange Notes.  To the extent that proceeds
from the sale of the Notes are used to repay indebtedness, or to make a
distribution to a stockholder on account of the ownership of capital stock, a
court may find that the Company did not receive fair consideration or reasonably
equivalent value for the incurrence of the indebtedness represented by the
Exchange Notes.  The issuance of a Subsidiary Guaranty by any future subsidiary
of the Company would be subject to similar analysis.  See "Description of the
Exchange Notes--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Non-Guarantor Subsidiary Debt."
The payments made in connection with the Recapitalization to the current
shareholders of the Company may be subject to review under provisions of the
California corporations code limiting dividends and distributions to
shareholders.  See "Summary--The Recapitalization" and "Certain Transactions."
If a court were to find that payments made to such shareholders in connection
with the Recapitalization were subject to these provisions, such payments would
exceed the applicable statutory limitations

                                       12
<PAGE>
 
and, to the extent that the Company's obligations to its creditors at the time
of such payments were not satisfied, such court could take actions with respect
to the Exchange Notes of the type described above.

     The measure of insolvency for purposes of determining whether a transfer is
avoidable as a fraudulent transfer varies depending upon the law of the
jurisdiction which is being applied.  Generally, however, a debtor would be
considered insolvent if the sum of all its liabilities, including contingent
liabilities, were greater than the value of all its property at a fair
valuation, or if the present fair saleable value of the debtor's assets were
less than the amount required to repay its probable liabilities on its debts,
including contingent liabilities, as they become absolute and matured.

     Based upon financial and other information currently available to it,
management of the Company believes that the indebtedness retired with the
proceeds of the Notes Offering was, and the Notes were and the Exchange Notes
will be, incurred for proper purposes and in good faith and that at the time it
incurred the indebtedness to be retired with the proceeds of the Notes Offering
the Company was, at the time the Notes were issued the Company was, and at the
time the Exchange Notes are issued the Company will be (i) neither insolvent nor
rendered insolvent thereby, (ii) in possession of sufficient capital to run its
business effectively and (iii) incurring debts within its ability to pay as the
same mature or become due.  See "Management's Discussions and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations--Liquidity and Capital Resources."
In reaching these conclusions, the Company relied upon various valuations and
estimates of future cash flow that necessarily involve a number of assumptions
and choices of methodology.  No assurance can be given, however, that the
assumptions and methodologies chosen by the Company would be adopted by a court
or that a court would concur with the Company's conclusions.  There can be no
assurance that a court would not determine, regardless of whether the Company
was solvent on the date the Notes were issued, that the payments constituted
fraudulent transfers.

MEDICAL COST CONTAINMENT

     In recent years, widespread efforts have been made in both the public and
private sectors to control health care costs, including the prices of products
such as those sold by the Company, in the United States and abroad.  Cost
containment measures have resulted in increased customer purchasing power,
particularly through the increased presence of GPOs in the marketplace and
increased consolidation of distributors.  Health care organizations are
evaluating ways in which costs can be reduced by decreasing the frequency with
which a treatment, device or product is used.  Cost containment has also caused
a shift in the decision making function with respect to supply acquisition from
the clinician to the administrator, resulting in a greater emphasis being placed
on price, as opposed to features and clinical benefits. The Company has
encountered significant pricing pressure from customers and believes that it is
likely that efforts by governmental and private payors to contain costs through
managed care and other efforts and to reform health systems will continue and
that such efforts may have an adverse effect on the pricing and demand for the
Company's products.  There can be no assurance that current or future reform
initiatives will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial conditions or results of operations.  See "Business--Industry
Overview."
    
     The Company's products are sold principally to a variety of health care
providers, including hospitals and alternate site providers, that receive
reimbursement for the products and services they provide from various public and
private third party payors, including Medicare, Medicaid and private insurance
programs. As a result, while the Company does not receive payments directly
from such third-party payors, the demand for the Company's products in any
specific care setting is dependent in part on the reimbursement policies of the
various payors in that setting. In order to be reimbursed, the products
generally must be found to be reasonable and necessary for the treatment of
medical conditions and must otherwise fall within the payor's list of covered
services. In light of increased controls on Medicare spending, there can be no
assurance on the outcome of future coverage or payment decisions for any of the
Company's products by governmental or private payors. If providers, suppliers
and other users of the Company's products are unable to obtain sufficient
reimbursement, a material adverse impact on the Company's business, financial
condition or operations may result.      

     The Company expects that the trend toward cost containment that has
impacted the domestic market will also be experienced in international health
care markets, impacting the Company's growth in foreign countries, particularly
where health care is socialized.

                                       13
<PAGE>
 
INDUSTRY CONSOLIDATION; CUSTOMER CONCENTRATION

     Cost containment has resulted in significant consolidation within the
health care industry.  A substantial number of the Company's customers,
including group purchasing organizations, hospitals, national nursing home
companies and national home health care agencies, have been affected by this
consolidation.  The acquisition of any of the Company's significant customers
could result in the loss of such customers by the Company, thereby negatively
impacting its business, financial condition and results of operations.  For
example, in 1996, three GPOs that accounted for aggregate sales of approximately
$11.0 million combined and, as a result of a decision of the combined entity to
enter into a sole distributorship arrangement in 1997 with one of the Company's
competitors, the Company has experienced some decrease in sales and may
experience additional sales decreases in the future.  In addition, the
consolidation of health care providers often results in the renegotiation of
terms and in the granting of price concessions.  The Company's customer
relationships, including exclusive or preferential provider relationships, are
terminable at will by either party without advance notice or penalty.  Because
larger purchasers or groups of purchasers tend to have more leverage in
negotiating prices, this trend has caused the Company to reduce prices and could
have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition or
results of operations.  As GPOs and integrated health care systems increase in
size, each relationship represents a greater concentration of market share and
the adverse consequences of losing a particular relationship increases
considerably.  For fiscal 1997, the Company's ten largest group purchasing
arrangements accounted for approximately 34% of the Company's total net sales,
and management believes that such arrangements accounted for a similar
percentage of net sales for fiscal 1997.  Distributors have also consolidated in
response to cost containment.  For fiscal 1997, approximately 30% of the
Company's net sales were to a single distributor, Owens & Minor Inc. ("Owens &
Minor").  The loss of the Company's relationship with this distributor would
have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition
and results of operations.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION

     The Company and its customers and suppliers are subject to extensive
Federal and state regulation in the United States, as well as regulation by
foreign governments.  Most of the Company's products are subject to government
regulation in the United States and other countries.  In the United States, the
Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, as amended (the "FDC Act"), and other
statutes and regulations govern or influence the testing, manufacture, safety,
labeling, storage, record keeping, marketing, advertising and promotion of such
products.  Failure to comply with applicable requirements can result in fines,
recall or seizure of products, total or partial suspension of production,
withdrawal of existing product approvals or clearances, refusal to approve or
clear new applications or notices and criminal prosecution.  Under the FDC Act
and similar foreign laws, the Company, as a marketer, distributor and
manufacturer of health care products, is required to obtain the approval of
Federal and foreign governmental agencies, including the Food and Drug
Administration ("FDA"), prior to marketing, distributing and manufacturing
certain of those products, which can be time consuming and expensive.  The
Company may also need to obtain FDA clearance before modifying marketed products
or making new promotional claims.  Delays in receipt of or failure to receive
required approvals or clearances, the loss of previously received approvals or
clearances, or failures to comply with existing or future regulatory
requirements in the United States or in foreign countries could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business.  Foreign sales are subject to similar
requirements.

     The Company is required to comply with the FDA's "Quality System
Regulations for Medical Devices" implementing "Good Manufacturing Practices"
("GMP/QSR Regulations"), which set forth requirements for, among other things,
the Company's manufacturing process, design control and associated record
keeping, including testing and sterility.  Further, the Company's plants and
operations are subject to review and inspection by local, state, Federal and
foreign governmental entities.  The distribution of the Company's products may
also be subject to state regulation.  The impact of FDA regulation on the
Company has increased in recent years as the Company has increased its
manufacturing operations.  The Company's suppliers, including sterilizer
facilities, are also subject to similar governmental requirements.  There can be
no assurance that changes to current regulations or additional regulations
imposed by the FDA will not have an adverse impact on the Company's business and
financial condition in the future.  If the FDA believes that a company is not in
compliance with applicable regulations, it can institute proceedings to detain
or seize products, issue a recall, impose operating restrictions, enjoin future
violations and assess civil and criminal penalties against the company, its
officers or its employees and can recommend criminal

                                       14
<PAGE>
 
prosecution to the Department of Justice.  Other regulatory agencies may have
similar powers.  In addition, product approvals could be withdrawn due to the
failure to comply with regulatory standards or the occurrence of unforeseen
problems following initial marketing.  The FDA also has the authority to issue
special controls for devices manufactured by the Company, which it has not done
to date.  In the event that such special controls were issued, the Company's
products would be required to conform, which could result in significant
additional expenditures for the Company.

     The Company is subject to numerous federal, state and local laws and
regulations relating to such matters as safe working conditions, manufacturing
practices, fire hazard control and the handling and disposal of hazardous or
infectious materials or substances and emissions of air pollutants.  The Company
owns and leases properties which are subject to environmental laws and
regulations.  There can be no assurance that the Company will not be required to
incur significant costs to comply with such laws and regulations in the future
or that such laws or regulations will not have a material adverse effect upon
the Company's business, financial condition or results of operations.  In
addition, the Company cannot predict the extent to which future legislative and
regulatory developments concerning its practices and products for the health
care industry may affect the Company.  See "Business--Government Regulation and
Environmental Matters."

RISKS RELATED TO INTERNATIONAL SALES; FOREIGN OPERATIONS

     Sales made outside the United States represented approximately 19.1% of the
Company's 1997 net sales and the Company intends to increase international sales
as a percentage of total net sales.  Foreign operations are subject to special
risks that can materially affect the sales, profits, cash flows and financial
position of the Company, including increased regulation, extended payment
periods, competition from firms with more local experience, currency exchange
rate fluctuations and import and export controls.  Sales of the Company's
products are denominated in U.S. dollars.  The destabilization of the economies
of several Asian countries in 1997 caused a decrease in demand for the Company's
products throughout Southeast Asia, and future sales in that region are
uncertain.  In addition, adverse economic conditions in Asia could result in
"dumping" of products similar to those produced by the Company by other
manufacturers, both in Asian and other markets.

     The Company also maintains a manufacturing and assembly facility in
Ensenada, Mexico and, as a result, is subject to operational risks such as
changing labor trends and civil unrest in that country.  In the event the
Company were required to transfer its Ensenada operations to the United States
or were otherwise unable to benefit from its lower cost Mexican operation, its
business, financial condition and results of operations would be adversely
affected.

PRODUCT LIABILITY

     The manufacturing and marketing of medical products entails an inherent
risk of product liability claims.  Although the Company has not experienced any
significant losses due to product liability claims and currently maintains
umbrella liability insurance coverage, there can be no assurance that the amount
or scope of the coverage maintained by the Company will be adequate to protect
it in the event a significant product liability claim is successfully asserted
against the Company.  In addition, the Company cannot predict the extent to
which future legislative and regulatory developments concerning its practices
and products for the health care industry may affect the Company.

DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL; MANAGEMENT OF EXPANDING OPERATIONS

     The Company's success will, to a large extent, depend upon the continued
services of its executive officers.  The loss of services of any of these
executive officers could materially and adversely affect the Company.  While the
Company has employment agreements with it senior management team, these
agreements may be terminated by either party, with or without cause.

     The Company's plans to expand its business may place a significant strain
on the Company's operational and financial resources and systems.  To manage its
expanding operations, the Company may be required to, among other things,
improve its operational, financial and management information systems.  The
Company may also be

                                       15
<PAGE>
 
required to attract, train and retain additional highly qualified management,
technical, sales and marketing and customer support personnel.  The process of
locating such personnel with the combination of skills and attributes required
to implement the Company's strategy is often lengthy.  The inability to attract
and retain additional qualified personnel could materially and adversely affect
the Company.

COMPETITION

     The medical supply industry is characterized by intense competition.
Certain of the Company's competitors have greater financial and other resources
than the Company and may succeed in utilizing these resources to obtain an
advantage over the Company.  The general trend toward cost containment in the
health care industry has had the effect of increasing competition among
manufacturers, as health care providers and distributors consolidate and as GPOs
increase in size and importance.  The Company competes on the basis of brand
name, product quality, breadth of product line, service and price.  See
"Business--Competition."

RISKS GENERALLY ASSOCIATED WITH ACQUISITIONS
    
     An element of the Company's business strategy is to pursue strategic
acquisitions that either expand or complement the Company's business.
Acquisitions involve a number of special risks, including the diversion of
management's attention to the assimilation of the operations and the
assimilation and retention of the personnel of the acquired companies, and
potential adverse effects on the Company's operating results.  The Company may
require additional debt or equity financing for future acquisitions, which may
not be available on terms favorable to the Company, if at all.  In addition, the
New Credit Facility and the Indenture contain certain restrictions regarding
acquisitions.  The Indenture restricts acquisitions to those companies in the 
same line of business as the Company, and requires that all such acquired 
companies be designated Restricted Subsidiaries. The New Credit Facility 
restricts all acquisitions with the exception of Permitted Acquisitions (as
defined therein), and limits, among other things, (i) the sum that may be paid
in connection with any single acquisition to $30.0 million, (ii) the total
amount outstanding of revolving credit indebtedness that can be incurred for
acquisition purposes to $40.0 million, and (iii) the line of business of the
acquired entity or assets. The inability of the Company to successfully finance,
complete and integrate strategic acquisitions in a timely manner could have an
adverse impact on the Company's ability to effect a portion of its growth
strategy. See "Business--Business Strategy," "Description of New Credit
Facility" and "Description of the Exchange Notes."

PATENTS AND TRADEMARKS

     The Company has historically relied primarily on its technological and
engineering abilities and on its design and production capabilities to gain
competitive business advantages, rather than on patents or other intellectual
property rights.  However, the Company does file patent applications on concepts
and processes developed by the Company's personnel.  The Company has 18 patents
in the U.S. and two patents pending.  Many of the U.S. patents have
corresponding patents issued in Canada, Europe and various Asian countries.  The
Company is currently preparing several patent applications covering intellectual
property associated with the closed suction catheter product and advanced
humidification devices.  The Company's success will depend in part on its
ability to maintain its patents, add to them where appropriate, and to develop
new products and applications without infringing the patent and other
proprietary rights of third parties and without breaching or otherwise losing
rights in technology licenses obtained by the Company for other products.  There
can be no assurance that any patent owned by the Company will not be
circumvented or challenged, that the rights granted thereunder will provide
competitive advantages to the Company or that any of the Company's pending or
future patent applications will be issued with claims of the scope sought by the
Company, if at all. If challenged, there can be no assurance that the Company's
patents (or patents under which it licenses technology) will be held valid or
enforceable.  In addition, there can be no assurance that the Company's products
or proprietary rights do not infringe the rights of third parties.  If such
infringement were established, the Company could be required to pay damages,
enter into royalty or licensing agreements on onerous terms and/or be enjoined
from making, using or selling the infringing product.  Any of the foregoing
could have a material adverse effect upon the Company's business, financial
condition or results of operations.

CONTROL OF COMPANY; AFFILIATE TRANSACTIONS

     FS&Co. indirectly controls approximately 80.8% of the voting common stock
of the Company and 100.0% of the preferred stock of the Company, which is
entitled to  1/2 vote per share.  As a result, FS&Co. has the ability to control
the Company's management, policies and financing decisions and to elect a
majority of the Company's Board of Directors.  There can be no assurance that
any decisions taken by FS&Co. will be in the interests of

                                       16
<PAGE>
 
holders of the Exchange Notes.  See "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial
Owners."  There are currently no independent members of the Company's Board of
Directors.  Under the Indenture, the Board of Directors of the Company has
discretion to approve certain transactions involving the Company and the
Restricted Subsidiaries, including transactions with affiliates and certain
asset sales.  In particular, the Indenture permits the Board of Directors to
approve transactions of up to $2.5 million between the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary, on the one hand, and any affiliate thereof (including members of the
Board of Directors), on the other hand ("Affiliate Transactions").  This limit
will apply to individual transactions only, and there will be no limit on the
aggregate value of such affiliate transactions that may be approved by the Board
of Directors.  The Indenture requires the Company to obtain a fairness opinion
with respect to Affiliate Transactions in excess of $5.0 million.

PAYMENT UPON A CHANGE OF CONTROL
    
     Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, each holder of the Exchange
Notes may require the Company to purchase all or a portion of such holder's
Exchange Notes at 101% of the principal amount of the Exchange Notes, together
with accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase.  The Trustee 
does not have authority under the Indenture to waive the covenant relating to 
the holder's right to require the Company to purchase the Exchange Notes upon 
the occurrence of a Change of Control.  Prior to any such repurchase of the
Exchange Notes, the Company may be required to (i) repay all or a portion of
indebtedness under the New Credit Facility or other indebtedness of the Company
or (ii) obtain certain consents to permit the repurchase, including consents
under the New Credit Facility. If the Company is unable to repay all of such
indebtedness or is unable to obtain the necessary consents, the Company would be
unable to offer to repurchase the Exchange Notes, which would constitute an
Event of Default (as defined herein) under the Indenture. There can be no
assurance that the Company will have sufficient funds available at the time of
any Change of Control to make any debt payment (including repurchases of Notes)
as described above. See "Description of the Exchange Notes--Repurchase at the
Option of Holders Upon a Change of Control."     

     The events that constitute a Change of Control under the Indenture may also
be events of default under the New Credit Facility or other indebtedness of the
Company.  Such events may permit the lenders under such debt instruments to
accelerate the debt and, if the debt is not paid, to enforce security interests
in, or to commence litigation that could ultimately result in a sale of,
substantially all the assets of the Company, thereby limiting the Company's
ability to raise cash to repurchase the Exchange Notes.  In such circumstances,
the subordination provisions in the Indenture would likely prohibit payments to
holders of the Exchange Notes.

LACK OF PUBLIC MARKET FOR THE EXCHANGE NOTES

     The Exchange Notes are being offered to the Holders of the Notes.  Prior to
this Exchange Offer, there has been no public market for the Notes.  The Company
does not intend to apply for listing of the Exchange Notes on any securities
exchange or for quotation through the Nasdaq National Market.  The Initial
Purchasers have informed the Company that they currently intend to make a market
in the Exchange Notes.  However, the Initial Purchasers are not obligated to do
so and any such market making may be discontinued at any time without notice.
Therefore, no assurance can be given as to whether an active trading market will
develop or be maintained for the Exchange Notes.  As the Notes were issued and
the Exchange Notes are being issued to a limited number of institutions who
typically hold similar securities for investment, the Company does not expect
that an active public market for the Exchange Notes will develop.  In addition,
resales by certain holders of the Notes or the Exchange Notes of a substantial
percentage of the aggregate principal amount of such notes could constrain the
ability of any market maker to develop or maintain a market for the Exchange
Notes.  To the extent that a market for the Exchange Notes should develop, the
market value of the Exchange Notes will depend on prevailing interest rates, the
market for similar securities and other factors, including the financial
condition, performance and prospects of the Company.  Such factors might cause
the Exchange Notes to trade at a discount from face value.

S CORPORATION STATUS

     The Company elected to be treated as an S corporation for federal and state
income tax purposes for its taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 1987.
Unlike a C corporation, an S corporation is generally not subject to income tax
at the corporate level; instead, the S corporation's income is taxed on the
personal income tax returns of its shareholders.  The Company's status as an S
corporation terminated upon consummation of the Recapitalization.  If S
corporation status were denied for any periods prior to such termination by
reason of a failure

                                       17
<PAGE>
 
to satisfy the S corporation election or eligibility requirements of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, the Company would be subject to tax
on its income as if it were a C corporation for these periods.  Such an
occurrence would have a material adverse effect on the Company's results.

YEAR 2000 COMPLIANCE
        
     The issue surrounding the year 2000 is whether computer systems will
properly recognize date sensitive information when the year changes to 2000, or
"00." Systems that misinterpret the two-digit date "00" as the year 1900 instead
of the year 2000 could generate erroneous data or fail. The Company has upgraded
its information system capabilities such that it does not believe that its
systems will encounter any material year 2000 problems, nor will its operations
be materially affected by year 2000 issues. In addition, the Company's products
are not subject to year 2000 problems. The Company also relies, directly and
indirectly on the external systems of various independent business enterprises,
such as its customers, suppliers, creditors, financial organizations, and of
governments, both domestically and internationally, for the accurate exchange of
data and related information. The Company has not assessed the status of such
third-party enterprises' information systems, nor the materiality, nature or
potential impact on the Company of year 2000 issues confronted by such third
parties to the extent the same affect the Company. The Company has not developed
any contingency plans in the event of disruption in the operation of the
various third-party enterprises with which it interacts, and thus could be
adversely affected in the event of any such disruption.    
     
CONSEQUENCES TO NON-TENDERING HOLDERS OF NOTES AND REQUIREMENTS FOR TRANSFER OF
EXCHANGE NOTES

          Upon consummation of the Exchange Offer, the Company will have no
further obligation to register the Notes.  Thereafter, any Holder of Notes who
does not tender its Notes in the Exchange Offer, including any Holder which is
an "affiliate" (as that term is defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act) of
the Company which cannot tender its Notes in the Exchange Offer, will continue
to hold restricted securities which may not be offered, sold or otherwise
transferred, pledged or hypothecated except pursuant to Rule 144 and Rule 144A
under the Securities Act or pursuant to any other exemption from registration
under the Securities Act relating to the disposition of securities, provided
that an opinion of counsel is furnished to the Company that such an exemption is
available.

                                       18
<PAGE>
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS

     This Exchange Offer is intended to satisfy certain of the Company's
obligations under the Exchange Offer Registration Agreement.  The Company will
not receive any cash proceeds from the issuance of the Exchange Notes offered in
the Exchange Offer.  In consideration for issuing the Exchange Notes as
contemplated in this Prospectus, the Company will receive in exchange Notes in
like principal amount, the form and terms of which are the same in all material
respects as the form and terms of the Exchange Notes except that the Exchange
Notes have been registered under the Securities Act and do not contain transfer
restrictions or terms with respect to the special interest payments applicable
to the Notes.  The Notes surrendered in exchange for Exchange Notes will be
retired and canceled and cannot be reissued.  Accordingly, issuance of the
Exchange Notes will not result in any increase in the indebtedness of the
Company.
    
          Net proceeds from the Notes Offering were $115.0 million. Such
proceeds, together with the proceeds of the Holding Equity Investment and
borrowings under the New Credit Facility, were used (i) to make a $131.1 million
cash payment to the Continuing Shareholder and payments to management of Hudson
RCI totalling $68.3 million pursuant to the Company's Equity Participation Plan,
(ii) to pay outstanding debt under the Company's existing credit agreement and
(iii) to pay related fees and expenses. The outstanding debt that was repaid
from the net proceeds of the sale of Notes consisted of $34.2 million of
borrowings and accrued interest outstanding under the Company's credit agreement
with a maturity of March 31, 2000 that included term loans that bore interest at
a base rate plus 0.5% or a eurodollar rate plus 2% and a revolving line of
credit that bore interest at a base rate plus 0.25% or a eurodollar rate plus
1.75%. This amount included $20.0 million of indebtedness incurred on March 11,
1998 in connection with payments made to certain employees pursuant to the
Company's Equity Participation Plan. See "Summary--The Recapitalization."     

                                       19
<PAGE>
 
                                 CAPITALIZATION
    
     The following table sets forth the capitalization of the Company on an
actual basis as of June 26, 1998. This table should be read in conjunction with
"Pro Forma Financial Statements" and the notes thereto, "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the Company's
consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto included elsewhere in
this Prospectus.    
<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                       JUNE 26, 1998(a)                                          
                                                                       -------------                                          
                                                                                                                              
<S>                                                                      <C>                                                  
Current maturities of long-term debt................................       $  1,000                                           
                                                                           --------                                           
Long-term debt:                                                                                                               
New Credit Facility.................................................         37,000                                           
Notes...............................................................        115,000                                           
                                                                           --------                                           
     Total long-term debt...........................................        152,000                                           
                                                                           --------                                           
Mandatorily redeemable PIK preferred stock, $.01 par                                                                          
 value, liquidation preference $100 per share, 600,000 shares 
 authorized, 300,000 shares issued and outstanding(b)...............         29,000
Accrued preferred stock dividend, payable-in-kind...................            776
                                                                           -------- 
                                                                             29,776
                                                                           --------  
Shareholders' equity (deficit):                                                                                               
Common stock, $.01 par value, 15,000,000 shares                                                                               
  authorized, 7,800,000 shares issued and outstanding...............         63,410
Cumulative translation adjustment...................................           (464)                                          
Retained earnings (deficit).........................................        (94,810) 
                                                                           --------                                           
     Total shareholders' equity (deficit)...........................        (31,864)                                          
                                                                           --------                                           
     Total capitalization...........................................       $150,912                                           
                                                                           ========                                           
 
</TABLE>     

_______________
(a) Does not give effect to the obligation of the Company to pay the Continuing
    Shareholder and former participants in the Equity Participation Plan an
    aggregate of $5.7 million upon achievement by the Company of certain
    operating performance targets in fiscal 1998.  See "Certain Transactions."
         
    
(b) The mandatorily redeemable preferred stock provides that, until April 15,
    2003, dividends on such preferred stock may be paid, at the election of the
    Company, in additional shares of such preferred stock, and thereafter must
    be paid in cash.     
         
                                       20
<PAGE>
 
                               THE EXCHANGE OFFER

PURPOSES OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     The Notes were issued and sold by the Company on April 7, 1998 to 
the Initial Purchasers, who subsequently resold the Notes to (a) "qualified
institutional buyers" (in reliance on Rule 144A under the Securities Act). In
connection with the issuance and sale of the Notes, the Company and the Initial
Purchasers entered into the Exchange Offer Registration Agreement pursuant to
which the Company agreed to use its best efforts to cause a registration
statement with respect to the Exchange Offer to become effective within 150 days
of April 7, 1998, the date of issuance of the Notes. However, in the event that
(a) any changes in the law or the applicable interpretations of the staff of the
Commission do not permit the Company to effect the Exchange Offer, (b) for any
other reason the Exchange Offer Registration Statement is not declared effective
within 150 days after the date of the original issuance of the Notes or the
Exchange Offer is not consummated within 180 days after the date of the original
issuance of the Notes, (c) under certain circumstances the Initial Purchasers so
request or (d) under certain circumstances if certain holders of the Notes are
not permitted to participate in the Exchange Offer or are not able to receive
freely tradeable Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, the Company will
file a shelf registration statement with respect to the resale of the Notes (the
"Shelf Registration Statement") and keep such Shelf Registration Statement
effective until two years after the Issue Date (or until one year after such
date if such Shelf Registration Statement is filed at the request of an Initial
Purchaser).


     The Exchange Offer is being made by Hudson RCI to satisfy its obligations
pursuant to the Exchange Offer Registration Agreement.  The form and terms of
the Exchange Notes are the same as the form and terms of the Notes in all
material respects except that the Exchange Notes have been registered under the
Securities Act and hence do not include certain rights to registration
thereunder and do not contain transfer restrictions or terms with respect to the
special interest payments applicable to the Notes.  Once the Exchange Offer is
consummated, Hudson RCI will have no further obligations to register any of the
Notes not tendered by the Holders for exchange.  See "Risk Factors--Consequences
to Non-Tendering Holders of Notes".  A copy of the Exchange Offer Registration
Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which
this Prospectus is a part.

     Based on interpretations by the staff of the Commission set forth in
several no-action letters issued to third parties, the Company believes that
Exchange Notes issued pursuant to the Exchange Offer in exchange for Notes may
be offered for resale, resold and otherwise transferred by holders thereof
without compliance with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of
the Securities Act, provided that such Exchange Notes are acquired in the
ordinary course of such holders' business and such holders have no such
arrangement with any person to participate in the distribution of such Exchange
Notes.  However, the Company does not intend to request the Commission to
consider, and the Commission has not considered, the Exchange Offer in a no-
action letter and there can be no assurance that the Commission would make a
similar determination with respect to the Exchange Offer.  However, any Holder
who is an "affiliate" of the Company or who intends to participate in the
Exchange Offer for the purpose of distributing the Exchange Notes (i) cannot
rely on the interpretation by the staff of the Commission set forth in the above
referenced no-action letters, (ii) cannot tender its Notes in the Exchange
Offer, and (iii) must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery
requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any sale or transfer of
the Notes, unless such sale or transfer is made pursuant to an exemption from
such requirements.  See "Risk Factors--Consequences to Non-Tendering Holders of
Notes".

     In addition, each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own
account in exchange for Notes, where such Notes were acquired by such broker-
dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities and
not acquired directly from the Company, must acknowledge that it will deliver a
copy of this Prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes.
See "Plan of Distribution".

     Except as aforesaid, this Prospectus may not be used for an offer to
resell, resale or other transfer of Exchange Notes.

                                       21
<PAGE>
 
TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

     General

     Upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the Exchange Offer set
forth in this Prospectus and in the Letter of Transmittal, the Company will
accept any and all Notes validly tendered and not withdrawn prior to 5:00 p.m.,
New York City time, on the Expiration Date.  The Company will issue $1,000
principal amount of Exchange Notes in exchange for each $1,000 principal
outstanding Notes accepted in the Exchange Offer.  Holders may tender some or
all of their Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer.  However, Exchange Notes may
be tendered only in integral multiples of $1,000.

     As of April 7, 1998, there was $115.0 million aggregate principal amount of
the Notes outstanding and one registered Holder of Notes.  This Prospectus,
together with the Letter of Transmittal, is being sent to such registered Holder
as of August 26, 1998.

     In connection with the issuance of the Notes, the Company arranged for the
Notes to be issued and transferable in book-entry form through the facilities of
DTC, acting as depository.  The Exchange Notes also will be issued and
transferable in book-entry form through DTC.  See "Description of Exchange
Notes--Form, Denomination and Book-Entry Procedures."

     The Company shall be deemed to have accepted validly tendered Notes when,
as and if the Company has given oral or written notice thereof to the Exchange
Agent.  The Exchange Agent will act as agent for the tendering Holders of Notes
for the purpose of receiving the Exchange Notes from the Company.

     If any tendered Notes are not accepted for exchange because of an invalid
tender, the occurrence of certain other events set forth herein or otherwise,
certificates for any such unaccepted Notes will be returned, without expense, to
the tendering Holder thereof as promptly as practicable after the Expiration
Date.

     Holders of Notes who tender in the Exchange Offer will not be required to
pay brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in the Letter
of Transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the exchange of Notes pursuant to
the Exchange Offer.  The Company will pay the expenses, other than certain
applicable taxes, of the Exchange Offer.  See "--Fees and Expenses."

     Expiration Date; Extensions; Amendments

     The term "Expiration Date" shall mean September 25, 1998, unless the
Company in its sole discretion, extends the Exchange Offer, in which case the
term "Expiration Date" shall mean the latest date to which the Exchange Offer is
extended.

     In order to extend the Expiration Date, the Company will notify the
Exchange Agent and the record Holders of Notes of any extension by oral or
written notice, each prior to 9:00 a.m., New York City time, on the next
business day after the previously scheduled expiration date.  Such notice may
state that the Company is extending the Exchange Offer for a specified period of
time or on a daily basis until 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the date on
which a specified percentage of Notes are tendered.

     The Company reserves the right to delay accepting any Notes, to extend the
Exchange Offer, to amend the Exchange Offer or to terminate the Exchange Offer
and not accept Notes not previously accepted if any of the conditions set forth
herein under "--Conditions" shall have occurred and shall not have been waived
by the Company by giving oral or written notice of such delay, extension,
amendment or termination to the Exchange Agent.  Any such delay in acceptance,
extension, amendment or termination will be followed as promptly as practicable
by oral or written notice thereof.  If the Exchange Offer is amended in a manner
determined by the Company to constitute a material change, the Company will
promptly disclose such amendment in a manner reasonably calculated to inform the
Holders of such amendment and the Company will extend the Exchange Offer for a
period of five to 10 business days, depending upon the significance of the
amendment and the manner of

                                       22
<PAGE>
 
disclosure to Holders of the Notes, if the Exchange Offer would otherwise expire
during such five to 10 business day period.

     Without limiting the manner in which the Company may choose to make public
announcement of any extension, amendment or termination of the Exchange Offer,
the Company shall have no obligation to publish, advertise, or otherwise
communicate any such public announcement, other than by making a timely release
to the Dow Jones News Service.

ACCRUED INTEREST ON THE EXCHANGE NOTES AND THE NOTES

     The Exchange Notes will bear interest at a rate equal to 9 1/8% per annum
from their date of issuance. Interest on the Exchange Notes is payable semi-
annually on April 15 and October 15 of each year, commencing on October 15,
1998. Holders whose Notes are accepted for exchange will receive, in cash,
accrued interest thereon to, but excluding, the date of issuance of the Exchange
Notes. Such interest will be paid with the first interest payment on the
Exchange Notes. Interest on the Notes accepted for exchange will cease to accrue
upon cancellation of the Notes and issuance of the Exchange Notes. Holders of
Notes whose Notes are not exchanged will receive the accrued interest payable on
October 15, 1998.

PROCEDURES FOR TENDERING

     To tender in the Exchange Offer, a Holder must complete, sign and date the
Letter of Transmittal, or a facsimile thereof, have the signatures thereon
guaranteed if required by Instruction 4 of the Letter of Transmittal, and mail
or otherwise deliver such Letter of Transmittal or such facsimile, together with
the Notes and any other required documents, to the Exchange Agent prior to 5:00
p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date.

     Any financial institution that is a participant in DTC's Book-Entry
Transfer Facility system may make book-entry delivery of the Notes by causing
DTC to transfer such Notes into the Exchange Agent's account in accordance with
DTC's procedure for such transfer.  Although delivery of Notes may be effected
through book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's account at DTC, the Letter
of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof), with any required signature guarantees
and any other required documents, must, in any case, be transmitted to and
received or confirmed by the Exchange Agent at its address set forth in "--
Exchange Agent" below prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration
Date.  DELIVERY OF DOCUMENTS TO DTC IN ACCORDANCE WITH ITS PROCEDURES DOES NOT
CONSTITUTE DELIVERY TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT.

     The tender by a Holder will constitute an agreement between such Holder and
the Company in accordance with the terms and subject to the conditions set forth
herein and in the Letter of Transmittal.

     Delivery of all documents must be made to the Exchange Agent at its address
set forth below.  Holders may also request their respective brokers, dealers,
commercial banks, trust companies or nominees to effect the above transactions
for such Holders.

     The method of delivery of Notes and the Letter of Transmittal and all other
required documents to the Exchange Agent is at the election and risk of the
Holders.  Instead of delivery by mail, it is recommended that Holders use an
overnight or hand delivery service.  In all cases, sufficient time should be
allowed to assure timely delivery.  No Letter of Transmittal or Notes should be
sent to the Company.

     Only a Holder of Notes may tender such Notes in the Exchange Offer.  The
term "Holder" with respect to the Exchange Offer means any person in whose name
Notes are registered on the books of the Company or any other person who has
obtained a properly completed bond power from the registered Holder.

     ANY BENEFICIAL HOLDER WHOSE NOTES ARE REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF ITS BROKER,
DEALER, COMMERCIAL BANK, TRUST COMPANY OR OTHER NOMINEE AND WHO WISHES TO TENDER
SHOULD CONTACT SUCH REGISTERED HOLDER PROMPTLY AND INSTRUCT SUCH REGISTERED
HOLDER TO CONSENT AND/OR TENDER ON ITS BEHALF.  IF SUCH BENEFICIAL HOLDER WISHES
TO TENDER ON ITS OWN BEHALF, SUCH BENEFICIAL HOLDER MUST, PRIOR TO COMPLETING
AND EXECUTING THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL AND DELIVERING ITS NOTES, EITHER MAKE
APPROPRIATE ARRANGEMENTS TO REGISTER OWNERSHIP OF THE NOTES

                                       23
<PAGE>
 
IN SUCH HOLDER'S NAME OR OBTAIN A PROPERLY COMPLETED BOND POWER FROM THE
REGISTERED HOLDER.  THE TRANSFER OF RECORD OWNERSHIP MAY TAKE CONSIDERABLE TIME.

     Signatures on a Letter of Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal, as the
case may be, must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution (as defined below)
unless the Notes tendered pursuant thereto are tendered (i) by a registered
Holder who has not completed the box entitled "Special Payment Instructions" or
"Special Delivery Instructions" on the Letter of Transmittal or (ii) for the
account of an Eligible Institution.  In the event that signatures on a Letter of
Transmittal or a notice of withdrawal, as the case may be, are required to be
guaranteed, such guarantee must be by an "Eligible Guarantor Institution" within
the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended, which is a member of one of the following recognized signature
guarantee programs:  (i) the Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program
(STAMP), (ii) the New York Stock Exchange Medallion Signature Program (MSP) or
(iii) the Stock Exchange Medallion Program (SEMP) (an "Eligible Institution").

     If the Letter of Transmittal is signed by a person other than the
registered Holder of any Notes listed therein, such Notes must be endorsed or
accompanied by appropriate bond powers signed as the name of the registered
Holder or Holders appears on the Notes.

     If the Letter of Transmittal or any Notes or powers of attorney are signed
by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers
of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such
persons should so indicate when signing, and unless waived by the Company,
evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority to so act must be
submitted with the Letter of Transmittal.

     All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility (including time of
receipt) and acceptance of tendered Notes and withdrawal of tendered Notes will
be determined by the Company in its sole discretion, which determination will be
final and binding.  The Company reserves the absolute right to reject any and
all Notes not properly tendered or any Notes the Company's acceptance of which
would, in the opinion of counsel for the Company, be unlawful.  The Company also
reserves the right to waive any defects, irregularities or conditions of tender
as to particular Notes.  The Company's interpretation of the terms and
conditions of the Exchange Offer (including the instructions in the Letter of
Transmittal) will be final and binding on all parties.  Unless waived, any
defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of Notes must be cured
within such time as the Company shall determine.  Neither the Company, the
Exchange Agent nor any other person shall be under any duty to give notification
of defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of Notes, nor shall any of
them incur any liability for failure to give such notification.  Tenders of
Notes will not be deemed to have been made until such irregularities have been
cured or waived.  Any Notes received by the Exchange Agent that are not properly
tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not been cured or
waived will be returned by the Exchange Agent to the tendering Holders of Notes,
unless otherwise provided in the Letter of Transmittal, as soon as practicable
following the Expiration Date.

     In addition, the Company reserves the right in its sole discretion to
purchase or make offers for any Notes that remain outstanding subsequent to the
Expiration Date or, as set forth under "--Conditions," to terminate the Exchange
Offer and, to the extent permitted by applicable law, purchase Notes in the open
market, in privately negotiated transactions or otherwise.  The terms of any
such purchases or offers could differ from the terms of the Exchange Offer.

     By tendering, each Holder will represent to the Company that, among other
things, the Exchange Notes acquired pursuant to the Exchange Offer are being
obtained in the ordinary course of such Holder's business, that such Holder has
no arrangement with any person to participate in the distribution of such
Exchange Notes, and that such Holder is not an "affiliate", as defined under
Rule 405 of the Securities Act, of the Company.  If the Holder is a broker-
dealer that will receive Exchange Notes for its own account in exchange for
Notes that were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other
trading activities and not acquired directly from the Company, such Holder by
tendering will acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with
any resale of such Exchange Notes.  See "Plan of Distribution."

                                       24
<PAGE>
 
GUARANTEED DELIVERY PROCEDURES

     Holders who wish to tender their Notes and (i) whose Notes are not
immediately available, or (ii) who cannot deliver their Notes, the Letter of
Transmittal or any other required documents to the Exchange Agent prior to the
Expiration Date, may effect a tender if:

     (a) The tender is made through an Eligible Institution;
    
     (b) Prior to the Expiration Date, the Exchange Agent receives from such
Eligible Institution a properly completed and duly executed Notice of Guaranteed
Delivery (the "Notice of Guaranteed Delivery") (by facsimile transmission, mail
or hand delivery) setting forth the name and address of the Holder of the Notes,
the certificate number or numbers of such Notes and the principal amount of
Notes tendered, stating that the tender is being made thereby and guaranteeing
that, within three New York Stock Exchange trading days after the Expiration
Date, the Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof) together with the
certificate(s) representing the Notes to be tendered in proper form for transfer
(or a confirmation of a book-entry transfer into the Exchange Agent's account at
DTC of Notes delivered electronically) and any other documents required by the
Letter of Transmittal will be deposited by the Eligible Institution with the
Exchange Agent; and     

     (c) Such properly completed and executed Letter of Transmittal (or
facsimile thereof), as well as the certificate(s) representing all tendered
Notes in proper form for transfer (or confirmation of a book-entry transfer into
the Exchange Agent's account at DTC of Notes delivered electronically) and all
other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal are received by the
Exchange Agent within five New York Stock Exchange trading days after the
Expiration Date.

Upon request of the Exchange Agent, a Notice of Guaranteed Delivery will be sent
to Holders who wish to tender their Notes according to the guaranteed delivery
procedures set forth above.

WITHDRAWAL OF TENDERS

     Except as otherwise provided herein, tenders of Notes may be withdrawn at
any time prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the Expiration Date.  To
withdraw a tender of Notes in the Exchange Offer, a written or facsimile
transmission notice of withdrawal must be received by the Exchange Agent at its
address set forth herein prior to 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on the
Expiration Date.  Any such notice of withdrawal must (i) specify the name of the
person having deposited the Notes to be withdrawn (the "Depositor"), (ii)
identify the Notes to be withdrawn (including the certificate number or numbers
and principal amount of such Notes), (iii) be signed by the Holder in the same
manner as the original signature on the Letter of Transmittal by which such
Notes were tendered (including any required signature guarantees) or be
accompanied by documents of transfer sufficient to have the Trustee with respect
to the Notes register the transfer of such Notes into the name of the person
withdrawing the tender, and (iv) specify the name in which any such Notes are to
be registered, if different from that of the Depositor.  All questions as to the
validity, form and eligibility (including time of receipt) of such notices will
be determined by the Company, whose determination shall be final and binding on
all parties.  Any Notes so withdrawn will be deemed not to have been validly
tendered for purposes of the Exchange Offer and no Exchange Notes will be issued
with respect thereto unless the Notes so withdrawn are validly retendered.  Any
Notes which have been tendered but which are not accepted for payment will be
returned to the Holder thereof without cost to such Holder as soon as
practicable after withdrawal, rejection of tender or termination of the Exchange
Offer.  Properly withdrawn Notes may be retendered by following one of the
procedures described above under "--Procedures for Tendering" at any time prior
to the Expiration Date.

CONDITIONS

     Notwithstanding any other term of the Exchange Offer, the Company will not
be required to accept for exchange, or exchange Exchange Notes for, any Notes
not theretofore accepted for exchange, and may terminate

                                       25
<PAGE>
 
or amend the Exchange Offer as provided herein before the acceptance of such
Notes, if any of the following conditions exist:

     (a) the Exchange Offer, or the making of any exchange by a Holder, violates
applicable law or any applicable interpretation of the Commission; or

     (b) any action or proceeding is instituted or threatened in any court or by
or before any governmental agency with respect to the Exchange Offer which, in
the sole judgment of the Company, might impair the ability of the Company to
proceed with the Exchange Offer; or

     (c) there shall have been adopted or enacted any law, statute, rule or
regulation which, in the sole judgment of the Company, might materially impair
the ability of the Company to proceed with the Exchange Offer.

     If any such conditions exist, the Company may (i) refuse to accept any
Notes and return all tendered Notes to exchanging Holders, (ii) extend the
Exchange Offer and retain all Notes tendered prior to the expiration of the
Exchange Offer, subject, however, to the rights of Holders to withdraw such
Notes (see "--Withdrawal of Tenders") or (iii) waive certain of such conditions
with respect to the Exchange Offer and accept all properly tendered Notes which
have not been withdrawn or revoked.  If such waiver constitutes a material
change to the Exchange Offer, the Company will promptly disclose such waiver in
a manner reasonably calculated to inform Holders of Notes of such waiver.

     The foregoing conditions are for the sole benefit of the Company and may be
asserted by the Company regardless of the circumstances giving rise to any such
condition or may be waived by the Company in whole or in part at any time and
from time to time in its sole discretion.  The failure by the Company at any
time to exercise any of the foregoing rights shall not be deemed a waiver of any
such right and each such right shall be deemed an ongoing right which may be
asserted at any time and from time to time.

     In addition to the foregoing conditions, if, because of any change in
applicable law or applicable interpretations thereof by the Commission, the
Company is not permitted to complete the Exchange Offer, then the Company shall
file a Shelf Registration Statement.  Thereafter, the Company's obligation to
consummate the Exchange Offer shall be terminated.

EXCHANGE AGENT

     United States Trust Company of New York has been appointed as Exchange
Agent for the Exchange Offer.  Questions and requests for assistance, requests
for additional copies of this Prospectus or of the Letter of Transmittal and
requests for Notices of Guaranteed Delivery should be directed to the Exchange
Agent addressed as follows:

<TABLE>

<S>                                                    <C> 

      By Registered or Certified Mail:                 By Overnight Courier and By Hand
                                                       after 4:30 p.m.:


      United States Trust Company of New York          United States Trust Company of New York
      P.O. Box 844 Cooper Station                      770 Broadway, 13th Floor
      New York, New York 10276                         New York, New York 10003
      Attention:  Corporate Trust Services

      By Hand before 4:30 p.m.:                        By Facsimile:

      United States Trust Company of New York          (212) 780-0592
      111 Broadway                                     Attention: Customer Service
      New York, New York 10006
      Attention:  Lower Level                          Confirm by telephone:
                  Corporate Trust Window               (800) 548-6565
</TABLE>

                                       26
<PAGE>
 
FEES AND EXPENSES

     The expenses of soliciting tenders will be borne by the Company.  The
principal solicitation is being made by mail; however, additional solicitation
may be made by telegraph, telephone or in person by officers and regular
employees of the Company and its affiliates.

     The Company will not make any payments to brokers, dealers or others
soliciting acceptances of the Exchange Offer.  The Company, however, will pay
the Exchange Agent reasonable and customary fees for its services and will
reimburse it for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection therewith.
The Company may also pay brokerage houses and other custodians, nominees and
fiduciaries the reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in forwarding
copies of the Prospectus and related documents to the beneficial owners of the
Notes, and in handling or forwarding tenders for exchange.

     The cash expenses to be incurred in connection with the Exchange Offer will
be paid by the Company, are estimated in the aggregate to be approximately
$200,000, and include fees and expenses of the Exchange Agent and Trustee under
the Indenture and accounting and legal fees.

     The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the exchange
of Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer.  If, however, certificates representing
Exchange Notes or Notes for principal amounts not tendered or accepted for
exchange are to be delivered to, or are to be registered or issued in the name
of, any person other than the registered Holder of the Notes tendered, or if
tendered Notes are registered in the name of any person other than the person
signing the Letter of Transmittal, or if a transfer tax is imposed for any
reason other than the exchange of Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, then the
amount of any such transfer taxes (whether imposed on the registered holder or
any other persons) will be payable by the tendering Holder.  If satisfactory
evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted with
the Letter of Transmittal, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed
directly to such tendering Holder.

ACCOUNTING TREATMENT

     The Exchange Notes will be recorded at the same carrying value as the
Notes, which is face value as reflected in the Company's accounting records on
the date of the exchange.  Accordingly, no gain or loss for accounting purposes
will be recognized upon consummation of the Exchange Offer.  The issuance costs
incurred in connection with the Exchange Offer will be expensed.

                                       27
<PAGE>
 
      SELECTED HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
    
     The selected fiscal year end historical financial data has been derived
from the audited financial statements of the Company. The selected pro forma
financial data has been derived from the pro forma financial statements included
elsewhere in this Prospectus and gives effect to the Recapitalization as if it
had occurred at the beginning of the period presented with respect to the
operating and other financial data, and as of June 26, 1998 with respect to
balance sheet data. The financial data for the six months ended June 27, 1997
and June 26, 1998 and as of June 26, 1998 has been derived from unaudited
financial statements included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected pro
forma financial data does not necessarily represent what the Company's financial
position and results of operations would have been if these transactions had
actually been completed as of the dates indicated, and is not intended to
project the Company's financial position or results of operations for any future
period. Fiscal year 1993 was a 53 week year and fiscal years 1994, 1995, 1996
and 1997 were 52 week years. The information contained in this table should be
read in conjunction with the Company's audited consolidated financial statements
and notes thereto at December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997 and for each of the
three years in the period ended December 26, 1997, unaudited financial
statements and notes thereto for the six months ended June 27, 1997 and June 26,
1998 and as of June 26, 1998 and the pro forma consolidated financial statements
and notes thereto, included elsewhere in this Prospectus.      
<TABLE>     
<CAPTION>
                                                                  FISCAL YEAR
                             --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                         PRO           
                                                                                                        FORMA          
                                1993           1994           1995           1996           1997         1997 
                             ----------     ----------     ----------     ----------     ---------      ------
                                                  (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)                 
<S>                          <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>            <C> 
OPERATING DATA:                                             
Net sales.................    $79,111        $82,772        $86,825        $93,842        $99,509        $99,509  
Cost of sales.............     46,476         47,631         47,582         49,405         51,732         51,732  
                              -------        -------        -------        -------        -------        -------  
Gross profit..............     32,635         35,141         39,243         44,437         47,777         47,777  
Operating expenses:
Selling expenses..........      7,070          7,499          8,283          8,961          9,643          9,643  
Distribution expenses.....      4,743          4,543          4,595          4,829          5,240          5,240  
General and administrative               
 expenses.................      9,732         10,426          9,769         11,277         11,456         10,617(b)
Research and development              
 expenses.................      2,880          1,983          2,064          2,253          1,845          1,845  

Provision for equity       
 participation plan.......         --             --         11,415          8,249          6,954             --(d)

Provision for retention 
 payments.................         --             --             --             --             --             --
                              -------        -------        -------        -------        -------        -------    
Operating income (loss)...      8,210         10,690          3,117          8,868         12,639         20,432  

OTHER (INCOME) AND 
 EXPENSES:
Interest expense..........      2,253          2,299          2,424          2,177          1,834         15,099(e)
Other (income)/expense....        600            546            811           (463)          (638)          (638)
                              -------        -------        -------        -------        -------        ------- 
Total other expenses......      2,853          2,845          3,235          1,714          1,196         19,461  
                              -------        -------        -------        -------        -------        -------  
Income (loss) before       
 provision for income      
 taxes....................      5,357          7,845           (118)         7,154         11,443          5,971
Provision (benefit) for 
 income taxes.............        181            175            280             73            150          2,389(g) 
                              -------        -------        -------        -------        -------        -------  
Income (loss) before  
 extraordinary item.......      5,176          7,670           (398)         7,081         11,293          3,582
Extraordinary item
 (loss on extinguishment 
 of debt)(h)..............         --             --             --             --             --            --
                              -------        -------        -------        -------        -------        -------  
Net income (loss).........    $ 5,176        $ 7,670        $  (398)       $ 7,081        $11,293        $ 3,582(i)
                              =======        =======        =======        =======        =======        =======

                           
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
Net cash provided by (used 
 in) operating activities.    $12,784        $12,017       $ 15,939       $ 16,133       $ 19,269
Net cash used in investing 
 activities...............    $(6,073)       $(2,607)      $ (6,088)      $(11,354)      $ (3,673)
Net cash provided by (used
 in) financing activities.    $(5,910)       $(9,653)      $(11,880)      $ (3,668)      $(16,398)
EBITDA before EPP and
 Retention Payments(j)....    $15,422        $17,354       $ 21,205       $ 23,194       $ 25,440        $26,279  
EBITDA before EPP and 
 Retention Payments
 margin(k)................       19.5%          21.0%          24.4%          24.7%          25.6%          26.4% 
Operating margin before     
 EPP and Retention
 Payments(l)..............       10.4%          12.9%          16.7%          18.2%          19.7%          20.5% 
Depreciation &              
 amortization(m)..........    $ 7,630        $ 7,033       $  6,820       $  6,133       $  5,847        $ 7,190(n)
Capital expenditures......    $ 9,112        $ 4,898       $  5,850       $  6,395       $  4,659        $ 4,659  
Ratio of EBITDA before     
 EPP and Retention Payments
 to cash interest      
 expense(o)...............        6.8x           7.5x           8.7x          10.7x          13.9x           1.9x
Ratio of total debt to     
 EBITDA before EPP and 
 Retention Payments.......        2.3x           1.8x           1.2x           1.2x           0.8x           5.9x
Ratio of earnings to       
 fixed charges(p).........        2.7x           3.6x           1.0x           3.7x           6.0x           1.3x 
Deficiency in earnings to
 fixed charges(p)......... 

BALANCE SHEET DATA:       
Working capital...........    $18,187        $18,926       $ 18,641       $ 24,188       $  6,430                       
Working capital as
 adjusted(q)..............     20,423         20,588         22,461         26,768         29,960                       
Total assets..............     66,870         66,576         64,387         76,910         77,754                       
Total debt................     35,167         31,607         25,364         28,146         20,250                       
Shareholders' equity      
 (deficit)................     23,693         25,269         19,112         19,872         22,515                       
                                                        
<CAPTION> 
                                  SIX MONTHS ENDED (UNAUDITED)
                             --------------------------------------
                                                              PRO    
                                                             FORMA   
                               JUNE          JUNE             JUNE   
                                27,           26,              26,   
                               1997          1998             1998   
                              ------        ------           ------   
                                                        
<S>                          <C>            <C>            <C>      
OPERATING DATA:    
Net sales.................    $49,093       $46,697         $ 46,697   
Cost of sales.............     25,388        25,142(a)        25,142   
                              -------       -------         --------   
Gross profit..............     23,705        21,255           21,555   
Operating expenses:                                                    
Selling expenses..........      4,789         4,691            4,691   
Distribution expenses.....      2,547         2,698            2,698   
General and administrative                                             
 expenses.................      5,498         5,676(c)         5,504(b)
Research and development                                               
 expenses.................        895           940              940   

Provision for equity                                                   
 participation plan.......      3,654        63,939               --(d)

Provision for retention
 payments.................         --         4,754(e)            --
                              -------       -------         --------   
Operating income (loss)...      6,322       (61,143)           7,722   

OTHER (INCOME) AND 
 EXPENSES:                                  
Interest expense..........        950         3,640            7,550(f) 
Other (income)/expense....       (645)          254              254   
                              -------       -------         --------   
Total other expenses......        305         3,894            7,804   
                              -------       -------         --------   
Income (loss) before                                                   
 provision for income                                                  
 taxes....................      6,017       (65,037)             (82)
Provision (benefit) for                                                 
 income taxes                     260       (76,978)             (33)(g)
                              -------       -------         --------    
Income (loss) before
 extraordinary item.......      5,757        11,941             (49)
Extraordinary item (loss 
 on extinguishment of
 debt)(h)..................        --           104              --
                              -------       -------         --------    
Net income (loss)..........   $ 5,757      $ 11,837         $    (49)(i)
                              =======       =======         ========   
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:                                                 
Net cash provided by (used 
 in) operating activities..   $12,273      $(78,011) 
Net cash used in investing 
 activities................   $  (994)     $ (1,646) 
Net cash provided by (used
 in) financing activities.   $(13,745)     $ 84,509 
EBITDA before EPP and 
 Retention Payments(j)....    $12,846      $ 10,061         $ 10,233   
EBITDA before EPP and 
 Retention Payments
 margin(k)................       26.2%         21.5%            21.9%  
Operating margin before                                                 
 EPP and Retention
 Payments(l)..............       20.3%         16.2%            16.5%   
Depreciation &                                                           
 amortization(m)..........    $ 2,901      $  2,992         $  3,215(n)
Capital expenditures......    $ 2,049      $  1,646         $  1,646  
Ratio of EBITDA before                                                
 EPP and Retention 
 Payments to cash interest                                                 
 expense(o)...............                                            
Ratio of total debt to                                                
 EBITDA before EPP and 
 Retention Payments.......                                            
Ratio of earnings to                                                  
 fixed charges(p).........        6.1x                           
Deficiency in earnings to 
 fixed charges(p).........                 $(65,037)        $    (82)
BALANCE SHEET DATA:                                                   
Working capital...........      $24,639    $ 23,509         
Working capital as                     
 adjusted(q)..............       26,654      18,842
Total assets..............       74,828     165,032
Total debt................       23,625     153,000
Shareholders' equity                                                  
 (deficit)................       42,531     (31,864)                
</TABLE>      

                                                     footnotes on following page

                                       28
<PAGE>
 
______________________
    
(a) For a discussion of the change in cost of goods sold, see "Management's
    Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations--
    Results of Operations--Six Months Ended June 26, 1998 Compared to Six Months
    Ended June 27, 1997."    
(b) The pro forma general and administrative expense reflects the following
    (amounts in thousands):

<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  December 26,     June 26,
                                                                                      1997           1998
                                                                               ----------------------------
<S>                                                                               <C>             <C>
  Actual general and administrative expense....................................        $11,456       $5,676
  Elimination of Continuing Shareholder salary, bonus and fringe benefits(1)...           (455)         (87)
  Elimination of expenses related to OxyAir(2).................................           (384)         (85)
                                                                                       -------       ------ 
  Total........................................................................        $10,617       $5,504
                                                                                       =======       ======
</TABLE>     
______________
    (1) The Company will not continue to pay Continuing Shareholder salary,
        bonus and related fringe benefits. The adjustment is to eliminate such
        expenses.
    (2) Reflects the elimination of expense related to OxyAir since OxyAir was
        transferred to the Continuing Shareholder.
    
(c) Includes $0.3 million of legal fees related to patent litigation in which
    the Company was granted favorable summary judgment during the six months
    ended June 26, 1998. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
    Condition and Results of Operations--Results of Operations--Six Months Ended
    June 26, 1998 Compared to Six Months Ended June 27, 1997."    
        
(d) Reflects the elimination of the Equity Participation Plan. For purposes of
    compliance with the Indenture, the Company's Consolidated Net Income and
    EBITDA will not be reduced by the amount of any contingent payments made by
    the Company to former participants in the Equity Participation Plan. See
    "Summary--The Recapitalization" and "Certain Transactions." Additional
    payments to former Equity Participation Plan participants will be expensed
    as earned.     
    
(e) Reflects retention bonuses paid to substantially every employee of the
    Company in connection with the Recapitalization. These bonuses were intended
    to ensure the continued employment of all employees after the
    Recapitalization and no future payments are anticipated.    
    
(f) Pro forma interest expense, including amortization of deferred financing
    fees related to the Recapitalization, consists of the following (amounts in
    thousands):     
<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          December 26,  June 26,
                                                                                           1997          1998
                                                                                     -----------------------------
<S>                                                                                     <C>            <C>
  Interest expense on bank facility at an assumed composite interest rate of 8.00%...        $ 3,200      $1,600
  Interest expense on Senior Subordinated Notes at an interest rate of 9.125%........         10,494       5,247
  Amortization of deferred finance fees(1)...........................................          1,405         703
                                                                                             -------      ------ 
  Total..............................................................................        $15,099      $7,550
                                                                                             =======      ======
</TABLE>     
______________
(1) Amortization of deferred debt financing costs relating to the
    Recapitalization are excluded from the calculation of the Company's
    Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio under the Indenture.
         
    
(g) Reflects the income tax effect of the net changes described above, using an
    effective tax rate of 40%.     
    
(h) Reflects the write-off of deferred financing fees related to the payoff of
    outstanding debt under the Company's credit agreement existing prior to the
    New Credit Facility.    
    
(i) For purposes of compliance with the Indenture, the Company's Consolidated
    Net Income will not be reduced by the amount of any contingent payments made
    by the Company to former participants in the Equity Participation Plan.  See
    "Summary--The Recapitalization" and "Certain Transactions."     
        
(j) EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments represents income before
    depreciation and amortization, interest expense, income tax expense,
    retention payments made to employees and charges related to the Company's
    Equity Participation Plan, which was terminated upon consummation of the
    Recapitalization. The Company has excluded payments under the Equity
    Participation Plan and retention payments made to employees to present
    comparable figures for all historical periods presented. EBITDA before EPP
    and Retention Payments is not a measure of performance under generally
    accepted accounting principles, and should not be considered as a substitute
    for net income, cash flows from operating activities and other income or
    cash flow statement data prepared in accordance with generally accepted
    accounting principles, or as a measure of profitability or liquidity. The
    Company has included information concerning EBITDA before EPP and Retention
    Payments as one measure of an issuer's historical ability to service debt.
    In addition, certain covenants in the Indenture are based upon a calculation
    analogous to EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments. EBITDA before EPP and
    Retention Payments should not be considered as an alternative to, or more
    meaningful than, income from operations or cash flow as an indication of the
    Company's operating performance. For purposes of compliance with the
    Indenture, the Company's Consolidated Net Income and EBITDA will not be
    reduced by retention payments, payments made pursuant to the Equity
    Participation Plan or by the amount    

                                       29
<PAGE>
 
    of any contingent payments made by the Company to former participants in the
    Equity Participation Plan.  See "Summary--The Recapitalization" and "Certain
    Transactions."
        
(k) Represents ratio of EBITDA before EPP and retention payments to net
    sales.    
    
(l) Represents ratio of Operating income before EPP and retention payments to
    net sales.    
        
(m) Includes amortization of deferred financing fees of $0.4 million in 1993,
    $0.4 million in 1994, $0.1 million in 1995 and $0.1 million in 1996, which
    should be excluded from depreciation and amortization in calculating EBITDA
    before EPP and Retention Payments since such fees are reflected below the
    operating income line.    
            
(n) Actual 1997 amortization of deferred financing fees has been replaced with
    pro forma non-cash amortization of deferred financing fees of approximately
    $1.4 million associated with the Recapitalization. Actual amortization for
    the six months ended June 26, 1998 has been replaced by pro forma
    amortization of $0.7 million associated with the Recapitalization.     
    
(o) Excludes approximately $1.4 million of non-cash amortization expense for
    1997 relating to deferred debt financing costs relating to the
    Recapitalization. This amount is also excluded from the calculation of the
    Company's Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio under the Indenture.     
        
(p) For the purpose of determining the ratio of earnings to fixed charges,
    earnings consist of earnings before income taxes and fixed charges.  Fixed
    charges consist of interest on indebtedness, the amortization of debt issue
    costs and that portion of operating rental expense representative of the
    interest factor.     
        
(q) Working capital as adjusted represents current assets, excluding cash, less
    current liabilities, excluding the current portion of long-term debt. Actual
    1997 current liabilities excludes the management bonus liability of $20.0
    million. See Note 7(c) to Consolidated Financial Statements.     

                                       30
<PAGE>
 
                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     The following discussion of the Company's consolidated historical results
of operations and financial condition should be read in conjunction with the
consolidated financial statements of the Company and the notes thereto included
elsewhere in this Prospectus.  The following discussion and analysis covers
periods before completion of the Recapitalization.  See "Risk Factors" and Pro
Forma Consolidated Financial Statements for a further discussion relating to the
effect that the transactions described herein may have on the Company.

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS AND OUTLOOK

     The Company is a leading manufacturer and marketer of disposable medical
products utilized in the respiratory care and anesthesia segments of the
domestic and international health care markets.  The Company's principal
products include oxygen masks, humidification systems, nebulizers, cannulae and
tubing.  In the United States, the Company markets its products to a variety of
health care providers, including hospitals and alternate site service providers
such as outpatient surgery centers, long-term care facilities, physician offices
and home health care agencies.  Internationally, the Company sells its products
to distributors who market to hospitals and other health care providers.  In
1997, 63.6% of the Company's net sales were generated from the domestic hospital
market, 19.1% from the export market, 14.7% from alternate site provider market
and 2.7% from OEM and other markets.  The Company's products are sold to over
2,500 distributors and alternate site service providers throughout the United
States and in more than 75 countries worldwide.
        
     The Company has reported increased annual net sales and EBITDA before EPP
and Retention Payments (the calculation used in certain material financial
covenants in the Indenture and the New Credit Facility) in each year since 1990.
Net sales increased from $79.1 million in fiscal 1993 to $99.5 million in fiscal
1997, representing a compound annual growth rate of 5.9%. From fiscal 1993 to
fiscal 1997, the Company's operating income increased from $8.2 million to $12.6
million, representing a compound annual growth rate of 11.4%. From fiscal 1993
to fiscal 1997, the Company's EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments increased
from $15.4 million to $25.4 million, representing a compound annual growth rate
of 13.3%. The more rapid increase in operating income and in EBITDA before EPP
and Retention Payments relative to net sales is the result of improvements in
operating income as a percentage of net sales from 10.4% in fiscal 1993 to 12.7%
in fiscal 1997 and in EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments as a percentage
of sales from 19.5% in fiscal 1993 to 25.6% in fiscal 1997. These margin
improvements were achieved during a period of heightened cost containment
affecting the health care market generally. See "Business--Industry Overview."
The Company attributes its ability to increase profit margins to its commitment
to cost reduction and operating efficiency. See "--Liquidity and Capital
Resources" for a discussion of certain cash flow information of the Company. 
     
     Consistent with the Company's business strategy, the Company has increased
its net sales and improved its position within the disposable health care
products market in recent years by increasing its respiratory care product
offering, introducing disposable products for the anesthesia health care market,
expanding its presence in international markets and establishing a position in
the growing alternate site market.

     Through consistent product development efforts, the Company continuously
evolves and improves its product offering to fully serve the respiratory care
market.  In addition to the respiratory care market, the Company developed and
introduced disposable products for the anesthesia market starting in 1995.
Since that time, sales of anesthesia products have increased and in 1997
contributed $6.5 million in net sales.  Net sales from new respiratory and
anesthesia products introduced since 1992 represented approximately 18% of the
Company's total net sales in fiscal 1997.  In 1994, the Company established a
sales force dedicated to sales of the Company's products to international
markets.  The international sales effort has focused largely on major and
growing markets for the Company's products.  In fiscal 1997, the Company's
products were sold to health care providers and distributors in more than 75
international markets representing $19.0 million in net sales.  See Note 8 to
Consolidated Financial Statements.  With the increasing trend toward providing
health care outside of traditional hospital settings and the rapid growth of
alternate site health care providers, the Company established in 1995 an
independent sales force dedicated to this market.  Sales of products to
alternate site distributors and/or health care providers represented
approximately $14.6 million in net sales in fiscal 1997.  The Company has
targeted the international, alternate site and anesthesia markets as key
components for future growth.

     The Company's results of operations may fluctuate significantly from
quarter to quarter as a result of a number of factors, including, among others,
the buying patterns of the Company's distributors, GPOs and other purchasers of
the Company's products, forecasts regarding the severity of the annual cold and
flu season,

                                       31
<PAGE>  
 
announcements of new product introductions by the Company or its competitors,
changes in the Company's pricing of its products and the prices offered by the
Company's competitors, rate of overhead absorption due to variability in
production levels and variability in the number of shipping days in a given
quarter.  

     Results for the second quarter of 1998 were adversely impacted because, 
among other things, of the decrease in demand from hospitals affiliated with the
Premier GPO, as the Premier contract for respiratory supplies was awarded to a 
competitor of the Company, and the discontinuance of a distribution-related 
strategic alliance in Germany with an international health care supplier.  As a 
result, the Company was not in compliance with certain covenants under the New
Credit Facility, so certain of the financial covenants in the New Credit 
Facility were amended.     
    
     On April 7, 1998, the Company consummated the Recapitalization. The
Recapitalization consisted of (i) the merger of River Acquisition Corp., a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Holding, with and into Hudson RCI, with Hudson RCI
surviving as a majority-owned subsidiary of Holding, (ii) a $93.0 million
investment by Holding in Hudson RCI, made up of the $63.0 million Common Stock
Investment and the $30.0 million Preferred Stock Investment, (iii) the $115.0
million Subordinated Notes Offering, (iv) the $30.0 million Preferred Stock
Offering, and (v) the $100.0 million New Credit Facility. See "Summary--The
Recapitalization." Immediately following consummation of the Recapitalization,
Holding owned approximately 80.8% of the outstanding common stock of Hudson RCI
and 100.0% of the outstanding preferred stock of Hudson RCI, and FS&Co. owned
approximately 87.3% of the outstanding common stock of Holding. The Company and
the shareholders that received distributions in the Recapitalization made an
election under Section 338(h)(10) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
amended, to treat the Recapitalization as an asset purchase for tax purposes,
which will have the effect of significantly increasing the basis of the
Company's assets, thus increasing depreciation and amortization expenses and
other deductions for tax purposes and reducing the Company's taxable income in
1998 and subsequent years. The Recapitalization resulted in no change in the
basis of the Company's assets and liabilities. The effect of the
Recapitalization, as if the transaction had occurred as of certain earlier
dates, is presented in the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Statements.

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     The following tables set forth, for the periods indicated, certain income
and expense items expressed in dollars and as a percentage of the Company's net
sales.

<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                                       FISCAL YEAR                      (unaudited)
                                                              -----------------------------     ---------------------------
                                                                                                   JUNE 27,      JUNE 26,
                                                                1995      1996       1997           1997           1998
                                                              --------  --------  ----------    -------------  ------------
                                                                                 (dollars in thousands)
<S>                                                              <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>
          Net sales...........................................    $86,825    $93,842    $99,509     $49,093     $46,697
          Cost of sales.......................................     47,582     49,405     51,732      25,388      25,142
                                                                 --------   --------   --------    --------    --------
            Gross profit......................................     39,243     44,437     47,777      23,705      21,555
                                                                 --------   --------   --------    --------    --------
          Selling expenses....................................      8,283      8,961      9,643       4,789       4,691
          Distribution expenses...............................      4,595      4,829      5,240       2,547       2,698
          General and administrative expenses.................      9,769     11,277     11,456       5,498       5,676
          Research and development expenses...................      2,064      2,253      1,845         895         940
          Provision for equity participation plan.............     11,415      8,249      6,954       3,654      63,939
          Provision for retention payments....................          -          -          -           -       4,754 
                                                                 --------   --------   --------    --------    --------
          Total operating expenses............................     36,126     35,569     35,138      17,383      82,698
                                                                 --------   --------   --------    --------    --------
          Operating income (loss).............................      3,117      8,868     12,639       6,322     (61,143)
          Add back: Provision for equity participation plan...     11,415      8,249      6,954       3,654      63,939
          Add back: Provision for retention payments..........         --         --         --          --       4,754
                                                                 --------   --------   --------    --------    --------
          Operating income before provision for equity            
           participation plan and provision for retention 
           payments...........................................    $14,532    $17,117    $19,593     $ 2,668     $ 7,550
                                                                 ========   ========   ========    ========    ========
</TABLE>     

                                       32
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                               FISCAL YEAR                 SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                                      -----------------------------   ---------------------------
                                                                                                        JUNE 27,       JUNE 26,
                                                                        1995      1996       1997         1997           1998
                                                                      --------  --------  ----------  -------------  ------------
<S>                                                                   <C>       <C>       <C>          <C>           <C>  
          Net sales...........................................           100.0%    100.0%      100.0%         100.0%        100.0%
          Cost of sales.......................................            54.8      52.6        52.0           51.7          53.8
                                                                      --------  --------  ----------  -------------  ------------
            Gross profit......................................            45.2      47.4        48.0           48.3          46.2
                                                                      --------  --------  ----------  -------------  ------------
          Selling expenses....................................             9.5       9.5         9.7            9.8          10.0
          Distribution expenses...............................             5.3       5.1         5.3            5.2           5.8
          General and administrative expenses.................            11.3      12.0        11.5           11.2          12.2
          Research and development expenses...................             2.4       2.4         1.9            1.8           2.0
          Provision for equity participation plan.............            13.1       8.8         7.0            7.4         136.9
          Provision for retention payments....................               -         -           -              -          10.2
                                                                      --------  --------  ----------  -------------  ------------
          Total operating expenses............................            41.6      37.9        35.3           35.4         177.1
                                                                      --------  --------  ----------  -------------  ------------
          Operating income (loss).............................             3.6       9.4        12.7           12.9        (130.9)
          Add back: Provision for equity participation plan...            13.1       8.8         7.0            7.4         136.9
          Add back: Provision for retention payments..........              --        --          --             --          10.2
                                                                      --------  --------  ----------  -------------  ------------
          Operating income before provision for equity
           participation plan and provision for retention 
           payments...........................................            16.7%     18.2%       19.7%           5.4%         16.2%
                                                                      ========  ========  ==========  =============  ============
</TABLE>     
         
    
Six Months Ended June 26, 1998 Compared to Six Months Ended June 27, 1997     
    
     Net sales, reported net of accrued rebates, were $46.7 million in the first
six months of 1998, a decrease of $2.4 million or 4.9% from the same period in
1997.  Domestic hospital sales declined by $2.9 million or 9.3%, due primarily
to the decrease in demand in hospitals affiliated with the Premier GPO as the
Premier contract for respiratory supplies was awarded to a competitor in
February, 1997.  Export sales declined by $0.2 million or 2.2%, primarily due to
loss of sales in southeast Asia as a result of the Asian economic crisis and a
slowdown in shipments to the European market due to delays in availability of CE
labeled product and inventory reduction programs by a large European
distributor.  Substantially all of the Company's high volume products are now in
compliance with CE labeling requirements and the shortfall represents a shift of
sales from the second quarter to the third quarter of 1998.  These shortfalls
were partially offset by an increase in alternate site sales of $0.7 million or
9.5% as the Company continues focus its sales efforts in this growing 
market.     
    
     The Company's gross profit for the first half of 1998 was $21.6 million, a
decline of $2.2 million or 9.1% from the first half of 1997. As a percentage of
sales, the Company's gross profit margin was 46.2% in the first half of 1998, as
compared to 48.3% in the first half of 1997. This decline was primarily due to
lower sales volumes in the first half of 1998 as compared to 1997 and due to
the under absorption of overhead resulting from the Company's efforts to reduce
inventory levels in combination with a relatively consistent level of sales
volumes. On an interim basis, the Company allocates actual manufacturing costs
between cost of sales and inventory based on actual production levels. The
Company decreased production and reduced inventories by $1.5 million in the
first half of 1998 as compared to an increase in inventories of $1.6 million in
the first half of 1997. The decline in inventories caused approximately $0.9
million of additional overhead to be charged to cost of sales in the first half
of 1998.    
    
     Selling expenses, consisting primarily of sales force salaries, were $4.7
million for the first half of 1998, a decrease of $0.1 million from the first
half of 1997. As a percentage of net sales, selling expenses increased to 10.0%
in the first half of 1998 as compared to 9.8% in the first half of 1997 due to
the lower sales volumes.     
    
     Distribution expenses, consisting primarily of freight charges from the
Company's warehouses to its domestic customers, were $2.7 million in the first
half of 1998, an increase of $0.2 million or 5.9% from the first half of 1997.
The increase was primarily due to increased freight rates.     
    
     General and administrative expenses consist primarily of salaries and other
expenses for corporate management, finance, accounting, regulatory and human
resources. General and administrative expenses for the first half of 1998 were
$5.7 million, a $0.2 million increase over the first half of 1997. This
increase is due to payment of $300,000 in legal fees relating to the successful
defense of a patent infringement lawsuit.     
       
    
     Research and development expenses for the first half of 1998 were $0.9
million, an increase of $45,000 over the first half of 1997.     
    
     The provision for Equity Participation Plan consists of accrued expenses 
and payments made to executives under the Equity Participation Plan. In the
first half of 1998, the provision for Equity Participation Plan was $63.9
million, which included approximately $1.3 million in employer payroll taxes
relating to the distribution made under the Equity Participation Plan.     
    
     The provision for retention payments, including related employer payroll
taxes, was $4.8 million in the first half of 1998. These payments were made to
substantially every employee in the Company and were intended to ensure the
continued employment of all employees after the Recapitalization. No future
payments are anticipated.    
    
     Interest expense was $3.6 million for the first half of 1998, an increase
of $2.7 million over the first half of 1997.  This increase was due to higher
debt levels during the first half of 1998 as a result of the 
Recapitalization.     
    
     Income tax expense reflects the effects of the termination of the Company's
S corporation status upon the Recapitalization.  The Company now provides for
federal and state income taxes as a C corporation, although actual payments are
expected to be substantially less than provided amounts due to the tax bases in
assets provided by the Section 338(h)(10) election.
     

                                      33
<PAGE>
 

          

Year Ended December 26, 1997 Compared to Year Ended December 27, 1996

     Net sales for 1997 were $99.5 million, an increase of $5.7 million or 6.0%
over 1996. The increase in net sales was primarily due to increased
international and alternate site sales due to increases in unit volume, which
was partially offset by a slight decrease in average selling price. For the
year, international sales were $19.0 million, an increase of $2.9 million or
18.2% over 1996, and alternate site sales were $14.6 million, an increase of
$1.7 million or 13.1% over 1996. Sales to Southeast Asia were adversely affected
in 1997 due to economic conditions in the region and the outlook for sales in
the region is uncertain in the near term. Approximately 30% of the Company's
1997 total net sales were to a single distributor.

     The Company's gross profit for 1997 was $47.8 million, an increase of $3.3
million or 7.5% over 1996.  As a percentage of net sales, the Company's gross
profit increased to 48.0% in 1997 from 47.4% in 1996.  The Company has been able
to improve its gross profit margin primarily by transferring additional assembly
operations to its lower cost operation in Ensenada, Mexico, automating and
upgrading the manufacturing process for the Company's products, particularly
oxygen masks, and continued cost containment efforts relating to the Company's
overhead structure.

     Selling expense was $9.6 million for 1997, an increase of $0.7 million or
7.6% over 1996. As a percentage of net sales, selling expense increased to 9.7%
in 1997 from 9.5% in 1996. Selling expense increased primarily as a result of
increased employee compensation related to increased sales commissions and
performance compensation in connection with the increase in net sales. In
particular, sales commissions increased in connection with sales of selected
products targeted by the Company's commission incentive program. Selling expense
also increased as a result of fees paid to certain distributors in connection
with special promotional programs.

     Distribution expense was $5.2 million for 1997, an increase of $0.4 million
or 8.5% over 1996. This increase was due to increased sales volume. As a
percentage of net sales, distribution expense increased to 5.3% in 1997 from
5.1% in 1996. Freight charges relating to international sales are generally paid
by the distributor.

     General and administrative expenses for 1997 were $11.5 million, an
increase of $0.2 million or 1.6% over 1996.  As a percentage of net sales,
general and administrative expenses decreased to 11.5% in 1997 from 12.0% in
1996 as a result of the Company's continued cost containment efforts.  General
and administrative expenses increased in absolute terms as a result of salary
and facility maintenance expense increases and upgrade of the Company's
management information systems.

     Research and development expenses for 1997 were $1.8 million, a decrease of
$0.4 million or 18.1% from 1996.  This decrease was the result of reduced head
count and outside consulting fees.  The Company's research and development
efforts include expenditures intended to provide improved products to its
customers and to upgrade its manufacturing processes.  Management expects 1998
research and development expenses to continue at 1997 levels.

                                       34
<PAGE>
 
     The provision for the EPP consisted of accrued expense of $7.0 million in
1997, as compared with $8.2 million in 1996, reflecting the total termination
liability under the EPP at the end of 1997 and 1996, respectively.  The EPP was
terminated upon consummation of the Recapitalization and replaced with an
executive stock purchase plan.  See "Management--Stock Purchase Plan."

     Interest expense for 1997 was $1.8 million, a decrease of $0.3 million or
15.8% from 1996, primarily as a result of lower average outstanding debt
balances during 1997 as compared to 1996.  Following the Recapitalization, the
Company will have substantially higher interest expenses.  See "--Liquidity and
Capital Resources" and Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements.

     Prior to the Recapitalization, the Company was a Subchapter S corporation
and was not subject to federal income tax.  Effective with the Recapitalization
the Company terminated S corporation status and is taxed as a Subchapter C
corporation.

Year Ended December 27, 1996 Compared to Year Ended December 29, 1995

     Net sales for 1996 were $93.8 million, an increase of $7.0 million or 8.1%
over 1995.  The increase in net sales was primarily due to growth in
international sales volume.  Net sales were also positively impacted due to the
Company completing its first full year of sales of its anesthesia product line
and increased sales of that product line, which was introduced during 1995.
Unit increases were partially offset by price decreases, largely due to changes
in GPO affiliations among health care providers.

     The Company's gross profit for 1996 was $44.4 million, an increase of $5.2
million or 13.2% over 1995.  As a percentage of net sales, gross profit
increased to 47.4% in 1996 from 45.2% in 1995.  The increase in the Company's
gross profit margin is primarily attributable to increased utilization of the
Company's lower cost manufacturing operations in Ensenada, Mexico, automating
and upgrading the manufacturing processes for the Company's products and cost
containment efforts relating to the Company's overhead structure.

     Selling expense for 1996 was $9.0 million, an increase of $0.7 million or
8.2% over 1995, and was unchanged as a percentage of net sales from 1995 to
1996.  Selling expense increased primarily as a result of increased employee
compensation related to increased sales commissions and performance compensation
in connection with the increase in net sales.

     Distribution expense for 1996 was $4.8 million, an increase of $0.2 million
or 5.1% over 1995 due to increased sales volume.  As a percentage of net sales,
distribution expense decreased to 5.1% in 1996 from 5.3% in 1995.

     General and administrative expenses for 1996 were $11.3 million, an
increase of $1.5 million or 15.4% over 1995.  As a percentage of net sales,
general and administrative expenses increased to 12.0% in 1996 from 11.3% in
1995.  General and administrative expenses increased as a result of the
amortization of intangible assets acquired in connection with the acquisition of
a passive humidification product line in 1996.  In 1995 the Company's general
and administrative expenses were lowered by a one-time credit of $0.3 million
relating to a workers' compensation program dividend.

     Research and development expenses for 1996 were $2.3 million, an increase
of $0.2 million or 9.2% over 1995.

     The Company's provision for the EPP consisted of an accrued expense of $8.2
million in 1996 compared to $11.4 million in 1995, reflecting the total
termination liability under the EPP at the end of 1996 and 1995, respectively.
The EPP was amended and restated in 1995 and the expense for 1995 reflected the
full value of the termination liability.  In 1996 the expense was due to the
Company's increased net income.

     Interest expense for 1996 was $2.2 million, a decrease of $0.2 million or
10.2% from 1995, primarily as a result of lower average outstanding debt
balances during 1996 as compared to 1995.

                                       35
<PAGE>
 
QUARTERLY RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
    
     The following table presents the unaudited quarterly net sales and EBITDA
before EPP and Retention Payments for each of the Company's fiscal quarters in
its fiscal years 1996 and 1997. In the opinion of the Company's management, this
quarterly information has been prepared on the same basis as the audited
consolidated financial statements appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and
includes all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments)
necessary to present fairly the unaudited quarterly results set forth herein.
The Company's quarterly results have in the past been subject to seasonal and
other fluctuations, and thus the operating results for any quarter are not
necessarily indicative of results for any future period.      

<TABLE>     
<CAPTION>
                                           1996                                             1997
                   -------------------------------------------------  ---------------------------------------------
                        FIRST      SECOND       THIRD      FOURTH       FIRST      SECOND       THIRD     FOURTH
                       QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER    QUARTER
                   ------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- -----------
                                                           (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                <C>           <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>
Net sales.......   $   24,143    $   21,271  $    21,566 $   26,862  $   23,987  $   25,106  $   21,813 $   28,603
Operating income        2,513           840        2,357      3,158       3,384       3,161       2,142      3,953
EBITDA before
 EPP and 
 Retention 
 Payments.......        6,278         4,449        5,539      6,928       6,526       6,397       5,103      7,414
<CAPTION> 
                                           1996                                             1997
                   -------------------------------------------------  ---------------------------------------------
                       FIRST       SECOND      THIRD       FOURTH      FIRST       SECOND       THIRD     FOURTH
                      QUARTER      QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER     QUARTER    QUARTER
                   ------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- -----------
                                                      (PERCENT OF ANNUAL TOTAL)
<S>                <C>           <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>
Net sales.......       25.7%       22.7%       23.0%       28.6%       24.1%       25.2%       21.9%       28.8%
Operating income       28.3         9.5        26.6        35.6        26.8        25.0        16.9        31.3
EBITDA before
 EPP and 
 Retention 
 Payments.......       27.1        19.2        23.9        29.8        25.7        25.1        20.1        29.1
</TABLE>      
    
     The Company's results of operations exhibit some measure of seasonality.
Generally, the Company's sales and EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments are
higher in the first and fourth quarters and lower in the second and third
quarters. This is due primarily to the higher incidence of breathing ailments,
such as colds and flu, during the winter months, which results in increased
hospitalization and respiratory care, especially among higher-risk individuals,
such as infants and the elderly. Fourth quarter sales are generally the
Company's highest, as distributors increase inventory in anticipation of the
cold and flu seasons. First quarter results are generally affected by the length
and severity of flu seasons. Management believes that the fourth quarter of 1996
and the first half of 1997 benefitted from an unusually strong flu season.      

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
        
     The Company's primary sources of liquidity are cash flow from operations
and borrowing under its working capital facility. Cash provided by operations
totaled $15.9 million, $16.1 million and $19.3 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively, and increased in each year during this period due to the Company's
increased sales volume and improved operating margins. Cash provided by
operations before EPP payments totalled $12.3 million in the six months ended
June 27, 1997 and $12.2 million in the six months ended June 26, 1998. The
Company had operating working capital, excluding cash and short-term debt, of
$22.5 million, $26.8 million and $10.0 million as of the end of fiscal 1995,
1996 and 1997, respectively, and $18.8 million at June 26, 1998. Inventories
were $12.8 million, $14.0 million and $16.6 million as of the end of fiscal
1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively, and $15.1 million at June 26, 1998. In order
to meet the needs of its customers, the Company must maintain inventories
sufficient to permit same-day or next-day filling of most orders. Such
inventories are higher than those that would be required for delayed filling of
orders, thus adversely impacting liquidity. Over time, the Company expects its
level of inventories to increase as the Company's sales in the international
market increase. Accounts receivable, net of allowances, were $17.2 million,
$20.7 million and $21.3 million at the end of fiscal 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively, and $17.0 million at June 26, 1998. The average number of days
sales in accounts receivable outstanding was approximately 77 days for 1997,
compared to 74 days for 1996. The Company offers 30 day credit terms to its U.S.
hospital distributors. Alternate site and international customers typically    

                                       36
<PAGE>
 
receive 60 to 90 day terms and, as a result, as the Company's alternate site and
international sales have increased, the amount and aging of its accounts
receivable have increased.  As a result, the Company anticipates that the amount
and aging of its accounts receivable will continue to increase.  The Company is
exploring the utilization in 1998 or 1999 of a distribution warehouse outside of
the United States.  While this will have the effect of increasing the Company's
investment in inventories, it may also result in lower international accounts
receivable than would otherwise be the case because customers will receive
products, and consequently pay for them, more quickly.
    
     In connection with the Recapitalization, the Company made cash payments 
under the EPP of $88.3 million in the six months ended June 26, 1998, which it
funded with the proceeds of the debt and equity transactions that were part of 
the Recapitalization.     
    
     Net cash used in investing activities was $6.1 million, $11.4 million and
$3.7 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively.  Primary uses of these funds
were to finance the acquisition of the passive humidification product line in
1996 and capital expenditures. Capital expenditures, consisting primarily of new
manufacturing equipment purchases and expansion of the Ensenada facility,
totaled $5.9 million, $6.4 million and $4.7 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997,
respectively. The decrease in 1997 resulted from temporary delays in projects
that the Company anticipates will be completed in 1998. During the six months
ended June 27, 1997 net cash provided by investing activities was 1.0 million,
reflecting purchases of property. During the six months ended June 26, 1998, net
cash used in investing activities was 1.6 million, primarily for capital
expenditures. The Company currently estimates that capital expenditures will be
approximately $6.0 million in each of 1998 and 1999, consisting primarily of
additional and replacement manufacturing equipment and new heater
placements.    
    
     Net cash used in financing activities was $11.9 million, $3.7 million and
$16.4 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively, which consisted primarily of
repayment of debt and shareholder distributions principally to pay taxes on
income passed through by the Company. During the six months ended June 27, 1997,
net cash used in financing activities was 13.7 million, consisting primarily of
repayment of debt and shareholder distributions. During the six months ended
June 26, 1998, net cash provided by financing was 84.5 million reflecting net
borrowing by the Company. The Company's long term debt at June 26, 1998
consisted of 153.0 million of bank indebtedness, which was refinanced in
connection with the Recapitalization.     
    
     The Company has outstanding $153.0 million of indebtedness, consisting of
$115.0 million of Notes and borrowings of $38.0 million under the New Credit
Facility. The New Credit Facility consists of a $40.0 million Term Loan Facility
(all of which was funded in connection with the Recapitalization) and a $60.0
million Revolving Loan Facility. The Notes bear, and the Exchange Notes will
bear, interest at the rate set forth on the cover hereof, payable semiannually,
and will require no principal repayments until maturity. See "Description of the
Exchange Notes." The Term Loan Facility matures on the sixth anniversary of the
initial borrowing and requires principal repayments of between $3.0 million and
$11.5 million each year until maturity, commencing on June 30, 1999. The
Revolving Loan Facility matures on the sixth anniversary of the initial
borrowing and bears interest based on a spread over either a eurodollar or base
rate. See "Description of New Credit Facility."     

     In connection with the Recapitalization, the Company issued 300,000 shares
of its 11 1/2% Senior PIK Preferred Stock due 2010 with an aggregate liquidation
preference of $30.0 million (the "Mirror Preferred Stock") which has terms and
provisions materially similar to those of the 11 1/2% Senior Exchangeable PIK
Preferred Stock due 2010 of Holding (the "Holding Preferred Stock") and the 11
1/2% Senior Exchangeable PIK Preferred Stock of the Company (the "Exchange
Preferred Stock").  At the election of the Company, dividends may be paid in
kind until April 15, 2003 and thereafter must be paid in cash.  See "Description
of Other Securities--Holding Preferred Stock" and "--Mirror Preferred Stock."
    
     The Company believes that after giving effect to the Recapitalization and
the incurrence of indebtedness related thereto, based on current levels of
operations and anticipated growth, its cash from operations, together with other
available sources of liquidity, including borrowings available under the
Revolving Loan Facility, will be sufficient over the next several years to fund
anticipated capital expenditures and acquisitions and to make required payments
of principal and interest on its debt, including payments due on the Notes and
obligations under the New Credit Facility. The Company intends to selectively
pursue strategic acquisitions, both domestically and internationally, to expand
its product line, improve its market share positions and increase cash flows.
Financing for such acquisitions is available, subject to limitations, under the
New Credit Facility. Any significant acquisition activity by the Company in 
excess of such amounts would require additional capital, which could be provided
through capital contributions or debt financing. The Company has no commitments
for such acquisition financing and to the extent financing is unavailable,
acquisitions may be delayed or not completed.    

                                       37
<PAGE>
 
YEAR 2000 COMPLIANCE
        
     The issue surrounding the year 2000 is whether computer systems will 
properly recognize date sensitive information when the year changes to 2000, or 
"00."  Systems that misinterpret the two-digit date "00" as the year 1900 
instead of the year 2000 could generate erroneous data or fail.  The Company has
upgraded its information system capabilities such that it does not believe that 
its systems will encounter any material year 2000 problems, nor will its 
operations be materially affected by year 2000 issues.  In addition, the 
Company's products are not subject to year 2000 problems.  The Company also 
relies, directly and indirectly on the external systems of various independent 
business enterprises, such as its customers, suppliers, creditors, financial 
organizations, and of governments, both domestically and internationally, for 
the accurate exchange of data and related information.  The Company has not 
assessed the status of such third-party enterprises' information systems, nor
the materiality, nature or potential impact on the Company of year 2000 issues
confronted by such third parties to the extent the same affect the Company. The
Company has not developed any contingency plans in the event of disruption in
the operation of the various third-party enterprises with which it interacts,
and thus could be adversely affected in the event of any such disruption.     

RECENT ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

          Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No. 129
Disclosure of Information about Capital Structure was issued in February 1997
and was adopted as of December 26, 1997.  SFAS No. 130 Reporting Comprehensive
Income and SFAS No. 131 Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related
Information were issued in June 1997.  SFAS No. 130 was adopted in the first
quarter of fiscal 1998.  SFAS No. 131 will initially be adopted in the Company's
1998 year-end financial statements.

                                       38
<PAGE>
 
                                    BUSINESS

GENERAL
        
     The Company is a leading manufacturer and marketer of disposable medical
products utilized in the respiratory care and anesthesia segments of the
domestic and international health care markets. The Company offers one of the
broadest respiratory care and anesthesia product lines in the industry,
including such products as oxygen masks, humidification systems, nebulizers,
cannulae and tubing. In the United States, the Company markets its products to a
variety of health care providers, including hospitals and alternate site service
providers such as outpatient surgery centers, long-term care facilities,
physician offices and home health care agencies. Internationally, the Company
sells its products to distributors that market to hospitals and other health
care providers. The Company's products are sold to over 2,500 distributors and
alternate site service providers throughout the United States and in more than
75 countries worldwide. For fiscal 1997, the Company had net sales of $99.5
million, operating income of $12.6 million and pro forma EBITDA before EPP and
Retention Payments of $26.3 million. From 1993 to 1997, the Company's net sales,
operating income and EBITDA before EPP and Retention Payments increased at
compound annual rates of approximately 5.9%, 11.4% and 13.3%, respectively. 
     

     The Company has supplied the disposable respiratory care market for over 50
years and enjoys strong brand name recognition and leading market positions.
Based on IMS America data regarding the size of the domestic hospital market for
respiratory therapy products, and the Company's estimate of the portion thereof
represented by respiratory products, the Company believes that in 1996 it held a
share of approximately 25% of the domestic hospital market for the disposable
respiratory care products that the Company markets and held number one or two
market share positions in 10 product categories representing approximately 75%
of the Company's 1997 net sales.  IMS America does not distinguish between
anesthesia and respiratory products in its market analysis.  See "--Industry
Overview." In recent years the Company has pursued a number of growth
initiatives, including the expansion of its international and alternate site
sales efforts and entry into the anesthesia market.  The Company established
separate sales forces dedicated to the international and alternate site markets
in 1993 and 1994, respectively.  In 1995, the Company entered the anesthesia
market to further leverage its manufacturing platform, distribution channels and
strong brand name recognition.  In 1997, anesthesia sales represented
approximately 6.5% of the Company's total net sales and international and
alternate site sales represented 19.1% and 14.7%, of the Company's total net
sales, respectively.

     The Company manufactures and markets over 1,000 respiratory care and
anesthesia products.  The Company believes that its broad product offering
represents a competitive advantage over suppliers with more limited product
offerings, as health care providers seek to reduce medical supply costs and
concentrate purchases among fewer vendors.  The Company also benefits
competitively from its extensive relationships with leading GPOs, as large
purchasing organizations play an increasingly important role in hospitals'
purchasing decisions.

     The Company maintains two manufacturing facilities and two distribution
facilities in the United States and an assembly operation in Mexico.  The
Company has reduced its manufacturing and assembly costs through cost reduction
programs, process improvement, equipment automation and upgrades and increased
utilization of its Ensenada, Mexico facility for labor-intensive operations.
Over the past five years the Company has spent $22.4 million to upgrade its
manufacturing operations.  During this period, the Company's gross margins have
improved from 41.3% to 48.0%, reflecting management's ongoing commitment to cost
reduction.
        
     Hudson Oxygen Therapy Sales Company ("Hudson Oxygen"), Hudson RCI's
predecessor, was founded in 1945. In 1988, Hudson Oxygen formed Industrias
Hudson, a majority-owned subsidiary that oversees the Company's assembly
operation in Mexico. Until the Recapitalization, the Continuing Shareholder
owned the minority interest in Industrias Hudson. In 1989, Hudson Oxygen merged
with Respiratory Care Inc. to form Hudson RCI. In April 1988, the Company
consummated the Recapitalization, pursuant to which it became a majority-owned
subsidiary of Holding, with the Continuing Shareholder retaining a minority
interest. In connection with the transfer of ownership of Industrias Hudson from
the Continuing Shareholder, the Company formed IH Holding LLC, a Delaware
limited liability company ("IH Holding"), which now owns the minority interest
in Industrias Hudson. Hudson RCI's principal executive offices are located at
27711 Diaz Road, P.O. Box 9020, Temecula, California 92589, and its telephone
number is (909) 676-5611. Holding was incorporated in Delaware in January 1998.
Holding's principal executive offices are located at 599 Lexington Avenue, 18th
Floor, New York, New York 10022, and its telephone number is (212) 
758-2555.     

                                       39
<PAGE>
 
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

     The worldwide market for disposable respiratory care and anesthesia
products consists of the domestic hospital market, the alternate site market and
the international market.  While no data is available for the size of the
alternate site and international markets, IMS America data indicates that in
1996 domestic hospitals purchased approximately $371 million of the disposable
respiratory care and anesthesia products that the Company markets.  The Company
categorizes approximately $208 million (56%) of this amount as respiratory care
and $163 million (44%) as anesthesia.  In addition, there is a growing alternate
site service provider market in the United States, as care is increasingly
provided outside of traditional hospital settings.  Further, the Company
believes there is a large and growing international market for disposable
respiratory care and anesthesia products.  The Company believes that in
countries with higher health care standards, heightened concern regarding cross-
contamination and sterilization costs have resulted in disposable medical
products replacing traditional reusable products.  The Company believes that the
trend towards utilizing disposable products is accelerating in developing
countries as health care standards improve.

     Respiratory care and anesthesia principally involve the delivery of oxygen
and anesthesia from a gas source, such as a mechanical ventilator or respirator,
to the patient's pulmonary system.  The gas is typically delivered to the
patient through specialized tubing connecting to a cannula, mask or endotracheal
tube.  In addition, it is often necessary to humidify or medicate the gas.  The
market for respiratory care and anesthesia products, including disposable
products, is expected to be positively impacted by demographic trends, both
domestically and internationally.  In the United States, changes in
demographics, including an aging population, increased incidence and awareness
of respiratory illnesses and heightened focus on cost-efficient treatment, have
had a positive impact on the domestic respiratory care and anesthesia markets.
There has been an increasing incidence of respiratory illnesses (such as asthma
and emphysema), due in part to an increasingly susceptible aging population,
environmental pollution, smoking-related illnesses and communicable diseases
with significant respiratory impact, such as tuberculosis, HIV and influenza.
The Company believes that the international respiratory care and anesthesia
markets will experience many of the trends currently affecting domestic markets.
In addition, many international markets have high incidences of communicable
respiratory diseases and are becoming increasingly aware of the value of single
use, disposable products.

     The market for respiratory care and anesthesia products is also affected by
trends affecting the health care market generally.  In particular, the overall
trend towards cost containment has increased the desirability of disposable
products relative to reusable products, and has influenced pricing, distribution
channels, purchasing decisions and health care delivery methods.

     Efforts to contain rising health care costs have increased the preference
for disposable medical products that improve the productivity of health care
professionals and reduce overall provider costs.  Health care organizations are
evaluating modes of treatment that are less labor and/or technology intensive as
a means of decreasing the cost of care, which can often result in increased
disposable usage.  In particular, increased utilization of disposable products
can decrease labor and other costs associated with sterilizing reusable
products.  In addition, the risks of transmission of infectious diseases such as
HIV, hepatitis and tuberculosis, and related concerns about the occupational
safety of health care professionals, have also contributed to an increased
preference for disposable single-use medical products.

     Cost containment has caused consolidation throughout the health care
product supply channel, which has favored manufacturers with large product
offerings and competitive pricing.  In an effort to contain costs, service
providers have consolidated to form GPOs, which take advantage of group buying
power to obtain lower supply prices.  This, in turn, has led to consolidation
among distributors, who seek to provide "one-stop shopping" for these large
buying groups.  Distributors have also sought to concentrate purchases among
fewer vendors in an effort to reduce supply costs.  Since selection as a GPO
provider and strong relationships with distributors are critical to many health
care manufacturers, manufacturers have responded to these trends by providing a
broad range of integrated products, combined with reliable delivery and strong
after-sales support.

     Cost containment has also caused a migration of the decision making
function with respect to supply acquisition from the clinician to the
administrator.  As clinicians lose influence and purchasing agents, materials

                                       40
<PAGE>
 
managers and upper level management become more involved in the purchasing
decision, a greater emphasis is placed on price relative to product features and
clinical benefits.

     As a result of cost containment, health care is increasingly provided
outside of traditional hospital settings through alternate health care sites,
such as outpatient surgery centers, long-term care facilities, physician offices
and patients' homes.  Growth of the alternate site market is also attributable
to advances in technology that have facilitated the delivery of care outside of
the hospital, an increased number of illnesses and diseases considered to be
treatable outside of the hospital and increased acceptance by the medical
community of, and patient preference for, non-hospital treatment.

     The Company believes that these industry trends create significant market
opportunities for an efficient, high volume manufacturer of disposable
respiratory care and anesthesia products with an extensive product offering and
strong relationships with leading distributors and GPOs.

BUSINESS STRATEGY

     The Company's senior management team has increased net sales and EBITDA
before EPP by 5.9% and 13.3%, respectively, from 1993 to 1997 compounded
annually, despite facing significant pricing pressure as a result of cost
containment trends affecting the health care industry generally.  These results
are largely attributable to management's expertise within the Company's markets
and ability to grow the Company's business and improve profitability margins
within a dynamic health care environment.  On average, members of the senior
management team have over 18 years of experience in the health care industry.
The senior management team intends to continue to expand the Company's market
position, increase cash flows and capitalize on favorable demographic trends by
pursuing the following strategies:

     ENHANCE MARKET POSITION IN DOMESTIC HOSPITAL MARKET.  The Company employs a
proactive, consultative sales approach in which the Company works with hospitals
to increase efficiency and address their cost containment needs.  The Company
believes that this approach, combined with high levels of customer service and
training, enhances its value as a supplier.  The Company has entered into
preferred supplier arrangements with 12 national GPOs and seeks both to increase
sales of disposable respiratory care products to its existing GPO network and to
establish new relationships with additional GPOs.

     INCREASE PENETRATION OF ANESTHESIA MARKET.  The Company plans to continue
to build its anesthesia product customer base and improve product margins.
Since its entry into the anesthesia market in 1995, the Company has built a
sales base by leveraging its established distribution network and strong brand
name recognition.  To minimize start-up costs, the Company initially outsourced
much of the manufacturing of its anesthesia product line.  Having validated its
market and product strategy, the Company is internalizing the manufacturing of
its anesthesia products in order to enhance quality and margins.  The Company is
also hiring sales personnel with experience in anesthesia and has established a
sales commission structure that emphasizes growth in this market segment.
    
     EXPAND INTERNATIONALLY.  The Company intends to further pursue the large
and growing international market for disposable respiratory care and anesthesia
products and believes that the Company, as a high-quality, low cost manufacturer
with a comprehensive product line, is well-positioned to compete in the
international market.  The Company has established and is currently expanding
its international sales force to further its penetration of this market.  The
Company's manufacturing facilities have received ISO 9000 certification and the
Company anticipates being in full compliance with European CE and Medical Device
Directive laws by the June 1998 deadline.       

     INCREASE PRESENCE IN ALTERNATE SITE MARKET.  The Company has targeted the
alternate site market as a key growth market due to cost containment and other
health care industry trends.  The Company provides a broad product line to
patients across multiple care settings through its national distribution
network.  In 1994, the Company established a sales force dedicated to the
alternate site market and intends to continue to increase this sales force.  In
addition, the Company continually focuses on areas with favorable demographics,
such as Florida, Arizona and southern California, where aging populations are
large recipients of alternate site care.

                                       41
<PAGE>
 
     DEVELOP NEW PRODUCTS.  The Company seeks to improve its current market
positions and enter new markets through a continuation of its aggressive new
product development program.  The Company's product development effort targets
specific markets in which the Company believes it can favorably compete.  As a
result of this targeted approach, products introduced since 1992 accounted for
approximately 18% of the Company's 1997 net sales.  In 1995, the Company entered
the disposable anesthesia products market, capitalizing on the Company's
manufacturing expertise, similar process technologies, complementary product
designs and distribution synergies with the existing respiratory care product
line.  The Company has also developed new products aimed specifically at the
alternate site market, such as more comfortable cannulae that can be worn for
longer periods of time.

     PURSUE STRATEGIC ACQUISITIONS.  The Company intends to pursue strategic
acquisitions, both domestically and internationally, to expand its product line,
improve its market share positions and increase cash flows.  Management believes
that the Company's business, with its efficient operations, leading distribution
network, well-recognized brand name and experienced management team, provides an
excellent platform to facilitate the Company's expansion strategy, particularly
in the anesthesia and international markets.

PRODUCTS

     The Company manufactures and markets products for use in respiratory care
and anesthesia.  The products for each market are similar and often overlap, as
do the distribution channels.

     The Company groups its products into nine categories: (i) oxygen delivery;
(ii) aerosol therapy; (iii) active and passive humidification; (iv) ventilatory
support; (v) adaptors, connectors and filters; (vi) resuscitation; (vii) airway
management; (viii) electronic monitoring; and (ix) durable equipment.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                 CATEGORY/PRODUCTS                                           DESCRIPTION
- --------------------------------------------------    ----------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                   <C>
OXYGEN DELIVERY:  Oxygen Masks, Oxygen                Used to deliver therapeutic, supplemental oxygen to a
 Cannulae, Oxygen Tubing                              patient.  Oxygen masks cover the nose and mouth.
                                                      Nasal cannulae fit inside the nostrils.  Both masks and
                                                      cannulae are connected to an oxygen source via small
                                                      diameter tubing through which oxygen flows.
 
AEROSOL THERAPY:  AQUAPAK(R) Large Volume,            Used to create and deliver aerosolized particles of
 Prefilled Nebulizers; Non-Prefilled Large            liquid water, sodium chloride or medication to the patient's
 Volume Nebulizer; UPDRAFT(R), UPDRAFT                airways to dilute and mobilize secretions and/or dilate  
 II(R), AVA-NEB(R) and MICRO MIST(R) Small            constricted breathing passages.  The peak flow meter is  
 Volume, Medication Nebulizers; Aerosol               used to monitor the patient's respiratory status before  
 Tubing; AQUATHERM(R) and THERMAGARD(R)               and after an aerosolized medication treatment.            
 Nebulizer Heaters; AQUAPAK Prefilled                 
 Ultrasonic Cups; ADDIPAK(R) Prefilled Unit
 Dose Solutions; POCKETPEAK(R) Peak Flow
 Meter
 
ACTIVE AND PASSIVE HUMIDIFICATION:                    Heated humidification systems actively heat and
 CONCHATHERM(R) Heated Humidifiers,                   humidify oxygen/air mixtures or anesthetic gases
 AQUA+(R) Hygroscopic Condenser Humidifiers,          provided by a mechanical ventilator or anesthesia gas
 AQUAPAK Prefilled Humidifiers, Non-                  machine.  Hygroscopic condenser humidifiers passively
 Prefilled, Reusable Humidifier, Non-Prefilled        conserve the heat and humidity in the patient's exhaled
 Disposable Humidifier                                breath for use during inspiration.  Prefilled and non-
                                                      prefilled humidifiers are used to add water vapor to
                                                      oxygen being provided to a patient via a mask or
                                                      cannula.
</TABLE> 

                                       42
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                 CATEGORY/PRODUCTS                                           DESCRIPTION
- --------------------------------------------------    ----------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                   <C>
VENTILATORY SUPPORT:  Conventional Ventilator         Used to convey an oxygen/air mixture and/or anesthetic
 Circuits, Heated-Wire Ventilator Circuits,           gas from a mechanical ventilator or anesthesia gas
 Anesthesia Breathing Circuits, Air Cushion           machine to a patient during the temporary or long-term
 Anesthesia Masks, Infant CPAP Systems                support of ventilation.  The infant CPAP system
                                                      provides non-invasive respiratory support to premature
                                                      infants with under-developed, immature lungs.
 
ADAPTORS, CONNECTORS AND FILTERS:  A wide             The adaptors and connectors are frequently used in
 variety of adaptors and connectors; Main Flow        respiratory care and anesthesia to add accessories,
 Bacterial/Viral Filters; Pulmonary Function          modify configurations, and/or customize other related
 Filter                                               products to meet specific needs.  Filters are used to
                                                      protect patients, caregivers, and medical equipment
                                                      from cross-contamination with bacteria and viruses.
 
RESUSCITATION:  LIFESAVER(R) Reusable and             Used during cardiopulmonary resuscitation ("CPR") to
 Disposable Resuscitation Bags, Isolation Valves      adequately support and/or maintain the patient's
 and Kits, LIFESAVER Tubes and Kits                   ventilatory function.
 
AIRWAY MANAGEMENT:  SOFTECH(R) Cuffed and             Assist in securing and maintaining an open airway and
 Uncuffed Endotracheal Tubes; CATH-GUIDE(R),          unobstructed breathing passage.  They also can assure
 Color-Coded and DUAL-CHANNEL Oral                    that the patient's ventilation can be maintained and that
 Pharyngeal Airways; BITEGARD (TM) Oral Bite          respiratory secretions can be adequately removed from
 Block; CATH-GUIDE Closed Suction Catheters           the lungs.
 
ELECTRONIC MONITORING:  Replacement oxygen            The oxygen sensors, monitors and analyzers are used to
 sensors, Oxygen Monitors and Analyzers,              analyze and monitor the amount of oxygen being
 VENTILARM II(R) Low-Pressure Alarms                  administered to a patient.  The low-pressure alarm is
                                                      used to detect a patient disconnect or a leak in the
                                                      breathing circuit during mechanical ventilation.
 
DURABLE EQUIPMENT:  Oxygen Regulators;                Used to regulate oxygen flow from cylinders, stabilize
 Cylinder Carts, Trucks and Stands; Portable          or transport oxygen or other gas cylinders, and provide
 Oxygen Units                                         a portable oxygen supply for emergency use.
</TABLE>


SALES, MARKETING AND DISTRIBUTION
    
     While substantially all of the Company's domestic hospital sales are made
to distributors, the Company's marketing efforts are focused on the health care
service provider. In the alternate site market, the Company both sells and
markets directly to the service provider. The Company's five largest alternate
site accounts are Apria Healthcare Group Inc., Gulf South Medical Supply, Inc.,
Moore Medical Corp., Redline Healthcare Corp. and VGM & Associates.
Internationally, the Company sells its products to distributors that market to
hospitals and other health care providers. See Note 8 to the Consolidated
Financial Statements for information with respect to international sales. The
Company's sales personnel currently call on approximately 2,800 health care
providers, 50 hospital distributors and 700 alternate site customers. Due to
consolidation and cost pressures among the Company's customer base, the
Company's target call point at the health care provider has been moving away
from the clinician to include a purchasing manager or corporate executive. As of
June 27, 1997 and June 26, 1998, the Company had a backlog of approximately $1.5
million and $1.4 million, respectively.    

                                       43
<PAGE>
 
     In the current market environment, GPO relationships are an essential part
of access to the Company's target markets and the Company has entered into
preferred supplier arrangements with 12 national GPOs.  The Company is typically
positioned as either a sole supplier of respiratory care disposables to the GPO,
or as one of two suppliers.  These arrangements set forth pricing and terms for
various levels of purchasing, although they do not obligate either party to
purchase or sell a specific amount of product.  In addition, GPO affiliated
hospitals often purchase products from other suppliers notwithstanding the
existence of sole or dual source GPO arrangements.  Further, these arrangements
are terminable at any time, but in practice usually run for two to three years.
The Company enjoys longer terms with two of its major GPOs, VHA, Inc. and
Columbia/HCA Healthcare Corporation.  The Company's most significant GPO
relationships are with AmeriNet Inc., Columbia/HCA Healthcare Corporation,
Health Services Corporation of America, MedEcon Medical Services, Purchase
Connection Limited, University HealthSystem Consortium and VHA, Inc.

     Health care providers have responded to pressures to reduce their costs by
merging with other members of their industry.  The acquisition of a customer of
the Company often results in the renegotiation of contracts, the granting of
price concessions or in the loss of the customer.  Alternatively, to the extent
a customer of the Company grows through acquisition activity, the Company may
benefit from increased sales to the larger entity.
        
     The Company markets its products primarily through consultative dialogue
with health care providers, targeted print advertising, trade shows, selective
promotional arrangements with distributors and the Company's heater lease
program. To support sales of the entire line of humidification and ventilation
products, the Company leases heaters to domestic customers without charge. The
revenues from the sale of products used in connection with the operation of the
heaters covers the amortization of the heater cost under the leases. The Company
has heaters with a net book value of approximately $1.1 million placed at
service provider locations under this program.     
    
     The Company utilizes a network of over 1,800 hospital distributors, as well
as additional alternate site distributors, to reach its markets. A number of
these distributors carry competing product lines, but many are moving to select
single supply sources for particular product groups. The Company has been
selected as the FOCUS preferred vendor of respiratory disposables for Owens &
Minor, and is seeking similar status with other national vendors. Such status
gives preference to the shipping of the Company's products versus other
competitive lines. Owens & Minor is the Company's largest distributor,
accounting for approximately $30.0 million or approximately 30% of total 1997
net sales, and approximately $7.0 million or approximately 29% of sales in the
first quarter of 1998. The Company provides a price list to its distributors
which details base acquisition prices. Distributors receive orders from the
service providers and charge the contract pricing (which is determined by their
GPO affiliation or individual contract price) plus their service margin. As is
customary within the industry, the Company rebates the difference between base
acquisition price and the specific contract price to the distributor. The
Company offers select large health care providers a reward for purchasing a
broader selection of the Company's product lines. The program allows a rebate in
the form of merchandise credit for purchasing minimum volumes from a selected
group of products. The Company's international distributors place their orders
directly with dedicated international customer service representatives based in
Temecula. Customer orders are shipped from one of two warehouse locations. Sales
strategies and marketing plans are tailored to each market with involvement of
the distributor. Region and territory sales managers are responsible for
supporting, training and launching of products into their regions. The Company
utilizes a network of 100 international distributors, typically on an exclusive
basis within each market.     

MANUFACTURING AND ASSEMBLY

     The Company operates two manufacturing facilities and two distribution
facilities in the United States and an assembly facility in Ensenada, Mexico.
While the Company believes that it is operating at a high utilization rate for
optimal efficiency, existing facilities could support increased capacity with
additional machinery and workers.

     The Company's manufacturing facility in Temecula, California houses 59
injection molding machines, 55 of which are automated.  During the past four
years, 28 out of the 59 machines have been replaced, which has increased
capacity, as the new machines are more efficient.  Tubing is produced on 8
extrusion lines: 4 corrugated, 3 oxygen or "spaghetti", and 1
repellitizer/regrinder.  The Temecula facility uses 10-12 million pounds of over
30 different kinds of resin annually; the most prominent are PVC, polyethylene
and polypropylene.  Sterile prefilled

                                       44
<PAGE>
 
humidification and nebulization products and electronics are manufactured using
7 blow/fill/seal machines in the Company's facility in Arlington Heights,
Illinois.

     The Company's facility located in Ensenada, Mexico is primarily used for
the assembly of certain products molded at the Temecula facility.  The facility
is a Maquiladora, and therefore there are minimal tariffs associated with the
transport of products and components across the United States-Mexico border.

     The Company occasionally outsources production of certain products while it
establishes its ability to penetrate a target market.  Having achieved an
acceptable level of penetration, the Company internalizes the manufacturing
function in order to increase margins and improve quality control.

     The Company monitors the quality of its products at the Temecula, Arlington
Heights and Ensenada facilities by statistical sampling and visual and
dimensional inspection.  The Company also inspects incoming raw materials for
inconsistencies, rating its vendors on quality and delivery time.  The Company
is routinely audited by the FDA and has received no significant regulatory
actions.  The Company is in substantial compliance with the GMP/QSR regulations
of the FDA and has qualified for an "advanced notification" program allowing the
Company to be informed of FDA inspections in advance.  The Company utilizes
outside facilities for sterilization of products produced in Temecula and
Ensenada.  The Arlington Heights products are manufactured in a sterile
environment and are certified sterile as a result of the production process.
The Ensenada and Arlington Heights facilities are certified as ISO 9002
compliant and the Temecula facility is certified as ISO 9001 compliant.

SUPPLIERS AND RAW MATERIALS

     The Company's primary raw materials are various resins, which are formed
into the Company's products.  The top 10 purchased products in 1997 were Tubing
Grade PVC, Clear PVC, LDPE-EVA, Polypropylene, Aluminum Cylinder, Pre-Cut
Elastic, Non-Tubing Grade PVC, Cannula Blanks, Acrylic Resin and Hose-End Grade
PVC.  The Company believes that it is able to purchase materials at a cost no
higher than its competitors.  The Company does not have long-term supply
contracts for any of its purchased raw materials.  The Company believes that
sufficient availability exists for its raw materials, as they consist of mainly
readily available plastic resins.

RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
        
     The Company's research and development department consists of 15 people,
including nine engineers.  The Company's research and development efforts are
split between developing new products and process improvements to its
manufacturing operations.  The Company develops new products to expand its
product line in anticipation of changes in demand.  The Company has invested
heavily in the anesthesia product line, as the Company continues to penetrate
this market.  The Company makes several new product introductions every year.
Significant products introduced in the last five years have been the line of
heat-moisture exchangers, POCKETPEAK peak flow meter, SOFTECH endotracheal
tubes, MICRO MIST small volume nebulizer and CONCHA IV heated humidification
system.  The Company constantly works to reduce costs through improved continued
process improvements.  Over the past several years, approximately 50% of total
research and development expenses have been to improve operational efficiency.
The Company incurred research and development expenses of approximately $2.0
million, $2.3 million and $1.8 million in 1995, 1996 and 1997, respectively, and
approximately $0.9 million in the six months ended June 26, 1998.         

COMPETITION

     The medical supply industry is characterized by intense competition.  The
Company's primary competitor in the respiratory care sector is Allegiance
Corporation and its primary competitors in the anesthesia sector include
Allegiance Corporation, The Kendall Company, Smiths Industries Medical Systems,
Inc. and Vital Signs, Inc.  Many of the products manufactured by the Company are
available from several sources, and many of the Company's customers tend to have
relationships with several manufacturers.  The Company competes on the basis of
brand name, product quality, breadth of product line, service and price.

PATENTS AND TRADEMARKS

     The Company has historically relied primarily on its technological and
engineering abilities and on its design and production capabilities to gain
competitive business advantages, rather than on patents or other

                                       45
<PAGE>
 
intellectual property rights.  However, the Company does file patent
applications on concepts and processes developed by the Company's personnel.
The Company has 18 patents in the U.S. and two patents pending.  Many of the
U.S. patents have corresponding patents issued in Canada, Europe and various
Asian countries.  The Company is currently preparing several patent applications
covering intellectual property associated with the closed suction catheter
product and advanced humidification devices.  The Company's success will depend
in part on its ability to maintain its patents, add to them where appropriate,
and to develop new products and applications without infringing the patent and
other proprietary rights of third parties and without breaching or otherwise
losing rights in technology licenses obtained by the Company for other products.
There can be no assurance that any patent owned by the Company will not be
circumvented or challenged, that the rights granted thereunder will provide
competitive advantages to the Company or that any of the Company's pending or
future patent applications will be issued with claims of the scope sought by the
Company, if at all.  If challenged, there can be no assurance that the Company's
patents (or patents under which it licenses technology) will be held valid or
enforceable.  In addition, there can be no assurance that the Company's products
or proprietary rights do not infringe the rights of third parties.  If such
infringement were established, the Company could be required to pay damages,
enter into royalty or licensing agreements on onerous terms and/or be enjoined
from making, using or selling the infringing product.  Any of the foregoing
could have a material adverse effect upon the Company's business, financial
condition or results of operations.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS

     The Company and its customers and suppliers are subject to extensive
Federal and state regulation in the United States, as well as regulation by
foreign governments, and the Company cannot predict the extent to which future
legislative and regulatory developments concerning its practices and products
for the health care industry may affect the Company.  Most of the Company's
products are subject to government regulation in the United States and other
countries.  In the United States, the FDC Act and other statutes and regulations
govern or influence the testing, manufacture, safety, labeling, storage, record
keeping, marketing, advertising and promotion of such products.  Failure to
comply with applicable requirements can result in fines, recall or seizure of
products, total or partial suspension of production, withdrawal of existing
product approvals or clearances, refusal to approve or clear new applications or
notices and criminal prosecution.  Under the FDC Act and similar foreign laws,
the Company, as a marketer, distributor and manufacturer of health care
products, is required to obtain the clearance or approval of Federal and foreign
governmental agencies, including the FDA, prior to marketing, distributing and
manufacturing certain of those products.  The Company may also need to obtain
FDA clearance before modifying marketed products or making new promotional
claims.  Delays in receipt of or failure to receive required approvals or
clearances, the loss of previously received approvals or clearances, or failures
to comply with existing or future regulatory requirements in the United States
or in foreign countries could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business.  Foreign sales are subject to similar requirements.

     The Company is required to comply with the FDA's GMP/QSR Regulations, which
set forth requirements for, among other things, the Company's manufacturing
process, design control and associated record keeping, including testing and
sterility.  Further, the Company's plants and operations are subject to review
and inspection by local, state, Federal and foreign governmental entities.  The
distribution of the Company's products may also be subject to state regulation.
The impact of FDA regulation on the Company has increased in recent years as the
Company has increased its manufacturing operations.  The Company's suppliers,
including the sterilizer facilities, are also subject to similar governmental
requirements.  There can be no assurance that changes to current regulations or
additional regulations imposed by the FDA will not have an adverse impact on the
Company's business and financial condition in the future.  The FDA also has the
authority to issue special controls for devices manufactured by the Company,
which it has not done to date.  In the event that such special controls were
issued, the Company's products would be required to conform, which could result
in significant additional expenditures for the Company.

     The Company is also subject to numerous federal, state and local laws and
regulations relating to such matters as safe working conditions, manufacturing
practices, fire hazard control and the handling and disposal of hazardous or
infectious materials or substances and emissions of air pollutants.  The Company
owns and leases properties which are subject to environmental laws and
regulations.  There can be no assurance that the Company will not be required to
incur significant costs to comply with such laws and regulations in the future
or that such

                                       46
<PAGE>
 
laws or regulations will not have a material adverse effect upon the Company's
business, financial condition or results of operations.  In addition, the
Company cannot predict the extent to which future legislative and regulatory
developments concerning its practices and products for the health care industry
may affect the Company.  See "Risk Factors--Government Regulation."

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     The Company is party to lawsuits and other proceedings, including suits
relating to product liability and patent infringement.  While the results of
such lawsuits and other proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty,
management does not expect that the ultimate liabilities, if any, will have a
material adverse effect on the financial position or results of operations of
the Company.

PROPERTIES

     The Company owns approximately 30 acres of land in Temecula, California on
which its headquarters, one of two principal manufacturing centers and three
other buildings totalling approximately 245,000 square feet are located.
Plastic and vinyl components and corrugated tubing are manufactured in Temecula
and assembled into finished goods at a 77,000 square foot facility in Ensenada,
Mexico.  The Company owns the Ensenada facility and the underlying land is held
in a 30-year trust that expires in 2019.  The Company leases an 86,000 square
foot manufacturing facility in Arlington Heights, Illinois under a lease that
expires in 2000.  Prefilled sterile solutions and electronics are manufactured
in Arlington Heights.  The Company also leases a 73,000 square foot distribution
warehouse in Elk Grove, Illinois under a lease that expires in 2000.  The
Company believes that its current facilities are adequate for its present level
of operations.  Management expects that the Arlington Heights and Elk Grove
leases will be renewed on favorable terms.

EMPLOYEES
    
     As of August 1, 1998, the Company employed 1,126 employees, substantially
all of whom were full-time employees.  None of the Company's employees are
represented by unions and the Company considers its employee relations to be
good.     

                                       47
<PAGE>
 
                                   MANAGEMENT

DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS

     The following individuals are the executive officers and directors of
Holding and Hudson RCI:

<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
NAME                     AGE                      POSITION
- ----------------------   ---   ------------------------------------------------
<S>                      <C>   <C>
Richard W. Johansen...    46   President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
Lougene Williams......    53   Senior Vice President
Jay R. Ogram..........    43   Chief Financial Officer
Brian W. Morgan.......    58   Vice President, Human Resources
Helen Hudson Lovaas...    59   Director
Jon D. Ralph..........    33   Director
Charles P. Rullman....    49   Director
Ronald P. Spogli......    50   Director
</TABLE>     


     Richard W. Johansen is President, Chief Executive Officer and Director of
the Company and assumed the same positions with Holding after consummation of
the Recapitalization.  Mr. Johansen became President of the Company in 1993 and
assumed the additional responsibilities of Chief Executive Officer in May 1997.
From 1989 to 1993, he served as Vice President, Marketing and Sales for the
Company following the 1989 acquisition of Respiratory Care Inc. by Hudson RCI.
He held the same position with Respiratory Care Inc. as well as prior executive
positions in the area of business development with its parent company, The
Kendall Company.

     Lougene Williams is a Senior Vice President of the Company responsible for
its product development, quality assurance and manufacturing operations, having
served in this capacity since 1996, and assumed the same position with Holding
after consummation of the Recapitalization.  Prior to 1996, he was the Company's
Vice President, Manufacturing, having held a similar position with Respiratory
Care Inc.  From 1976 to 1987, he held manufacturing management positions of
increasing responsibility at various manufacturing plants of The Kendall
Company.

     Jay R. Ogram is the Company's Chief Financial Officer, having served in
this capacity since 1996, and assumed the same position with Holding after
consummation of the Recapitalization.  From 1984 until his assumption of Chief
Financial Officer responsibilities, Mr. Ogram held prior positions as Accounting
Manager and Vice President and Controller of the Company.  Prior to joining the
Company, he had held executive positions in financial management with a major
health care company.

     Brian W. Morgan is Vice President, Human Resources, having held this
position since 1989, and assumed the same position with Holding after
consummation of the Recapitalization.  Mr. Morgan held similar positions in
human resources at Respiratory Care Inc. since 1978.

     Helen Hudson Lovaas is a director of the Company and became a director of
Holding after consummation of the Recapitalization.  Mrs. Lovaas began her
career at the Company in 1961.  She has been Chairman since 1987, when she
inherited ownership of the Company and served as Chief Executive Officer from
1987 until May 1997.  Mrs. Lovaas had served previously as the Vice President of
Administration of Hudson Oxygen for 15 years.

     Jon D. Ralph became a director of Hudson RCI and of Holding in connection
with the Recapitalization.  Mr. Ralph joined FS&Co. in 1989 and became a
Principal in January 1998.  Prior to joining FS&Co., Mr. Ralph spent three years
at Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated where he served as an Analyst in the
Investment Banking Division.  Mr. Ralph is also a director of EnviroSource, Inc.
and The Pantry, Inc.

     Charles P. Rullman became a director of Hudson RCI and of Holding in
connection with the Recapitalization.  Mr. Rullman joined FS&Co. as a Principal
in 1995.  From 1992 to 1995, Mr. Rullman was a General Partner of Westar
Capital, a private equity investment firm specializing in middle market
transactions.

                                       48
<PAGE>
 
Prior to joining Westar, Mr. Rullman spent twenty years at Bankers Trust Company
and its affiliate BT Securities Corporation where he was a Managing Director and
Partner.  Mr. Rullman is also a director of The Pantry, Inc.

     Ronald P. Spogli became a director of Hudson RCI and of Holding in
connection with the Recapitalization.  He is a founding Principal of FS&Co.,
which was founded in 1983.  Mr. Spogli is the Chairman of the Board and a
director of EnviroSource, Inc.  Mr. Spogli also serves on the Boards of
Directors of Calmar Inc., Buttrey Food and Drug Stores Company, AFC Enterprises,
Inc. and Brylane Inc.

     Directors of Hudson RCI and of Holding are elected annually and hold office
until the next annual meeting of stockholders and until their successors are
duly elected and qualified.

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     The following table sets forth the compensation earned by the Company's
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer and the four most highly compensated
executive officers who earned salary and bonus in excess of $100,000 for
services rendered in all capacities to the Company and its subsidiaries for the
fiscal year ended December 26, 1997 (collectively, with the exception of Helen
Hudson Lovaas, who resigned in connection with the Recapitalization, the "Named
Executive Officers").


                                        SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                   ANNUAL COMPENSATION
                                                         --------------------------------------

                                               FISCAL
         NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITION            YEAR      SALARY     BONUS     COMPENSATION(1)   COMPENSATION(2)
- -------------------------------------------   --------  ---------  ---------  ----------------  -----------------
<S>                                           <C>       <C>        <C>        <C>               <C>
Helen Hudson Lovaas........................   1997       $286,353   $ 88,601         --             $9,000
 Chairman and Chief Executive Officer(3)

Richard W. Johansen........................   1997       $256,535   $141,101   $1,350,000            $9,000
 President and Chief Executive Officer

Lougene Williams...........................   1997       $180,005   $ 70,475   $  556,000            $9,000
  Senior Vice President

Jay R. Ogram...............................   1997       $140,520   $ 48,357   $  556,000            $8,394
 Chief Financial Officer

Brian W. Morgan............................   1997       $127,368   $ 42,984   $  238,000            $7,477
 Vice President, Human Resources
</TABLE>     
    
_____________________
(1) Reflects amounts earned by the Named Executive Officers during 1997 under
    the Equity Participation Plan. During 1997, no executive officer named above
    received perquisites and other personal benefits, securities or property in
    an aggregate amount in excess of the lesser of $50,000 or 10% of the total
    of such officer's salary and bonus nor did any such officer receive any
    restricted stock award or stock appreciation right.     
(2) Represents payments by the Company under its defined contribution plan.
(3) Resigned as Chief Executive Officer in May 1997.

EXECUTIVE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS

     On April 7, 1998, the Company entered into employment agreements with each
of the Named Executive Officers.  Each Named Executive Officer receives a base
salary in an amount and on substantially the same terms and conditions as was
being paid by the Company on that date and an annual cash bonus in accordance
with the Company's existing incentive programs.  Pursuant to the employment
agreements, in the event that employment is terminated by the Company other than
for cause (as such term is defined in the employment agreements), or if the
Named Executive Officer resigns pursuant to a "qualifying resignation" (as such
term is defined in the employment

                                       49
<PAGE>
 
agreements), the Company will be required to pay such Named Executive Officer's
base salary for a period of between 12 and 24 months.  The employment agreements
also provide for nondisclosure of confidential information, that the Named
Executive Officer shall not engage in any prohibited activity (as such term is
defined in the employment agreement) during the term of employment and that the
Named Executive Officer will refrain from interfering with the Company's
contractual relationships or soliciting the Company's employees for 12 months
following the Named Executive Officer's termination.

COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS

     Directors of the Company receive no compensation as directors.  Directors
are reimbursed for their reasonable expenses in attending meetings.

MANAGEMENT BONUS PLANS

     The Company offers two management bonus plans for its executives, one for
senior management and one for executive management.  The plan for senior
management is based on a combination of the financial goals of the Company and
goals set for individual employees.  The plan has minimum goals of 70%
attainment for operating income before EPP and 75% attainment of the individual
plan.  The payout is based 70% on attainment of Company financial performance
and 30% attainment of individual performance goals.  The plan for executive
management is based on the financial goals of the Company.  The payout to an
individual is based on his or her bonus level and the percentage attainment of
the operating income before EPP goal for the Company.  In order to participate,
70% of operating income before EPP must be achieved.

RETIREMENT PLANS

     The Company sponsors two programs that assist its employees in planning for
retirement.  The Company offers a defined contribution pension plan that is
funded by the Company.  Employees must be at least 21 years of age and have
completed two years of service to be eligible to participate in the pension
plan.  The Company annually contributes an amount equal to 6% of a participating
employee's base earnings to a participant's account, prorated for any part of a
year that a participant was ineligible for a contribution.  The funding also
includes a proportionate share of any increase or decrease in the fair market
value of the assets in the trust fund as of the immediately preceding last day
of the plan year.  In addition, employees may contribute to a 401(k) plan that
has no matching contributions by the Company.  Employees must have six months of
service to be eligible to participate in the 401(k) plan and may contribute up
to 10% of their annual compensation, or 6% if the employee is a highly
compensated participant.

         

COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION

     The Board of Directors of the Company determines the compensation of the
executive officers.  During fiscal 1997, Mrs. Lovaas determined the compensation
of the Company's Chief Executive Officer and Mrs. Lovaas and Mr. Johansen
participated in deliberations regarding the compensation of the Company's other
executive officers.

STOCK OPTION PLAN

     The Board of Directors of the Company plans to adopt a stock option plan
(the "Option Plan") permitting grants of up to 15% of Hudson RCI's common stock.
The Option Plan and each outstanding option thereunder will be subject to
termination in the event of a change in control of Hudson RCI or Holding, as
more particularly described in the Option Plan.  In addition, all options
granted pursuant to the Option Plan will terminate 45 days

                                       50
<PAGE>
 
after termination of employment (unless termination was for cause, in which
event an option will terminate immediately) or 180 days in the event of
termination due to death or disability.  Shares received upon exercise of
options will be subject to both a right of first refusal and a repurchase right
at stated prices in favor of Hudson RCI and will also be subject to obligations
to sell at the request of FS&Co. and co-sale rights in favor of the optionee.

     A portion of the options granted pursuant to the Option Plan ("Time Vesting
Options") will vest over a five-year period in equal annual installments or,
alternatively, will vest in full upon a sale of Hudson RCI or Holding.  Time
Vesting Options will terminate on the eight-year anniversary of the closing of
the Recapitalization.

     A portion of the options granted pursuant to the Option Plan ("Company
Performance Options") will be earned in installments based upon satisfaction of
annual performance targets over a five-year period.  In the event Hudson RCI or
Holding is sold prior to the fifth year following the grant of Company
Performance Options, such options will accelerate proportionately based on
achievement of annual performance targets through the year ended prior to the
sale.  In addition, upon a sale of Hudson RCI or Holding, if 90% of the annual
performance targets for all years ended prior to the sale have been achieved,
50% of the options subject to installments for years ended prior to the sale
will be deemed earned (inclusive of installments previously earned).  Finally,
to the extent FS&Co. achieves a specific internal rate of return on its
investment in Holding for a sale, Company Performance Options will also be
earned under certain circumstances.

     In addition, a portion of the options granted pursuant to the Option Plan
will be earned upon the realization by FS&Co. of a specific internal rate of
return on its investment in Holding.

STOCK SUBSCRIPTION PLANS
    
     In connection with the Recapitalization, Holding adopted an Employee Stock
Subscription Plan and an Executive Stock Subscription Plan (collectively, the
"Stock Subscription Plans") pursuant to which executives of the Company
purchased 800,000 shares of common stock of Holding valued at $10.00 per share.
The Stock Subscription Plans provide for a repurchase option in favor of Holding
upon termination of employment at stated repurchase prices.  In addition, the
Stock Subscription Plans provide for restrictions on the transferability of
shares prior to the fifth anniversary of the Recapitalization or Hudson RCI's
initial public offering. The shares are also subject to a right of first refusal
in favor of Holding as well as obligations to sell at the request of FS&Co. and
co-sale rights if FS&Co. sells its shares to a third party.     

     The following table sets forth, for the Named Executive Officers, the
number of shares purchased pursuant to the Stock Purchase Plans:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
NAME                                   NUMBER OF SHARES
- -----------------------------------   ------------------
<S>                                   <C>
Richard W. Johansen................        300,000(1)
Lougene Williams...................        100,000
Jay R. Ogram.......................        100,000
Brian W. Morgan....................         15,000
</TABLE>

___________________

(1)  Represents shares held of record by the Johansen Family Trust U/D/T dated
     8/16/91, of which Mr. Johansen and his wife, Barbara L. Johansen, are the
     trustees.

                                       51
<PAGE>
 
                SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS

     The following table sets forth certain information, as of May 31, 1998,
with respect to the beneficial ownership of capital stock of the Company by (i)
each person who beneficially owns more than 5% of such shares, (ii) each of the
Named Executive Officers, (iii) each director of Hudson RCI and (iv) all Named
Executive Officers and directors of Hudson RCI as a group. The following table
should be read in conjunction with the security ownership table for Hudson RCI.

<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>                                                             SHARES OF                  SHARES OF
                                                                       COMMON       PERCENT      PREFERRED        PERCENT
                   NAME OF BENEFICIAL OWNER                            STOCK        OF CLASS       STOCK         OF CLASS
- -------------------------------------------------------------------  ----------     --------    -----------    -----------
<S>                                                                  <C>            <C>         <C>            <C>
River Holding Corp.(1).............................................   6,300,000      80.8%       300,000       100.0%
  Jon D. Ralph(1)..................................................          --                      --
  Charles P. Rullman(1)............................................          --                      --
  Ronald P. Spogli(1)..............................................          --                      -- 
Helen Hudson Lovaas(2).............................................   1,500,000      19.2%           --
Richard W. Johansen(3).............................................          --                      --
Lougene Williams(3)................................................          --                      --
Jay R. Ogram(3)....................................................          --                      --
Brian W. Morgan(3).................................................          --                      --
All Named Executive Officers and directors of the Company as                       
  a group (4 individuals)..........................................   7,800,000     100.0%       300,000       100.0%       
</TABLE>     

- -------------------
    
(1) As beneficial owner of 87.3% of the common stock of Holding, FS&Co. will
    have the power to vote and dispose of the shares held by Holding. 1,441,251
    shares, 58,749 shares and 4,000,000 shares of common stock of Holding is
    held of record by FS Equity Partners III, L.P. ("FSEP III"), FS Equity
    Partners International, L.P. ("FSEP International") and FS Equity Partners
    IV, L.P. ("FSEP IV"), respectively. As general partner of FS Capital
    Partners, L.P. ("FS Capital"), which is general partner of FSEP III, FS
    Holdings, Inc. ("FSHI") has the sole power to vote and dispose of the shares
    owned by FSEP III. As general partner of FS&Co. International, L.P. ("FS&Co.
    International"), which is the general partner of FSEP International, FS
    International Holdings Limited ("FS International Holdings") has the sole
    power to vote and dispose of the shares owned by FSEP International. As
    general partner of FSEP IV, FS Capital Partners LLC ("FS Capital LLC") has
    the sole power to vote and dispose of the shares owned by FSEP IV. Messrs.
    Spogli and Rullman and Bradford M. Freeman, William M. Wardlaw, J. Frederick
    Simmons and John M. Roth are the sole directors, officers and shareholders
    of FSHI, FS International Holdings and Freeman Spogli & Co. Incorporated and
    such individuals, in addition to Mr. Ralph and Todd W. Halloran and Mark J.
    Doran, are the sole managing members of FS Capital LLC, and as such may be
    deemed to be the beneficial owners of the shares of the common stock and
    rights to acquire the common stock owned by FSEP III, FSEP International and
    FSEP IV. The business address of Freeman Spogli & Co. Incorporated, FSEP
    III, FSEP IV, FS Capital, FSHI, FS Capital LLC, and its sole directors,
    officers, shareholders and managing members is 11100 Santa Monica Boulevard,
    Suite 1900, Los Angeles, California 90025 and the business address of FSEP
    International, FS&Co. International and FS International Holdings is c/o
    Padget-Brown & Company, Ltd., West Winds Building, Third Floor, Grand
    Cayman, Cayman Islands, British West Indies. Holding has pledged all shares
    of the Company's capital stock owned by it to secure its guarantee of the
    Company's obligations under the New Credit Facility.    
(2) Represents shares held of record by the Helen Lovaas Separate Property Trust
    U/D/T dated 7/17/97 (the "Trust").  As sole trustee of the Trust, Mrs.
    Lovaas has the sole power to vote and dispose of the shares owned by the
    Trust.  The address of the Trust is c/o Hudson Respiratory Care Inc., 27711
    Diaz Road, P.O. Box 9020, Temecula, California 92589.
(3) The business address of these individuals is Hudson Respiratory Care Inc.,
    27711 Diaz Road, P.O. Box 9020, Temecula, California 92589.
         


                              CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS

SHAREHOLDERS' AGREEMENT

     Upon the closing of the Recapitalization Agreement, the Continuing
Shareholder and Holding entered into a Shareholders' Agreement (the
"Shareholders' Agreement").  Under the Shareholders' Agreement, Holding and the
Continuing Shareholder have the right to purchase their pro rata share of
certain new issuances of capital stock by Hudson RCI.  In addition, the
Shareholders' Agreement provides that upon certain issuances of common stock of
Holding to employees of the Company, and contribution of the consideration
received for such issuance to Hudson RCI, an equivalent number of shares of
Hudson RCI's common stock will be issued to Holding.  The Shareholders'
Agreement provides for restrictions on the transferability of the shares held by
the Continuing Shareholder for a period of two years following the consummation
of the Recapitalization, and provides for a right of first offer on the
Continuing Shareholder's common stock.  In addition, the agreement provides that
upon sales by Holding of common stock of Hudson RCI or by FS&Co. of common stock
of Holding, the Continuing Shareholder is obligated to sell all its shares of
common stock at the request of Holding and the Continuing Shareholder has the
right to participate in such sale on a pro rata basis.  If Hudson RCI engages in
an initial public offering with respect to its common stock, the Shareholders'
Agreement provides that Holding will exchange all of the common stock of Hudson
RCI it holds for newly issued common stock of Hudson RCI and the Mirror
Preferred

                                       52
<PAGE>
 
     
Stock (as defined herein) will be exchanged, at Holding's option, into Company
Preferred Stock (as defined herein) or Company Exchange Debentures (as defined
herein), which in turn will be exchanged for Exchange Preferred Stock. Holding
will then liquidate and distribute Hudson RCI's common stock to its common
holders. Hudson RCI will grant unlimited piggyback registration rights (after an
initial public offering) to FS&Co. and the Continuing Shareholder and,
commencing six (6) months after the initial public offering, three (3) demand
registrations to FS&Co., and one demand registration to the Continuing
Shareholder. The Shareholders' Agreement provides that the parties thereto will
vote their shares to elect Helen Hudson Lovaas to the Board of Directors.      

PAYMENTS RELATING TO THE RECAPITALIZATION

          In connection with the Recapitalization, two trusts of which Mrs.
Lovaas is the sole trustee received payments of an aggregate of $131.1 million.
Such trusts will also receive payments in an aggregate of approximately $3.3
million if the Company achieves certain operating performance targets for fiscal
1998.  In addition, FS&Co. received a transaction fee of $4.0 million.  Under
the Equity Participation Plan, upon consummation of the Recapitalization,
certain employees of the Company received an aggregate of $88.3 million, a
substantial portion of which was received by the Named Executive Officers.
Senior management, including the Named Executive Officers, will receive an
additional $2.4 million if the Company achieves certain operating performance
targets for fiscal 1998.  For purposes of compliance with the Indenture, the
payment of such $2.4 million by the Company will not reduce Hudson RCI's
Consolidated Net Income or EBITDA.

                                       53
<PAGE>
 
                       DESCRIPTION OF NEW CREDIT FACILITY

     On April 7, 1998, Hudson RCI entered into the New Credit Facility, for
which Salomon Brothers Inc is arranger and syndication agent and Bankers Trust
Company is administrative agent.  Pursuant to the New Credit Facility, a
syndicate of lenders ("Lenders") lent to Hudson RCI up to $100.0 million in the
form of senior secured credit facilities, consisting of a $40.0 million term
loan facility (the "Term Loan Facility") and a $60.0 million revolving credit
facility (the "Revolving Credit Facility").  The Revolving Credit Facility has a
letter of credit sublimit of $7.5 million.

     Use of Proceeds; Maturity.  The entire Term Loan Facility was drawn in
connection with the Recapitalization.  The balance of the New Credit Facility
will be made available to Hudson RCI and its subsidiaries (i) for working
capital and general corporate purposes of Hudson RCI, (ii) for acquisitions, and
(iii) for issuing commercial and standby letters of credit.  The New Credit
Facility will mature on the sixth anniversary of closing of the
Recapitalization.

     Prepayment; Reduction of Commitments.  The Term Loan Facility amortizes in
quarterly installments through final maturity.  In addition, borrowings under
the New Credit Facility are required to be prepaid, subject to certain
exceptions, with (i) 75% (or 50% for years when Hudson RCI's ratio of Debt to
EBITDA (as defined) is less than 5:1) of Excess Cash Flow (as defined), (ii)
100% of the net cash proceeds of the sale or other disposition of any properties
or assets of Holding and its subsidiaries (subject to certain exceptions), (iii)
100% of the net proceeds of certain issuances of debt obligations of Hudson RCI
and its subsidiaries and (iv) 100% of the net proceeds from insurance recoveries
and condemnations.  The Revolving Credit Facility must be prepaid upon payment
in full of the Term Loan Facility.

     Voluntary prepayments are permitted in whole or in part, at the option of
Hudson RCI, in minimum principal amounts to be agreed upon, without premium or
penalty, subject to reimbursement of the Lenders' redeployment costs in the case
of prepayment of eurodollar borrowings other than on the last day of the
relevant interest period.

     Interest.  The interest rate under the New Credit Facility is based, at the
option of Hudson RCI, upon either a eurodollar rate plus 2.25% per annum or a
base rate plus 1.25% per annum.  If Hudson RCI achieves performance goals to be
agreed upon, the margins will be reduced in increments to be agreed upon.  A
commitment fee of 0.50% per annum will be charged on the unused portion of the
New Credit Facility.

     Collateral and Guarantees.  The New Credit Facility is guaranteed by
Holding and all existing and subsequently acquired or organized domestic and, to
the extent no adverse tax consequences would result, foreign, subsidiaries of
Hudson RCI.  The New Credit Facility is secured by a first priority lien in
substantially all of the properties and assets of Hudson RCI and the Guarantors
now owned or acquired later, including a pledge of all of the capital stock of
Hudson RCI owned by Holding and all of the shares held by Hudson RCI of Hudson
RCI's existing and future subsidiaries; provided, that such pledge is limited to
65% of the shares of any foreign subsidiary to the extent a pledge of a greater
percentage would result in adverse tax consequences to Hudson RCI.
    
     Covenants.  The New Credit Facility contains covenants restricting the
ability of Holding, Hudson RCI and Hudson RCI's subsidiaries to, among others,
(i) incur additional debt, (ii) declare dividends or redeem or repurchase
capital stock, (iii) prepay, redeem or purchase debt, (iv) incur liens, (v) make
loans and investments, (vi) make capital expenditures, (vii) engage in mergers,
acquisitions and asset sales, (viii) engage in transactions with affiliates.
Hudson RCI is also required to comply with financial covenants with respect to
(a) limits on annual aggregate capital expenditures, ranging from $6.0 million 
in 1998 to $8.0 million in 2004 (with the right to carry over unspent amounts 
for one year), (b) a fixed charge coverage ratio as of the end of each four 
quarter period of not less than 1.20 to 1.00 (beginning with the fiscal quarter 
ending nearest March 31, 1999), (c) a maximum leverage ratio decreasing from
6.75 to 1.00 for the second quarter of 1998 to 3.50 to 1.00 for the fourth
quarter of 2002 and thereafter, (d) a minimum EBITDA test increasing from $26.5
million for 1998 to $39.0 million for 2003 and thereafter, and (e) an interest
coverage ratio increasing from 1.50 to 1.00 for the four quarters ended with the
second quarter of 1998 to 3.00 to 1.00 for the four quarters ending with the
first quarter of 2002 and thereafter.     

     Events of Default.  Events of default under the New Credit Facility include
but are not limited to (i) the Company's failure to pay principal when due or
interest after a grace period, (ii) the Company's material breach of any
covenant, representation or warranty contained in the loan documents, (iii)
customary cross-default provisions, (iv) events of bankruptcy, insolvency or
dissolution of the Company or its subsidiaries, (v) the levy of certain
judgments against the Company, its subsidiaries, or their assets, (vi) the
actual or asserted invalidity of security documents or guarantees of the Company
or its subsidiaries, and (vii) a change of control of the Company.

                                       54
<PAGE>
 
     The preceding discussion of certain of the provisions of the New Credit
Facility is not intended to be exhaustive and is qualified in its entirety by
reference to the provisions of the New Credit Facility.  Copies of the New
Credit Facility are available upon request from the Company.

                                       55
<PAGE>
 
                       DESCRIPTION OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES

     The Notes were, and the Exchange Notes will be, issued under an Indenture,
dated as of April 7, 1998 (the "Indenture") by and among Hudson RCI, Holding and
United States Trust Company of New York, as trustee (the "Trustee"), a copy of
which has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this
Prospectus is a part.  Upon the effectiveness of this Registration Statement
filed under the Securities Act with respect to the Exchange Notes, the Indenture
will be subject to and governed by the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended
(the "TIA").  The terms of the Exchange Notes include those stated in the
Indenture and those made part of the Indenture by reference to the TIA as in
effect on the date of the Indenture.  The Exchange Notes are subject to all such
terms, and holders of the Exchange Notes are referred to the Indenture and the
TIA for a statement of them.  The following is a summary of the material terms
and provisions of the Exchange Notes.  This summary does not purport to be a
complete description of the Exchange Notes and is subject to the detailed
provisions of, and qualified in its entirety by reference to, the Exchange Notes
and the Indenture (including the definitions contained therein).  A copy of the
form of Indenture may be obtained from the Company by any holder or prospective
investor upon request.  Definitions relating to certain capitalized terms are
set forth under "-- Certain Definitions".  Capitalized terms that are used but
not otherwise defined herein have the meanings ascribed to them in the Indenture
and such definitions are incorporated herein by reference.  For purposes of this
Section, references to the "Company" shall mean Hudson Respiratory Care Inc.
excluding its subsidiaries. Capitalized terms used in this Section and not
otherwise defined below have the respective meanings assigned to them in the
Indenture.


GENERAL

     The Exchange Notes will mature on April 15, 2008, and will be limited to an
aggregate principal amount of $115.0 million. The Exchange Notes will bear
interest at the rate set forth on the cover page from the date of issuance, or
from the most recent date to which interest has been paid, payable semi-annually
on April 15 and October 15 of each year, beginning on October 15, 1998, to the
Persons who are registered holders of the Exchange Notes at the close of
business on the preceding April 1 or October 1, as the case may be. Interest
will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day
months.

     Principal of, and premium, if any, and interest on, the Exchange Notes will
be payable in immediately available funds, and the Exchange Notes will be
exchangeable and transferable, at an office or agency of the Company, one of
which will be maintained for such purpose in The City of New York (which
initially will be the corporate trust office of the Trustee); provided, however,
that payment of interest may be made at the option of the Company by check
mailed to the Person entitled thereto as shown on the Security Register. The
Exchange Notes will be issued only in fully registered form without coupons, in
denominations of $1,000 or any integral multiple thereof. No service charge will
be made for any registration of transfer or exchange of Exchange Notes, except
for any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection
therewith.
    
     If (a) on or prior to the 150th day following the date of original issuance
of the Notes, neither the Exchange Offer Registration Statement nor the Shelf
Registration Statement has been declared effective, (b) on or prior to the 180th
day following the date of original issuance of the Notes, neither the Registered
Exchange Offer has been consummated nor the Shelf Registration Statement has
been declared effective, or (c) after either the Exchange Offer Registration
Statement or the Shelf Registration Statement has been declared effective, such
Registration Statement thereafter ceases to be effective or usable (subject to
certain exceptions) in connection with resales of Notes or Exchange Notes in
accordance with and during the periods specified in the Exchange Offer
Registration Agreement (each such event referred to in clauses (a) through (c),
a "Registration Default"), interest ("Special Interest") will accrue on the
principal amount of the Notes and the Exchange Notes (in addition to the stated
interest on the Notes and the Exchange Notes) from and including the date on
which any such Registration Default shall occur to but excluding the date on
which all Registration Defaults have been cured. Special Interest will accrue at
a rate of 0.25% per annum during the 90-day period immediately following the
occurrence of such Registration Default and shall increase by 0.25% per annum at
the end of each subsequent 90-day period, but in no event shall such rate exceed
1.00% per annum.     
                                       56
<PAGE>
 
SUBORDINATION

     The Exchange Notes will be senior subordinated, unsecured obligations of
the Company. The payment of the principal of, and premium, if any, and interest
on, the Exchange Notes will be subordinated in right of payment to the payment
when due of all Senior Debt of the Company. The Exchange Notes will rank pari
passu in right of payment with any future Senior Subordinated Debt and senior to
any future Subordinated Obligations of the Company. The Subsidiary Guaranty of
any Subsidiary Guarantor will rank subordinate in right of payment to all Senior
Indebtedness of such Subsidiary Guarantor, pari passu with any Senior
Subordinated Debt of such Subsidiary Guarantor and senior to any Subordinated
Obligations of such Subsidiary Guarantor. The Exchange Notes and the Subsidiary
Guaranties also will be effectively subordinated to any secured debt of the
Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors, as the case may be to the extent of the
value of the assets securing such debt.
   
     As of June 26, 1998, the Company had $38.0 million of Senior Debt, all of
which represented secured Debt under the New Credit Facility. The Company also
had $60.0 million of undrawn commitments available under the New Credit
Facility, which if drawn upon will constitute Senior Debt. The Company had no
outstanding Subordinated Obligations.     
   
     The Exchange Notes will be effectively subordinated to creditors (including
trade creditors) and preferred stockholders, if any, of Subsidiaries of the
Company that are not Subsidiary Guarantors. Since a portion of the operations of
the Company are conducted through Subsidiaries, the Company's ability to service
its debt, including the Exchange Notes, is partially dependent upon the earnings
of any such Subsidiaries and the distribution of those earnings to, or upon
loans or other payments of funds by those Subsidiaries to, the Company. The
payment of dividends and the making of loans and advances to the Company by such
Subsidiaries are subject to statutory restrictions. Under certain circumstances,
any Subsidiary Guaranties could be effectively subordinated to all the
obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantors in which event restrictions of the type
described above on the ability of such Subsidiary Guarantors (in addition to the
Company's other Subsidiaries) to distribute funds to the Company could further
adversely effect the Company's ability to service its debt. As of June 26, 1998,
Industrias Hudson, the Company's principal Subsidiary, had total balance sheet
liabilities of $0.1 million.    
    
     The Company may not pay principal of, or premium, if any, or interest on,
the Exchange Notes, or make any deposit pursuant to the provisions described
under "--Defeasance", and may not repurchase, redeem or otherwise retire any
Exchange Notes (collectively, "pay the Exchange Notes"), if (a) any principal,
premium or interest in respect of any Senior Debt is not paid within any
applicable grace period (including at maturity) or (b) any other default on
Senior Debt occurs and the maturity of such Senior Debt is accelerated in
accordance with its terms unless, in either case, (i) the default has been cured
or waived and any such acceleration has been rescinded or (ii) such Senior Debt
has been paid in full in cash; provided, however, that the Company may pay the
Exchange Notes without regard to the foregoing if the Company and the Trustee
receive written notice approving such payment from the Representative (as
defined herein) of each issue of Designated Senior Debt. During the continuance
of any default (other than a default described in clause (a) or (b) of the
preceding sentence) with respect to any Designated Senior Debt (as defined
herein) pursuant to which the maturity thereof may be accelerated immediately
without further notice (except notice required to effect the acceleration) or
the expiration of any applicable grace period, the Company may not pay the
Exchange Notes for a period (a "Payment Blockage Period") commencing upon the
receipt by the Company and the Trustee of written notice of such default from
the Representative of the holders of such Designated Senior Debt specifying an
election to effect a Payment Blockage Period (a "Payment Blockage Notice") and
ending 179 days thereafter (unless such Payment Blockage Period is earlier
terminated (a) by written notice to the Trustee and the Company from the
Representative which gave such Payment Blockage Notice, (b) because such default
is no longer continuing or (c) because such Designated Senior Debt has been
repaid in full in cash). Unless the holders of such Designated Senior Debt or
the Representative of such holders have accelerated the maturity of such
Designated Senior Debt and not rescinded such acceleration, the Company may
(unless otherwise prohibited as described in the first sentence of this
paragraph) resume payments on the Exchange Notes after the end of such Payment
Blockage Period. Not more than one Payment Blockage Notice with respect to all
issues of Designated Senior Debt may be given in any consecutive 360-day period,
irrespective of the number of defaults with respect to one or more issues of
Designated Senior Debt during such period.     

                                       57
<PAGE>
 
     
     Upon any payment or distribution of the assets of the Company upon a total
or partial liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company or in a
bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, receivership or similar proceeding
relating to the Company or its Property (as defined herein), the holders of
Senior Debt will be entitled to receive payment in full in cash before the
holders of the Exchange Notes are entitled to receive any payment of principal
of or interest on the Exchange Notes, except that holders of Exchange Notes may
receive and retain shares of stock and any debt securities that are subordinated
to Senior Debt to at least the same extent as the Exchange Notes. Until the
Senior Debt is paid in full in cash, any distribution to which holders of the
Exchange Notes would be entitled but for the subordination provisions of the
Indenture will be made to holders of the Senior Debt. If a payment or
distribution is made to holders of Exchange Notes that, due to the subordination
provisions, should not have been made to them, such holders are required to hold
it in trust for the holders of Senior Debt and pay it over to them as their
interests may appear.     

     If payment of the Exchange Notes is accelerated when any Designated Senior
Debt is outstanding, the Company may not pay the Exchange Notes until three
business days after the Representatives of all issues of Designated Senior Debt
receive notice of such acceleration and, thereafter, may pay the Exchange Notes
only if the Indenture otherwise permits payment at that time.

     The Subsidiary Guaranty of each Subsidiary Guarantor will be subordinated
to Senior Debt of the applicable Subsidiary Guarantor to the same extent and in
the same manner as the Exchange Notes are subordinated to Senior Debt of the
Company.

     By reason of the subordination provisions contained in the Indenture, in
the event of bankruptcy or similar proceedings relating to the Company or a
Subsidiary Guarantor, holders of Senior Debt and other creditors (including
trade creditors) of the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor may recover more
ratably, even if the Exchange Notes or the applicable Subsidiary Guaranty are
pari passu with their claims, than the holders of the Exchange Notes. In such
event, there may be insufficient assets or no assets remaining to pay the
principal of or interest on the Exchange Notes.
    
     Payment from the money or the proceeds of U.S. Government Obligations
(as defined herein) held in any defeasance trust pursuant to the provisions
described under "--Defeasance" will not be subject to the subordination
provisions described above.     

     See "Risk Factors--Subordination of Notes, Exchange Notes and Subsidiary
Guaranties," "--Fraudulent Conveyance and Distribution Limitation
Considerations," "--Substantial Leverage; Shareholders' Deficit" and
"Description of New Credit Facility."

SUBSIDIARY GUARANTIES
        
     The obligations of the Company under the Indenture, including the
repurchase obligation resulting from a Change of Control, will be fully and
unconditionally guaranteed, jointly and severally, on a senior subordinated,
unsecured basis by each Restricted Subsidiary of the Company which guarantees
the Company's obligations under the New Credit Facility or which, with certain 
limited exceptions, incurs any indebtedness.  Restricted Subsidiaries, unlike 
Unrestricted Subsidiaries (as defined herein), are subject to the negative 
covenants contained in the Indenture, and the financial results of each 
Restricted Subsidiary are included in all financial tests set forth in the 
Indenture.  In addition, if the Company has any Unrestricted Subsidiaries, all 
dealings with such Unrestricted Subsidiary must be conducted on an arm's length 
basis, as though such Subsidiary were a third party.  Any subsidiary of the 
Company will be a Restricted Subsidiary unless the Board of Directors of the 
Company designates such subsidiary to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary because it 
(i) does not own any capital stock or debt of the Company, nor any liens on the 
Company's property, (ii) is not obligated under any debt, lien or other 
obligation that, if in default, would result in a default of any debt of the 
Company, or (iii) either (A) has total assets of $1,000 or less or (B) such 
designation is effective immediately upon such subsidiary becoming a 
subsidiary. Although both Industrias Hudson and IH Holding are Restricted 
Subsidiaries, neither is a Subsidiary Guarantor under the New Credit Facility or
the Indenture because, in the case of Industrias Hudson, the Company would incur
negative tax consequences, and, in the case of IH Holding,
such subsidiary has not incurred any indebtedness that would require it to
excecute a Subsidiary Guaranty.    

     Upon the sale or other disposition of a Subsidiary Guarantor or the sale or
disposition of all or substantially all the assets of a Subsidiary Guarantor (in
each case other than to the Company or an Affiliate of the Company) permitted by
the Indenture, such Subsidiary Guarantor will be released from all its
obligations under its Subsidiary Guaranty. See "--Certain Covenants--Limitation
on Issuance or Sale of Capital Stock of Restricted Subsidiaries". Any Subsidiary
Guarantor that is designated an Unrestricted Subsidiary in accordance with the
Indenture will be released from all its obligations under its Subsidiary
Guaranty.

     Each of the Company and, when they exist, the Subsidiary Guarantors has
agreed to contribute to any other Subsidiary Guarantor which makes payments
pursuant to its Subsidiary Guaranty an amount equal to the Company's or such
Subsidiary Guarantor's proportionate share of such payment, based on the net
worth of the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor relative to the aggregate net
worth of the Company and the Subsidiary Guarantors.

                                       58
<PAGE>
 
REDEMPTION

     The Exchange Notes will not be redeemable at the option of the Company
prior to April 15, 2003. Thereafter, the Exchange Notes will be redeemable at
the option of the Company, in whole or in part, upon not less than 30 nor more
than 60 days' prior notice, at the following redemption prices (expressed as
percentages of principal amount), plus accrued and unpaid interest (if any) to
the redemption date (subject to the right of holders of record on the relevant
record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date), if
redeemed during the 12-month period commencing on April 15 of the years set
forth below:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            REDEMPTION
                       YEAR                   PRICE
               -------------------         -------------
              <S>                           <C>
               2003                           104.563%
               2004                           103.042%
               2005                           101.521%
               2006 and thereafter            100.000%
</TABLE>
    
     Any notice to holders of such a redemption need not set forth the
redemption price of such Exchange Notes but need only set forth the calculation
thereof as described in the immediately preceding paragraph. The redemption
price, calculated as aforesaid, shall be set forth in an Officers' Certificate
(as defined herein) delivered to the Trustee no later than two business days
prior to the redemption date.     

     At any time and from time to time, prior to April 15, 2001, the Company may
redeem up to a maximum of 35% of the original aggregate principal amount of the
Exchange Notes with the proceeds of one or more Public Equity Offerings, at a
redemption price equal to 109 1/8% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued
and unpaid interest thereon, if any, to the redemption date (subject to the
right of holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due
on the relevant interest payment date); provided, however, that after giving
effect to any such redemption, at least 65% of the original aggregate principal
amount of the Exchange Notes remains outstanding. Any such redemption shall be
made within 60 days of such Public Equity Offering upon not less than 30 nor
more than 60 days' notice.

SINKING FUND

     There will be no mandatory sinking fund payments for the Exchange Notes.

REPURCHASE AT THE OPTION OF HOLDERS UPON A CHANGE OF CONTROL
    
     Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, each holder of Exchange Notes
shall have the right to require the Company to repurchase all or any part of
such holder's Exchange Notes pursuant to the offer described below (the "Change
of Control Offer") at a purchase price (the "Change of Control Purchase Price")
equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest
thereon, if any, to the purchase date (subject to the right of holders of record
on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest
payment date). The Trustee does not have the authority under the Indenture to 
waive the covenant relating to the holder's right to require the Company to 
purchase the Exchange Notes upon the occurrence of a Change of Control. Approval
by the Company's Board of Directors will not prevent a transaction from 
constituting a Change of Control if it otherwise falls within the definition 
thereof.     

     Within 30 days following any Change of Control, the Company shall (a) cause
a notice of the Change of Control Offer to be sent at least once to the Dow
Jones News Service or similar business news service in the United States and (b)
send, by first-class mail, with a copy to the Trustee, to each holder of
Exchange Notes, at such holder's address appearing in the Security Register, a
notice stating: (i) that a Change of Control has occurred and a Change of
Control Offer is being made pursuant to the covenant entitled "Repurchase at the
Option of Holders Upon a Change of Control" and that all Exchange Notes timely
tendered will be accepted for payment; (ii) the

                                       59
<PAGE>
 
Change of Control Purchase Price and the purchase date, which shall be, subject
to any contrary requirements of applicable law, a business day no earlier than
30 days nor later than 60 days from the date such notice is mailed; (iii) the
circumstances and relevant facts regarding the Change of Control (including
information with respect to pro forma historical income, cash flow and
capitalization after giving effect to the Change of Control); and (iv) the
procedures that holders of Exchange Notes must follow in order to tender their
Exchange Notes (or portions thereof) for payment, and the procedures that
holders of Exchange Notes must follow in order to withdraw an election to tender
Exchange Notes (or portions thereof) for payment.

     The Company will comply, to the extent applicable, with the requirements of
Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other securities laws or regulations
in connection with the repurchase of Exchange Notes pursuant to a Change of
Control Offer. To the extent that the provisions of any securities laws or
regulations conflict with the provisions of the covenant described hereunder,
the Company will comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and
will not be deemed to have breached its obligations under the covenant described
hereunder by virtue of such compliance.

     The Change of Control repurchase feature is a result of negotiations
between the Company and the Initial Purchasers. Management has no present
intention to engage in a transaction involving a Change of Control, although it
is possible that the Company would decide to do so in the future. Subject to
certain covenants described below, the Company could, in the future, enter into
certain transactions, including acquisitions, refinancings or other
recapitalizations, that would not constitute a Change of Control under the
Indenture, but that could increase the amount of debt outstanding at such time
or otherwise affect the Company's capital structure or credit ratings.

     The definition of Change of Control includes a phrase relating to the sale,
transfer, assignment, lease, conveyance or other disposition of "all or
substantially all" the Company's assets. Although there is a developing body of
case law interpreting the phrase "substantially all," there is no precise
established definition of the phrase under applicable law. Accordingly, the
ability of a holder of Exchange Notes to require the Company to repurchase such
Exchange Notes as a result of a sale, transfer, assignment, lease, conveyance or
other disposition of less than all the assets of the Company may be uncertain.

     The New Credit Facility prohibits the Company from purchasing any Exchange
Notes, and also provides that the occurrence of certain of the events that would
constitute a Change of Control would constitute a default under such existing
debt. Other future debt of the Company may contain prohibitions of certain
events which would constitute a Change of Control or require such debt to be
repurchased upon a Change of Control. Moreover, the exercise by holders of
Exchange Notes of their right to require the Company to repurchase such Exchange
Notes could cause a default under existing or future debt of the Company, even
if the Change of Control itself does not, due to the financial effect of such
repurchase on the Company. Finally, the Company's ability to pay cash to holders
of Exchange Notes upon a repurchase may be limited by the Company's then
existing financial resources. There can be no assurance that sufficient funds
will be available when necessary to make any required repurchases. The Company's
failure to purchase Exchange Notes in connection with a Change of Control would
result in a default under the Indenture which would, in turn, constitute a
default under existing (and may constitute a default under future) debt of the
Company. If such debt constitutes Designated Senior Debt, the subordination
provisions in the Indenture would likely restrict payment to holders of Exchange
Notes. The provisions under the Indenture relative to the Company's obligation
to make an offer to repurchase the Exchange Notes as a result of a Change of
Control may be waived or modified (at any time prior to the occurrence of such
Change of Control) with the written consent of the holders of a majority in
principal amount of the Exchange Notes.

CERTAIN COVENANTS
    
     Limitation on Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt. The Company shall not,
and shall not permit any Subsidiary Guarantor to, Incur (as defined herein),
directly or indirectly, any Debt unless, after giving pro forma effect to the
application of the proceeds thereof, no Default (as defined herein) or Event of
Default would occur as a consequence of such Incurrence (as defined herein) or
be continuing following such Incurrence and either (a) after giving effect to
the Incurrence of such Debt and the application of the proceeds thereof, the
Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio would be greater than 1.75 to 1.00    

                                       60
<PAGE>
 
     
if such Debt is Incurred from the Issue Date through April 15, 2000, and 2.00 to
1.00 if such Debt is Incurred thereafter or (b) such Debt is Permitted Debt (as 
defined below).     

     The term "Permitted Debt" is defined to include the following:

          (a) Debt evidenced by the Exchange Notes and of Subsidiary Guarantors
     evidenced by Subsidiary Guaranties;
    
          (b) (i) Debt under the Credit Facility; provided that the aggregate
     principal amount of all such Debt under the Credit Facility comprised of
     (A) term loans at any one time outstanding shall not exceed $40.0 million
     minus all principal amounts repaid in respect of such term loans and (B)
     revolving credit loans or obligations at any one time outstanding shall not
     exceed the greater of (x) $60.0 million, which amount shall be permanently
     reduced by the amount of Net Available Cash (as defined herein) used to
     repay Debt under the Credit Facility, and not subsequently reinvested in
     Additional Assets (as defined herein) or used to purchase Exchange Notes,
     pursuant to the covenant described under "--Limitation on Asset Sales" and
     (y) the sum of the amounts equal to (1) 60% of the net book value of the
     inventory of the Company and the Restricted Subsidiaries and (2) 85% of the
     net book value of the accounts receivable of the Company and the Restricted
     Subsidiaries, in each case as of the most recent fiscal quarter ending at
     least 45 days prior to the date of determination and (ii) subject to the
     proviso contained in clause (iii) of the covenant described under "--
     Limitation on Non-Guarantor Subsidiary Debt," "--Guarantees of Debt under
     the Credit Facility";     
    
          (c) Debt in respect of Capital Lease Obligations (as defined herein)
     and Purchase Money Debt (as defined herein); provided that (i) the
     aggregate principal amount of such Debt does not exceed the Fair Market
     Value (as defined herein) (on the date of the Incurrence thereof) of the
     Property acquired, constructed or leased (including costs of installation,
     taxes and delivery charges with respect to such acquisition, construction
     or lease) and (ii) the aggregate principal amount of all Debt Incurred and
     then outstanding pursuant to this clause (c) (together with all Permitted
     Refinancing Debt (as defined herein) Incurred in respect of Debt previously
     Incurred pursuant to this clause (c) and then outstanding) does not exceed
     $15.0 million;     
    
          (d) Debt of the Company owing to and held by any Wholly Owned
     Subsidiary (as defined herein) and Debt of a Wholly Owned Subsidiary owing
     to and held by the Company or any Wholly Owned Subsidiary; provided,
     however, that any subsequent issue or transfer of Capital Stock or other
     event that results in any such Wholly Owned Subsidiary ceasing to be a
     Wholly Owned Subsidiary or any subsequent transfer of any such Debt (except
     to the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary) shall be deemed, in each case,
     to constitute the Incurrence of such Debt by the issuer thereof;     

          (e) Debt of a Wholly Owned Subsidiary Incurred and outstanding on or
     prior to the date on which such Wholly Owned Restricted Subsidiary was
     acquired by the Company or otherwise became a Restricted Subsidiary (other
     than Debt Incurred as consideration in, or to provide all or any portion of
     the funds or credit support utilized to consummate, the transaction or
     series of transactions pursuant to which such Wholly Owned Restricted
     Subsidiary became a Subsidiary of the Company or was otherwise acquired by
     the Company); provided that at the time such Wholly Owned Restricted
     Subsidiary was acquired by the Company or otherwise became a Restricted
     Subsidiary and after giving pro forma effect to the Incurrence of such
     Debt, the Company would have been able to Incur $1.00 of additional Debt
     pursuant to clause (a) in the first paragraph of this covenant;
    
          (f) Debt under Interest Rate Agreements (as defined herein) entered
     into by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary for the purpose of limiting
     interest rate risk in the ordinary course of the financial management of
     the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary and not for speculative purposes,
     provided that the obligations under such agreements are directly related to
     payment obligations on Debt otherwise permitted by the terms of this
     covenant;     
    
          (g) Debt under Currency Exchange Protection Agreements (as defined
     herein) entered into by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary for the
     purpose of limiting currency exchange rate risks directly related to    
                                   61
<PAGE>
 
     transactions entered into by the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary in
     the ordinary course of business and not for speculative purposes;

          (h) Debt in connection with one or more standby letters of credit or
     performance bonds issued for the account of the Company or a Restricted
     Subsidiary in the ordinary course of business or pursuant to self-insurance
     obligations and not in connection with the borrowing of money or the
     obtaining of advances;

          (i) Debt outstanding on the Issue Date not otherwise described in
     clauses (a) through (h) above;

          (j) Debt not otherwise described in clauses (a) through (i) above in
     an aggregate principal amount outstanding at any one time not to exceed
     $15.0 million; and

          (k) Permitted Refinancing Debt Incurred in respect of Debt Incurred
     pursuant to clause (a) of the first paragraph of this covenant and clauses
     (a), (c), (e) and (i) above, subject, in the case of clause (c) above, to
     the limitations set forth in the proviso thereto.
    
     Notwithstanding the immediately foregoing two paragraphs, (a) the Company
shall not, and shall not permit any Subsidiary Guarantor to, Incur any Debt
pursuant to such paragraphs if the proceeds thereof are used, directly or
indirectly, to Refinance (as defined herein) (i) any Subordinated Obligations
unless such Debt shall be subordinated to the Exchange Notes and the Subsidiary
Guaranties, as applicable, to at least the same extent as such Subordinated
Obligations or (ii) any Senior Subordinated Debt unless such Debt shall be
Senior Subordinated Debt or shall be subordinated to the Exchange Notes and the
Subsidiary Guaranties, as applicable and (b) the Company shall not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to Incur any Debt pursuant to such paragraph if the
proceeds thereof are used, directly or indirectly, to Refinance any Subordinated
Obligations or Senior Subordinated Debt.     

     Limitation on Non-Guarantor Subsidiary Debt. The Company shall not permit
any Restricted Subsidiary which is not a Subsidiary Guarantor to, directly or
indirectly, Incur any Debt except: (i) Debt outstanding on the Issue Date and
any Permitted Refinancing Debt with respect thereto; (ii) Debt described in
clauses (e) or (h) of the definition of Permitted Debt under "--Limitation on
Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt"; provided, however, that Industrias
Hudson may Incur Debt in an aggregate principal amount outstanding at any one
time not to exceed $5.0 million; and (iii) Guarantees of the Company's
obligations under the New Credit Facility; provided that any Restricted
Subsidiary which Incurs any such Guarantee shall concurrently therewith execute
and deliver to the Trustee a Subsidiary Guaranty.

     Limitation on Restricted Payments. The Company shall not make, and shall
not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to make, directly or indirectly, any
Restricted Payment if at the time of, and after giving pro forma effect to, such
proposed Restricted Payment,

     (a) a Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing,

     (b) the Company could not Incur at least $1.00 of additional Debt pursuant
to clause (a) of the first paragraph of the covenant described under "--
Limitation on Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt" or

     (c) the aggregate amount of such Restricted Payment and all other
Restricted Payments declared or made since the Issue Date (the amount of any
Restricted Payment, if made other than in cash, to be based upon Fair Market
Value) would exceed an amount equal to the sum of:

          (i) 50% of the aggregate amount of Consolidated Net Income accrued
     during the period (treated as one accounting period) from the beginning of
     the fiscal quarter during which the Issue Date occurs to the end of the
     most recent fiscal quarter ending at least 45 days prior to the date of
     such Restricted Payment (or if the aggregate amount of Consolidated Net
     Income for such period shall be a deficit, minus 100% of such deficit),

                                       62
<PAGE>
 
     
          (ii)  Capital Stock Sale Proceeds (as defined herein),     

    
          (iii) the amount by which Debt of the Company Incurred after the 
     Issue Date is reduced on the Company's balance sheet upon the conversion or
     exchange (other than by the Company or a Subsidiary of the Company)
     subsequent to the Issue Date of any Debt (other than Subordinated
     Obligations) of the Company for Capital Stock (other than Disqualified
     Stock (as defined herein)) of the Company (less the amount of any cash or
     other Property distributed by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary upon
     such conversion or exchange), and     
    
          (iv) an amount equal to the sum of (A) the net reduction in
     Investments (as defined herein) in any Person (as defined herein) other
     than the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary resulting from dividends,
     repayments of loans or advances or other transfers of Property, in each
     case to the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary from such Person, to the
     extent such dividends, repayments or transfers do not increase the amount
     of Permitted Investments (as defined herein) permitted to be made pursuant
     to clause (i) of the definition thereof and (B) the portion (proportionate
     to the Company's equity interest in such Unrestricted Subsidiary) of the
     Fair Market Value of the net assets of an Unrestricted Subsidiary at the
     time such Unrestricted Subsidiary is designated a Restricted Subsidiary;
     provided, however, that the foregoing sum shall not exceed, in the case of
     any Person, the amount of Investments previously made (and treated as a
     Restricted Payment) by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary in such
     Person, and    

          (v)  $7.5 million.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing limitation, the Company may:

          (a) pay dividends on its Capital Stock within 60 days of the
     declaration thereof if, on said declaration date, such dividends could have
     been paid in compliance with the Indenture; provided, however, that at the
     time of such payment of such dividend, no other Default or Event of Default
     shall have occurred and be continuing (or result therefrom); provided
     further, however, that such dividend shall be included in the calculation
     of the amount of Restricted Payments;

          (b) purchase, repurchase, redeem, legally defease, acquire or retire
     for value Capital Stock of the Company or Subordinated Obligations in
     exchange for, or in an amount not in excess of the proceeds of the
     substantially concurrent sale of, Capital Stock of the Company (other than
     Disqualified Stock and other than Capital Stock issued or sold to a
     Subsidiary of the Company or an employee stock ownership plan or trust
     established by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries for the benefit of
     their employees); provided, however, that (i) such purchase, repurchase,
     redemption, legal defeasance, acquisition or retirement shall be excluded
     in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments and (ii) the
     Capital Stock Sale Proceeds from such exchange or sale shall be excluded
     from the calculation pursuant to clause (c)(ii) above;

          (c) purchase, repurchase, redeem, legally defease, acquire or retire
     for value any Subordinated Obligations in exchange for, or in an amount not
     in excess of the proceeds of the substantially concurrent sale of,
     Permitted Refinancing Debt; provided, however, that such purchase,
     repurchase, redemption, legal defeasance, acquisition or retirement shall
     be excluded in the calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;

          (d) purchase, repurchase, redeem, legally defease, acquire or retire
     for value, or pay dividends or make loans to Holding to enable Holding
     substantially concurrently therewith to purchase, repurchase, redeem,
     legally defease, acquire or retire for value, shares of, or options to
     purchase shares of, common stock of the Company or Holding from employees
     or former employees of the Company, Holding or any of their Subsidiaries
     (or their estates or beneficiaries thereof) upon death, disability,
     retirement or termination pursuant to the terms of the agreements
     (including employment agreements) or plans (or amendments thereto) approved
     by the Board or Directors or the board of directors of Holding, as the case
     may be, under which such individuals purchase or sell, or are granted the
     option to purchase or sell, shares of such common stock; provided, however,
     that (i) the aggregate amount of such purchases,

                                       63
<PAGE>
 
     
     repurchases, redemptions, defeasances, acquisitions or retirements shall
     not exceed $1.0 million in any year or $5.0 million during the term of the
     Exchange Notes, except that (x) such amounts shall be increased by the
     aggregate net amount of cash received by the Company after the Issue Date
     from the sale of such shares to, or the exercise of options to purchase
     such shares by, employees of the Company, Holding or any of their
     Subsidiaries and (y) the Company may forgive or return Employee Notes (as 
     defined herein) without regard to the limitation set forth in clause (d)(i)
     above and such forgiveness or return shall not be treated as a Restricted
     Payment for purpose of determining compliance with such clause (d)(i) and
     (ii) such purchases, repurchases, defeasances, acquisitions or retirements
     (but not forgiveness or return of Employee Notes) shall be included in the
     calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments;     

          (e) purchase or redeem Subordinated Obligations pursuant to asset sale
     or change of control provisions contained in the governing instrument
     relating thereto; provided, however, that (i) no offer or purchase
     obligation may be triggered in respect of any such Subordinated Obligation
     unless a corresponding obligation also arises with respect to the Exchange
     Notes and (ii) in any event, no repurchase or redemption of any such
     Subordinated Obligation may be consummated unless and until the Company
     shall have satisfied all repurchase obligations with respect to any
     required purchase offer made with respect to the Exchange Notes; provided,
     however, that such purchases or redemptions shall be included in the
     calculation of the amount of Restricted Payments; and
    
          (f) make payments to Helen Hudson Lovaas pursuant to the Merger
     Agreement (as defined herein) in an aggregate amount not to exceed $1.1
     million in any fiscal year or $3.3 million during the term of the Exchange
     Notes (plus, in each case, interest due on the unpaid portion of such
     required payments in accordance with the Merger Agreement); provided,
     however, that such payments shall be excluded in the calculation of the
     amount of Restricted Payments.    
    
     Limitation on Liens. The Company shall not, and shall not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, Incur or suffer to exist, any
Lien (other than Permitted Liens (as defined herein)) upon any of its Property
(including Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary), whether owned at the Issue
Date or thereafter acquired, or any interest therein or any income or profits
therefrom, unless (i) if such Lien secures Senior Subordinated Debt, the
Exchange Notes or the applicable Subsidiary Guaranty are secured on an equal and
ratable basis with such Debt and (ii) if such Lien secures Subordinated
Obligations, such Lien shall be subordinated to a Lien securing the Exchange
Notes or the applicable Subsidiary Guaranty in the same Property as that
securing such Lien to the same extent as such Subordinated Obligations are
subordinated to the Exchange Notes and the Subsidiary Guaranties.     

     Limitation on Issuance or Sale of Capital Stock of Restricted Subsidiaries.
The Company shall not (a) sell, pledge, hypothecate or otherwise dispose of any
shares of Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary or (b) permit any Restricted
Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, issue or sell or otherwise dispose of any
shares of its Capital Stock, other than (i) directors' qualifying shares, (ii)
to the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary or (iii) a disposition of 100% of
the shares of Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary that complies with the
covenant described under "--Limitation on Asset Sales"; provided, however, that,
in the case of this clause (iii), upon consummation of such disposition, any
such Restricted Subsidiary shall be released from all its obligations under its
Subsidiary Guaranty.

     Limitation on Asset Sales. The Company shall not, and shall not permit any
Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, consummate any Asset Sale
unless (a) the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary receives consideration at
the time of such Asset Sale at least equal to the Fair Market Value of the
Property subject to such Asset Sale; (b) at least 75% of the consideration paid
to the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such Asset Sale
is in the form of cash or cash equivalents or the assumption by the purchaser of
liabilities of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (other than liabilities
that are by their terms subordinated to the Exchange Notes or the applicable
Subsidiary Guaranty) as a result of which the Company and the Restricted
Subsidiaries are no longer obligated with respect to such liabilities; and (c)
the Company delivers an Officers' Certificate to the Trustee certifying that
such Asset Sale complies with the foregoing clauses (a) and (b).

     The Net Available Cash (or any portion thereof) from Asset Sales may be
applied by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary, to the extent the Company or
such Restricted Subsidiary elects (or is required by the terms of any Debt): (a)
to prepay, repay, legally defease or purchase Senior Debt of the Company or any
Subsidiary

                                       64
<PAGE>
 
Guarantor or Debt of any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Subsidiary
Guarantor (excluding, in any such case, Disqualified Stock and Debt owed to the
Company or an Affiliate of the Company); or (b) to reinvest in Additional Assets
(including by means of an Investment in Additional Assets by a Restricted
Subsidiary with Net Available Cash received by the Company or another Restricted
Subsidiary); provided, however, that in connection with any prepayment,
repayment, legal defeasance or purchase of Debt pursuant to clause (a) above,
the Company or such Subsidiary Guarantor or other Restricted Subsidiary shall
retire such Debt and shall cause the related loan commitment (if any) to be
permanently reduced by an amount equal to the principal amount so prepaid,
repaid, legally defeased or purchased.

     Any Net Available Cash from an Asset Sale not applied in accordance with
the preceding paragraph within twelve months from the date of the receipt of
such Net Available Cash shall constitute "Excess Proceeds". When the aggregate
amount of Excess Proceeds exceeds $10.0 million (taking into account income
earned on such Excess Proceeds, if any), the Company will be required to make an
offer to purchase (the "Prepayment Offer") the Exchange Notes which offer shall
be in the amount of the Excess Proceeds, on a pro rata basis according to
principal amount, at a purchase price equal to 100% of the principal amount
thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon, if any, to the purchase date
(subject to the right of holders of record on the relevant record date to
receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date) in accordance with
the procedures (including prorating in the event of oversubscription) set forth
in the Indenture. To the extent that any portion of the amount of Net Available
Cash remains after compliance with the preceding sentence and provided that all
holders of Exchange Notes have been given the opportunity to tender their
Exchange Notes for purchase in accordance with the Indenture, the Company or
such Restricted Subsidiary may use such remaining amount for any purpose
permitted by the Indenture and the amount of Excess Proceeds will be reset to
zero.

     Within five business days after the Company is obligated to make a
Prepayment Offer as described in the preceding paragraph, the Company shall send
a written notice, by first-class mail, to the holders of Exchange Notes,
accompanied by such information regarding the Company and its Subsidiaries as
the Company in good faith believes will enable such holders to make an informed
decision with respect to such Prepayment Offer. Such notice shall state, among
other things, the purchase price and the purchase date, which shall be, subject
to any contrary requirements of applicable law, a business day no earlier than
30 days nor later than 60 days from the date such notice is mailed.

     The Company will comply, to the extent applicable, with the requirements of
Section 14(e) of the Exchange Act and any other securities laws or regulations
in connection with the repurchase of Exchange Notes pursuant to the covenant
described hereunder. To the extent that the provisions of any securities laws or
regulations conflict with provisions of the covenant described hereunder, the
Company will comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and will
not be deemed to have breached its obligations under the covenant described
hereunder by virtue thereof.

     Limitation on Restrictions on Distributions from Restricted Subsidiaries.
The Company shall not, and shall not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to,
directly or indirectly, create or otherwise cause or suffer to exist any
consensual restriction on the right of any Restricted Subsidiary to (a) pay
dividends, in cash or otherwise, or make any other distributions on or in
respect of its Capital Stock, or pay any Debt or other obligation owed, to the
Company or any other Restricted Subsidiary (except, with respect to restrictions
on dividends of non-cash Property, as permitted pursuant to clause (ii) of the
next sentence), (b) make any loans or advances to the Company or any other
Restricted Subsidiary or (c) transfer any of its Property to the Company or any
other Restricted Subsidiary. The foregoing limitations will not apply (i) with
respect to clauses (a), (b) and (c), to restrictions (A) in effect on the Issue
Date, (B) relating to Debt of a Restricted Subsidiary and existing at the time
it became a Restricted Subsidiary if such restriction was not created in
connection with or in anticipation of the transaction or series of transactions
pursuant to which such Restricted Subsidiary became a Restricted Subsidiary or
was acquired by the Company or (C) which result from the Refinancing of Debt
Incurred pursuant to an agreement referred to in clause (i)(A) or (B) above or
in clause (ii)(A) or (B) below, provided such restriction is no less favorable
to the holders of Exchange Notes than those under the agreement evidencing the
Debt so Refinanced, and (ii) with respect to clause (c) only, to restrictions
(A) relating to Debt that is permitted to be Incurred and secured without also
securing the Exchange Notes or the applicable Subsidiary Guaranty without equal
and ratable treatment pursuant to the covenants described under "--Limitation on
Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt" and "--Limitation on Liens" that limit

                                       65
<PAGE>
 
the right of the debtor to dispose of the Property securing such Debt, (B)
encumbering Property at the time such Property was acquired by the Company or
any Restricted Subsidiary, so long as such restriction relates solely to the
Property so acquired and was not created in connection with or in anticipation
of such acquisition, (C) resulting from customary provisions restricting
subletting or assignment of leases or customary provisions in other agreements
that restrict assignment of such agreements or rights thereunder or (D)
customary restrictions contained in asset sale agreements limiting the transfer
of such Property pending the closing of such sale.
    
     Limitation on Transactions with Affiliates. The Company shall not, and
shall not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to, directly or indirectly, conduct
any business or enter into or suffer to exist any transaction or series of
transactions (including the purchase, sale, transfer, assignment, lease,
conveyance or exchange of any Property or the rendering of any service) with, or
for the benefit of, any Affiliate of the Company (an "Affiliate Transaction"),
unless (a) the terms of such Affiliate Transaction are (i) set forth in writing,
(ii) in the interest of the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case
may be, and (iii) no less favorable to the Company or such Restricted
Subsidiary, as the case may be, than those that could be obtained in a
comparable arm's-length transaction with a Person that is not an Affiliate of
the Company, (b) if such Affiliate Transaction involves aggregate payments or
value in excess of $2.5 million, the Board of Directors (including a majority of
the disinterested members of the Board of Directors) approves such Affiliate
Transaction and, in its good faith judgment, believes that such Affiliate
Transaction complies with clauses (a) (ii) and (iii) of this paragraph as
evidenced by a resolution of the Board of Directors (a "Board Resolution")
promptly delivered to the Trustee and (c) if such Affiliate Transaction involves
aggregate payments or value in excess of $5.0 million, the Company obtains a
written opinion from an Independent Appraiser (as defined herein) to the effect
that the consideration to be paid or received in connection with such Affiliate
Transaction (as defined herein) is fair, from a financial point of view, to the
Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be.    

     Notwithstanding the foregoing limitation, the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary may enter into or suffer to exist the following:
    
          (i) any transaction or series of transactions between the Company and
     one or more Restricted Subsidiaries or between two or more Restricted
     Subsidiaries in the ordinary course of business; provided that no more than
     5% of the total voting power of the Voting Stock (as defined herein) (on a
     fully diluted basis) of any such Restricted Subsidiary is owned by an
     Affiliate of the Company (other than a Restricted Subsidiary);     

          (ii)   any Restricted Payment permitted to be made pursuant to the
     covenant described under "--Limitation on Restricted Payments";

          (iii)  the payment of compensation (including amounts paid pursuant to
     employee benefit plans) for the personal services of officers, directors
     and employees of the Company or any of the Restricted Subsidiaries, so long
     as the Board of Directors in good faith shall have approved the terms
     thereof and deemed the services theretofore or thereafter to be performed
     for such compensation to be fair consideration therefor;

          (iv)   loans and advances to employees made in the ordinary course of
     business and consistent with the past practices of the Company or such
     Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be; provided that such loans and
     advances do not exceed $1.0 million in the aggregate at any one time
     outstanding;

          (v)    the payment of fees and expenses in connection with the
     Recapitalization pursuant to written agreements in effect on the Issue
     Date;

          (vi)   the sale of common stock of the Company for cash; provided,
     that the Company may receive Employee Notes in an aggregate principal
     amount not in excess of $1.0 million at any one time outstanding;

          (vii)  the payment of dividends in kind in respect of (i) the Company
     Mirror Preferred Stock or (ii) any other Preferred Stock issued in
     compliance with this covenant; and

                                       66
<PAGE>
 
          (viii)  a proportionate split of, or a common stock dividend payable
     on, the common stock of the Company.

     Limitation on Layered Debt. The Company shall not, and shall not permit any
Subsidiary Guarantor to, Incur, directly or indirectly, any Debt which is
subordinate or junior in right of payment to any Senior Debt unless such Debt is
Senior Subordinated Debt or is expressly subordinated in right of payment to
Senior Subordinated Debt. In addition, no Subsidiary Guarantor shall Guarantee,
directly or indirectly, any Debt of the Company that is subordinate or junior in
right of payment to any Senior Debt unless such Guarantee is expressly
subordinate in right of payment to, or ranks pari passu with, the Subsidiary
Guaranty of such Subsidiary Guarantor.

     Designation of Restricted and Unrestricted Subsidiaries. The Board of
Directors may designate any Subsidiary of the Company (other than Industrias
Hudson) to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary if (a) the Subsidiary to be so
designated does not own any Capital Stock or Debt of, or own or hold any Lien on
any Property of, the Company or any other Restricted Subsidiary, (b) the
Subsidiary to be so designated is not obligated under any Debt, Lien or other
obligation that, if in default, would result (with the passage of time or notice
or otherwise) in a default on any Debt of the Company or of any Restricted
Subsidiary and (c) either (i) the Subsidiary to be so designated has total
assets of $1,000 or less or (ii) such designation is effective immediately upon
such entity becoming a Subsidiary of the Company. Unless so designated as an
Unrestricted Subsidiary, any Person that becomes a Subsidiary of the Company
will be classified as a Restricted Subsidiary; provided, however, that such
Subsidiary shall not be designated a Restricted Subsidiary and shall be
automatically classified as an Unrestricted Subsidiary if either of the
requirements set forth in clauses (x) and (y) of the immediately following
paragraph will not be satisfied after giving pro forma effect to such
classification. Except as provided in the first sentence of this paragraph, no
Restricted Subsidiary may be redesignated as an Unrestricted Subsidiary. Upon
designation of a Restricted Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary in
compliance with this covenant, such Restricted Subsidiary will, by delivery of a
supplemental indenture in form satisfactory to the Trustee, be released from any
Subsidiary Guaranty previously made by such Subsidiary.

     The Board of Directors may designate any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a
Restricted Subsidiary if, immediately after giving pro forma effect to such
designation, (x) the Company could Incur at least $1.00 of additional Debt
pursuant to clause (a) of the first paragraph of the covenant described under "-
- -Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt" and (y) no Default or Event of Default
shall have occurred and be continuing or would result therefrom.

     Any such designation or redesignation by the Board of Directors will be
evidenced to the Trustee by filing with the Trustee a Board Resolution giving
effect to such designation or redesignation and an Officers' Certificate (a)
certifying that such designation or redesignation complies with the foregoing
provisions and (b) giving the effective date of such designation or
redesignation, such filing with the Trustee to occur within 45 days after the
end of the fiscal quarter of the Company in which such designation or
redesignation is made (or, in the case of a designation or redesignation made
during the last fiscal quarter of the Company's fiscal year, within 90 days
after the end of such fiscal year).

     Limitation on Holding's Business. Holding shall not, directly or
indirectly, engage in any business or activity other than the ownership of
Capital Stock of the Company and business activities incidental thereto.

MERGER, CONSOLIDATION AND SALE OF PROPERTY

     The Company shall not merge, consolidate or amalgamate with or into any
other Person (other than a merger of a Wholly Owned Subsidiary into the Company)
or sell, transfer, assign, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or
substantially all its Property in any one transaction or series of transactions
unless: (a) the Company shall be the surviving Person (the "Surviving Person")
or the Surviving Person (if other than the Company) formed by such merger,
consolidation or amalgamation or to which such sale, transfer, assignment,
lease, conveyance or disposition is made shall be a corporation organized and
existing under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or
the District of Columbia; (b) the Surviving Person (if other than the Company)
expressly assumes, by supplemental indenture in form satisfactory to the
Trustee, executed and delivered to the Trustee by

                                       67
<PAGE>
 
     
such Surviving Person, the due and punctual payment of the principal of, and
premium, if any, and interest on, all the Exchange Notes, according to their
tenor, and the due and punctual performance and observance of all the covenants
and conditions of the Indenture to be performed by the Company; (c) in the case
of a sale, transfer, assignment, lease, conveyance or other disposition of all
or substantially all the Property of the Company, such Property shall have been
transferred as an entirety or virtually as an entirety to one Person; (d)
immediately before and after giving effect to such transaction or series of
transactions on a pro forma basis (and treating, for purposes of this clause (d)
and clauses (e) and (f) below, any Debt which becomes, or is anticipated to
become, an obligation of the Surviving Person or any Restricted Subsidiary as a
result of such transaction or series of transactions as having been Incurred by
the Surviving Person or such Restricted Subsidiary at the time of such
transaction or series of transactions), no Default or Event of Default shall
have occurred and be continuing; (e) immediately after giving effect to such
transaction or series of transactions on a pro forma basis, the Company or the
Surviving Person, as the case may be, would be able to Incur at least $1.00 of
additional Debt under clause (a) of the first paragraph of the covenant
described under "--Certain Covenants--Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt";
provided, however, that this clause (e) shall not apply to a merger between the
Company and a Wholly Owned Subsidiary of the Company or Holding incorporated in
another state of the United States solely for the purpose of reincorporating the
Company as long as the total amount of Debt of the Company and its Restricted
Subsidiaries is not increased as a result thereof; and (f) the Company shall
deliver, or cause to be delivered, to the Trustee, in form and substance
reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee, an Officers' Certificate and an Opinion
of Counsel (as defined herein), each stating that such transaction and the
supplemental indenture, if any, in respect thereto comply with this covenant and
that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction
have been satisfied.     

     The Surviving Person shall succeed to, and be substituted for, and may
exercise every right and power of the Company under the Indenture, but the
predecessor Company in the case of a sale, transfer, assignment, lease,
conveyance or other disposition shall not be released from the obligation to pay
the principal of, and premium, if any, and interest on, the Exchange Notes.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

    
     Events of Default in respect of the Exchange Notes as set forth in the
Indenture include: (a) failure to make the payment of any interest on the
Exchange Notes when the same becomes due and payable, and such failure continues
for a period of 30 days; (b) failure to make the payment of any principal of, or
premium, if any, on, any of the Exchange Notes when the same becomes due and
payable at its Stated Maturity (as defined herein), upon acceleration,
redemption, optional redemption, required repurchase or otherwise; (c) failure
to comply with the covenant described above under "--Merger, Consolidation and
Sale of Property"; (d) failure to comply with any other covenant or agreement in
the Exchange Notes or in the Indenture (other than a failure which is the
subject of the foregoing clause (a), (b) or (c)) and such failure continues for
30 days after written notice is given to the Company as provided below; (e) a
default under any Debt by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary which results
in acceleration of the stated maturity of such Debt, or failure to pay any such
Debt at final maturity, in an aggregate amount greater than $7.5 million (or its
foreign currency equivalent at the time) (the "cross acceleration provisions");
(f) any judgment or judgments for the payment of money in an aggregate amount in
excess of $7.5 million (or its foreign currency equivalent at the time) shall be
rendered against the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary and shall not be
waived, satisfied or discharged for any period of 30 consecutive days during
which a stay of enforcement shall not be in effect (the "judgment default
provisions"); (g) certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or
reorganization of the Company or any Significant Subsidiary (as defined herein)
(the "bankruptcy provisions"); and (h) the Subsidiary Guaranty of any
Significant Subsidiary or, if issued, Industrias Hudson ceases to be in full
force and effect (other than in accordance with the terms thereof) or any
Significant Subsidiary or, if applicable, Industrias Hudson denies or disaffirms
its obligations under its Subsidiary Guaranty (the "guaranty provisions").    

     A Default under clause (d) is not an Event of Default until the Trustee or
the holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the Exchange
Notes then outstanding notify the Company of the Default and the Company does
not cure such Default within the time specified after receipt of such notice.
Such notice must specify the Default, demand that it be remedied and state that
such notice is a "Notice of Default".

                                       68
<PAGE>
 
     The Company shall deliver to the Trustee, within 30 days after the
occurrence thereof, written notice in the form of an Officers' Certificate of
any event which with the giving of notice and the lapse of time would become an
Event of Default, its status and what action the Company is taking or proposes
to take with respect thereto.

     The Indenture provides that if an Event of Default with respect to the
Exchange Notes (other than an Event of Default resulting from certain events
involving bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization with respect to the Company
or any Significant Subsidiary) shall have occurred and be continuing, the
Trustee or the registered holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal
amount of the Exchange Notes then outstanding may declare to be immediately due
and payable the principal amount of all the Exchange Notes then outstanding,
plus accrued but unpaid interest to the date of acceleration. In case an Event
of Default resulting from certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or
reorganization with respect to the Company or any Significant Subsidiary shall
occur, such amount with respect to all the Exchange Notes shall be due and
payable immediately without any declaration or other act on the part of the
Trustee or the holders of the Exchange Notes. After any such acceleration, but
before a judgment or decree based on acceleration is obtained by the Trustee,
the registered holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the
Exchange Notes then outstanding may, under certain circumstances, rescind and
annul such acceleration if all Events of Default, other than the nonpayment of
accelerated principal, premium or interest, have been cured or waived as
provided in the Indenture.

     Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in case an Event of Default shall occur and be continuing, the Trustee
will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under the
Indenture at the request or direction of any of the holders of the Exchange
Notes, unless such holders shall have offered to the Trustee reasonable
indemnity. Subject to such provisions for the indemnification of the Trustee,
the holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes
then outstanding will have the right to direct the time, method and place of
conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising
any trust or power conferred on the Trustee with respect to the Exchange Notes.

     No holder of Exchange Notes will have any right to institute any proceeding
with respect to the Indenture, or for the appointment of a receiver or trustee,
or for any remedy thereunder, unless (a) such holder has previously given to the
Trustee written notice of a continuing Event of Default, (b) the registered
holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the Exchange Notes then
outstanding have made written request and offered reasonable indemnity to the
Trustee to institute such proceeding as trustee and (c) the Trustee shall not
have received from the registered holders of a majority in aggregate principal
amount of the Exchange Notes then outstanding a direction inconsistent with such
request and shall have failed to institute such proceeding within 60 days.
However, such limitations do not apply to a suit instituted by a holder of any
Exchange Note for enforcement of payment of the principal of, and premium, if
any, or interest on, such Exchange Note on or after the respective due dates
expressed in such Exchange Note.

AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS

     Subject to certain exceptions, the Indenture may be amended with the
consent of the registered holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of
the Exchange Notes then outstanding (including consents obtained in connection
with a tender offer or exchange offer for the Exchange Notes) and any past
default or compliance with any provisions may also be waived (except a default
in the payment of principal, premium or interest and certain covenants and
provisions of the Indenture which cannot be amended without the consent of each
holder of an outstanding Exchange Note) with the consent of the registered
holders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Exchange
Notes then outstanding. However, without the consent of each holder of an
outstanding Exchange Note, no amendment may, among other things, (a) reduce the
amount of Exchange Notes whose holders must consent to an amendment or waiver,
(b) reduce the rate of or extend the time for payment of interest on any
Exchange Note, (c) reduce the principal of or extend the Stated Maturity of any
Exchange Note, (d) make any Exchange Note payable in money other than that
stated in the Exchange Note, (e) impair the right of any holder of the Exchange
Notes to receive payment of principal of and interest on such holder's Exchange
Notes on or after the due dates therefor or to institute suit for the
enforcement of any payment on or with respect to such holder's Exchange Notes or
any Subsidiary Guaranty, (f) release any security interest that may have been
granted in favor of the holders of the Exchange Notes, (g) reduce the premium
payable upon the redemption or repurchase of any

                                       69
<PAGE>
 
Exchange Note, or change the time at which any Exchange Note may be redeemed, as
described under "--Optional Redemption", (h) reduce the premium payable upon a
Change of Control or, at any time after a Change of Control or Asset Sale has
occurred, change the time at which the Change of Control Offer or Prepayment
Offer relating thereto must be made or at which the Exchange Notes must be
repurchased pursuant to such Change of Control Offer or (i) make any change to
the subordination provisions of the Indenture that would adversely affect the
holders of the Exchange Notes or (j) make any change in any Subsidiary Guaranty
that would adversely affect the holders of the Exchange Notes.

     Without the consent of any holder of the Exchange Notes, the Company and
the Trustee may amend the Indenture to cure any ambiguity, omission, defect or
inconsistency, to provide for the assumption by a successor corporation of the
obligations of the Company under the Indenture, to provide for uncertificated
Exchange Notes in addition to or in place of certificated Exchange Notes
(provided that the uncertificated Exchange Notes are issued in registered form
for purposes of Section 163(f) of the Code, or in a manner such that the
uncertificated Exchange Notes are described in Section 163(f)(2)(B) of the
Code), to add additional Guarantees with respect to the Exchange Notes or to
release Subsidiary Guarantors from Subsidiary Guaranties as provided by the
terms of the Indenture, to secure the Exchange Notes, to add to the covenants of
the Company for the benefit of the holders of the Exchange Notes or to surrender
any right or power conferred upon the Company, to make any change that does not
adversely affect the rights of any holder of the Exchange Notes in any material
respect, to make any change to the subordination provisions of the Indenture
that would limit or terminate the benefits available to any holder of Senior
Debt under such provisions or to comply with any requirement of the Commission
in connection with the qualification of the Indenture under the Trust Indenture
Act.

     No amendment may be made to the subordination provisions of the Indenture
that adversely affects the rights of any holder of Senior Debt then outstanding
unless the holders of such Senior Debt (or their Representative) consent to such
change. The consent of the holders of the Exchange Notes is not necessary under
the Indenture to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment. It is
sufficient if such consent approves the substance of the proposed amendment.
After an amendment under the Indenture becomes effective, the Company is
required to mail to each registered holder of the Exchange Notes at such
holder's address appearing in the Security Register a notice briefly describing
such amendment. However, the failure to give such notice to all holders of the
Exchange Notes, or any defect therein, will not impair or affect the validity of
the amendment.

DEFEASANCE

     The Company at any time may terminate all its obligations under the
Exchange Notes and the Indenture ("legal defeasance"), except for certain
obligations, including those respecting the defeasance trust and obligations to
register the transfer or exchange of the Exchange Notes, to replace mutilated,
destroyed, lost or stolen Exchange Notes and to maintain a registrar and paying
agent in respect of the Exchange Notes. The Company at any time may terminate
its obligations under the covenants described under "--Repurchase at the Option
of Holders Upon a Change of Control" and "--Certain Covenants", the operation of
the cross acceleration provisions, the judgment default provisions, the
bankruptcy provisions with respect to Significant Subsidiaries, the guaranty
provisions described under "--Events of Default" above and the limitations
contained in clauses (e) and (f) under the first paragraph of "--Merger,
Consolidation and Sale of Property" above ("covenant defeasance"). The Company
may exercise its legal defeasance option notwithstanding its prior exercise of
its covenant defeasance option.

     If the Company exercises its legal defeasance option, payment of the
Exchange Notes may not be accelerated because of an Event of Default with
respect thereto. If the Company exercises its covenant defeasance option,
payment of the Exchange Notes may not be accelerated because of an Event of
Default specified in clause (d) (with respect to the covenants described under
"--Certain Covenants"), (e), (f), (g) (with respect only to Significant
Subsidiaries) or (h) under "--Events of Default" above or because of the failure
of the Company to comply with clauses (e) and (f) under the first paragraph of
"--Merger, Consolidation and Sale of Property" above. If the Company exercises
its legal defeasance option or its covenant defeasance option, each Subsidiary
Guarantor will be released from all its obligations under its Subsidiary
Guaranty.

                                       70
<PAGE>
 
     In order to exercise either defeasance option, the Company must, among
other things, irrevocably deposit in trust (the "defeasance trust") with the
Trustee money or U.S. Government Obligations for the payment of principal of and
interest on the Exchange Notes to maturity or redemption, as the case may be,
and must comply with certain other conditions, including delivery to the Trustee
of an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that holders of the Exchange Notes will
not recognize income, gain or loss for Federal income tax purposes as a result
of such deposit and defeasance and will be subject to Federal income tax on the
same amounts and in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the
case if such deposit and defeasance had not occurred (and, in the case of legal
defeasance only, such Opinion of Counsel must be based on a ruling of the
Internal Revenue Service or other change in applicable Federal income tax law).


GOVERNING LAW

     The Indenture and the Exchange Notes are governed by the internal laws of
the State of New York without reference to principles of conflicts of law.


THE TRUSTEE

     United States Trust Company of New York is the Trustee under the Indenture.

     The Indenture provides that, except during the continuance of an Event of
Default, the Trustee will perform only such duties as are specifically set forth
in the Indenture. During the existence of an Event of Default, the Trustee will
exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it under the Indenture and use
the same degree of care and skill in its exercise as a prudent person would
exercise under the circumstances in the conduct of such person's own affairs.


CERTAIN DEFINITIONS

     Set forth below is a summary of certain of the defined terms used in the
Indenture. Reference is made to the Indenture for the full definition of all
such terms as well as any other capitalized terms used herein for which no
definition is provided.
    
     "Additional Assets" means (a) any Property (other than cash, cash
equivalents and securities) to be owned by the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary and used in a Related Business (as defined herein); or (b) Capital
Stock of a Person that becomes a Restricted Subsidiary as a result of the
acquisition of such Capital Stock by the Company or another Restricted
Subsidiary from any Person other than an Affiliate of the Company; provided,
however, that, in the case of clause (b), such Restricted Subsidiary is
primarily engaged in a Related Business.    

     "Affiliate" of any specified Person means (a) any other Person directly or
indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common
control with such specified Person or (b) any other Person who is a director or
officer of (i) such specified Person, (ii) any Subsidiary of such specified
Person or (iii) any Person described in clause (a) above. For the purposes of
this definition, "control" when used with respect to any Person means the power
to direct the management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly,
whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise;
and the terms "controlling" and "controlled" have meanings correlative to the
foregoing. For purposes of the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--
Limitation on Transactions with Affiliates", "--Limitation on Asset Sales" and
the definition of "Additional Assets" only, "Affiliate" shall also mean any
beneficial owner of shares representing 5% or more of the total voting power of
the Voting Stock (on a fully diluted basis) of the Company or of rights or
warrants to purchase such Voting Stock (whether or not currently exercisable)
and any Person who would be an Affiliate of any such beneficial owner pursuant
to the first sentence hereof.

     "Asset Sale" means any sale, lease, transfer, issuance or other disposition
(or series of related sales, leases, transfers, issuances or dispositions) by
the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary, including any disposition by

                                       71
<PAGE>
 
     
means of a merger, consolidation or similar transaction (each referred to for
the purposes of this definition as a "disposition"), of (a) any shares of
Capital Stock of a Restricted Subsidiary (other than directors' qualifying
shares) or (b) any other assets of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
outside of the ordinary course of business of the Company or such Restricted
Subsidiary other than, in the case of clauses (a) and (b) above, (i) any
disposition by a Restricted Subsidiary to the Company or by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary to a Wholly Owned Subsidiary, (ii) for purposes of the
covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Asset Sales" only,
any disposition that constitutes a Permitted Investment or Restricted Payment
permitted by the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on
Restricted Payments", (iii) any disposition effected in compliance with the
first paragraph of the covenant described under "--Merger, Consolidation and
Sale of Property", (iv) any Sale and Leaseback Transaction (as defined herein)
completed within 180 days following the original acquisition of the subject
assets where such Sale and Leaseback Transaction represents the intended
financing of Property acquired after the Issue Date and (v) any disposition or
series of related dispositions of assets having a Fair Market Value and sale
price of less than $500,000.    

     "Attributable Debt" in respect of a Sale and Leaseback Transaction means,
at the time of determination, the present value (discounted at the rate of
interest implicit in such transaction, determined in accordance with GAAP) of
the obligation of the lessee for net rental payments during the remaining term
of the lease included in such Sale and Leaseback Transaction (including any
period for which such lease has been extended or may, at the option of the
lessor, be extended).

     "Average Life" means, as of any date of determination, with respect to any
Debt or Preferred Stock, the quotient obtained by dividing (a) the sum of the
product of the numbers of years (rounded to the nearest one-twelfth of one year)
from the date of determination to the dates of each successive scheduled
principal payment of such Debt or redemption or similar payment with respect to
such Preferred Stock multiplied by the amount of such payment by (b) the sum of
all such payments.

     "Board of Directors" means the Board of Directors of the Company or any
committee thereof duly authorized to act on behalf of such Board.

     "Capital Lease Obligations" means any obligation under a lease that is
required to be capitalized for financial reporting purposes in accordance with
GAAP; and the amount of Debt represented by such obligation shall be the
capitalized amount of such obligations determined in accordance with GAAP; and
the Stated Maturity thereof shall be the date of the last payment of rent or any
other amount due under such lease prior to the first date upon which such lease
may be terminated by the lessee without payment of a penalty. For purposes of 
"--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Liens", a Capital Lease Obligation shall be
deemed secured by a Lien on the Property being leased.

     "Capital Stock" means, with respect to any Person, any shares or other
equivalents (however designated) of corporate stock, partnership interests or
any other participations, rights, warrants, options or other interests in the
nature of an equity interest in such Person, including Preferred Stock, but
excluding any debt security convertible or exchangeable into such equity
interest.

     "Capital Stock Sale Proceeds" means the aggregate cash proceeds received by
the Company from the issuance or sale (other than to a Subsidiary of the Company
or an employee stock ownership plan or trust established by the Company or any
of its Subsidiaries for the benefit of their employees) by the Company of any
class of its Capital Stock (other than Disqualified Stock) after the Issue Date,
net of attorneys' fees, accountants' fees, underwriters' or placement agents'
fees, discounts or commissions and brokerage, consultant and other fees actually
incurred in connection with such issuance or sale and net of taxes paid or
payable as a result thereof.

     "Change of Control" means the occurrence of any of the following events:
    
          (a) prior to the first Public Equity Offering, the Permitted Holders 
     (as defined herein) cease to be the "beneficial owners" (as defined in Rule
     13d-3 under the Exchange Act, except that a Person will be deemed to have
     "beneficial ownership" of all shares that any such Person has the right to
     acquire, whether such right is exercisable immediately or only after the
     passage of time), directly or indirectly, of a majority of the voting     

                                       72
<PAGE>
 
     power of the Voting Stock of the Company, whether as a result of the
     issuance of securities of the Company, any merger, consolidation,
     liquidation or dissolution of the Company, any direct or indirect transfer
     of securities by the Permitted Holders or otherwise (for purposes of this
     clause (a), the Permitted Holders will be deemed to beneficially own any
     Voting Stock of a corporation (the "specified corporation") held by any
     other corporation (the "parent corporation") so long as the Permitted
     Holders beneficially own, directly or indirectly, in the aggregate a
     majority of the voting power of the Voting Stock of such parent
     corporation); or

          (b) after the first Public Equity Offering, any "Person" or "group"
     (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d)(3) and 14(d)(2) of the Exchange
     Act or any successor provisions to either of the foregoing), including any
     group acting for the purpose of acquiring, holding, voting or disposing of
     securities within the meaning of Rule 13d-5(b)(1) under the Exchange Act,
     other than any one or more of the Permitted Holders, becomes the
     "beneficial owner" (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act, except
     that a Person will be deemed to have "beneficial ownership" of all shares
     that any such Person has the right to acquire, whether such right is
     exercisable immediately or only after the passage of time), directly or
     indirectly, of 35% or more of the voting power of the Voting Stock of the
     Company; provided, however, that the Permitted Holders are the "beneficial
     owners" (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act, except that a
     Person will be deemed to have "beneficial ownership" of all shares that any
     such Person has the right to acquire, whether such right is exercisable
     immediately or only after the passage of time), directly or indirectly, in
     the aggregate of a lesser percentage of the total voting power of all
     classes of the Voting Stock of the Company than such other Person or group
     (for purposes of this clause (b), such Person or group shall be deemed to
     beneficially own any Voting Stock of a specified corporation held by a
     parent corporation so long as such Person or group beneficially owns,
     directly or indirectly, in the aggregate a majority of the voting power of
     the Voting Stock of such parent corporation); or

          (c) the sale, transfer, assignment, lease, conveyance or other
     disposition, directly or indirectly, of all or substantially all the assets
     of the Company and the Restricted Subsidiaries, considered as a whole
     (other than a disposition of such assets as an entirety or virtually as an
     entirety to a Wholly Owned Subsidiary or one or more Permitted Holders)
     shall have occurred, or the Company merges, consolidates or amalgamates
     with or into any other Person (other than one or more Permitted Holders) or
     any other Person (other than one or more Permitted Holders) merges,
     consolidates or amalgamates with or into the Company, in any such event
     pursuant to a transaction in which the outstanding Voting Stock of the
     Company is reclassified into or exchanged for cash, securities or other
     Property, other than any such transaction where (i) the outstanding Voting
     Stock of the Company is reclassified into or exchanged for Voting Stock of
     the surviving corporation and (ii) the holders of the Voting Stock of the
     Company immediately prior to such transaction own, directly or indirectly,
     not less than a majority of the Voting Stock of the surviving corporation
     immediately after such transaction and in substantially the same proportion
     as before the transaction; or

          (d) during any period of two consecutive years, individuals who at the
     beginning of such period constituted the Board of Directors (together with
     any new directors whose election or appointment by such Board or whose
     nomination for election by the shareholders of the Company was approved by
     a vote of 66 2/3% of the directors then still in office who were either
     directors at the beginning of such period or whose election or nomination
     for election was previously so approved) cease for any reason to constitute
     a majority of the members of the Board of Directors then in office; or

          (e) the shareholders of the Company shall have approved any plan of
     liquidation or dissolution of the Company.

     "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

     "Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio" means, as of any date of
determination, the ratio of (a) the aggregate amount of EBITDA for the most
recent four consecutive fiscal quarters ending at least 45 days prior to such
determination date to (b) Consolidated Interest Expense for such four fiscal
quarters; provided, however, that

                                       73
<PAGE>
 

    
(i) if the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary has Incurred any Debt since the
beginning of such period that remains outstanding or if the transaction giving
rise to the need to calculate the Consolidated Interest Coverage Ratio is an
Incurrence of Debt, or both, Consolidated Interest Expense (as defined herein)
for such period shall be calculated after giving effect on a pro forma basis to
such Debt as if such Debt had been Incurred on the first day of such period and
the discharge of any other Debt repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise
discharged with the proceeds of such new Debt as if such discharge had occurred
on the first day of such period, (ii) if since the beginning of such period the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary shall have repaid, repurchased, legally
defeased or otherwise discharged any Debt with Capital Stock Sale Proceeds,
Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after giving
effect on a pro forma basis to such discharge as if such discharge had occurred
on the first day of such period, (iii) if since the beginning of such period the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary shall have made any Asset Sale or if the
transaction giving rise to the need to calculate the Consolidated Interest
Coverage Ratio is an Asset Sale, or both, EBITDA for such period shall be
reduced by an amount equal to the EBITDA (if positive) directly attributable to
the Property which is the subject of such Asset Sale for such period, or
increased by an amount equal to the EBITDA (if negative) directly attributable
thereto for such period, in either case as if such Asset Sale had occurred on
the first day of such period and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period
shall be reduced by an amount equal to the Consolidated Interest Expense
directly attributable to any Debt of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
repaid, repurchased, defeased or otherwise discharged with respect to the
Company and its continuing Restricted Subsidiaries in connection with such Asset
Sale, as if such Asset Sale had occurred on the first day of such period (or, if
the Capital Stock of any Restricted Subsidiary is sold, by an amount equal to
the Consolidated Interest Expense for such period directly attributable to the
Debt of such Restricted Subsidiary to the extent the Company and its continuing
Restricted Subsidiaries are no longer liable for such Debt after such sale),
(iv) if since the beginning of such period the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary (by merger or otherwise) shall have made an Investment in any
Restricted Subsidiary (or any Person which becomes a Restricted Subsidiary) or
an acquisition of Property, including any acquisition of Property occurring in
connection with a transaction causing a calculation to be made hereunder, which
constitutes all or substantially all of an operating unit of a business, EBITDA
and Consolidated Interest Expense for such period shall be calculated after
giving pro forma effect thereto (including the Incurrence of any Debt) as if
such Investment or acquisition occurred on the first day of such period and (v)
if since the beginning of such period any Person (that subsequently became a
Restricted Subsidiary or was merged with or into the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary since the beginning of such period) shall have made any Asset Sale,
Investment or acquisition of Property that would have required an adjustment
pursuant to clause (iii) or (iv) above if made by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary during such period, EBITDA and Consolidated Interest Expense for such
period shall be calculated after giving pro forma effect thereto as if such
Asset Sale, Investment or acquisition occurred on the first day of such period.
For purposes of this definition, pro forma calculations shall be determined in
good faith by a responsible financial or accounting Officer of the Company and
as further contemplated by the definition of the term "pro forma". If any Debt
bears a floating rate of interest and is being given pro forma effect, the
interest expense on such Debt shall be calculated as if the rate in effect on
the date of determination had been the applicable rate for the entire period
(taking into account any Interest Rate Agreement applicable to such Debt if such
Interest Rate Agreement has a remaining term in excess of 12 months).    
    
     "Consolidated Interest Expense" means, for any period, the total interest
expense of the Company and its consolidated Restricted Subsidiaries, plus, to
the extent not included in such total interest expense, and to the extent
Incurred by the Company or its Restricted Subsidiaries, (a) interest expense
attributable to capital leases, (b) amortization of debt discount and debt
issuance cost, including commitment fees, other than with respect to Debt
Incurred in connection with the Recapitalization, (c) capitalized interest, (d)
non-cash interest expenses, (e) commissions, discounts and other fees and
charges owed with respect to letters of credit and bankers' acceptance
financing, (f) net costs associated with Hedging Obligations (as defined
herein) (including amortization of fees), (g) Disqualified Dividends (as defined
herein) other than Disqualified Dividends paid with shares of Capital Stock of
the Company which is not Disqualified Stock, (h) Preferred Stock dividends in
respect of all Preferred Stock of Restricted Subsidiaries held by Persons other
than the Company or a Wholly Owned Subsidiary, (i) interest Incurred in
connection with Investments in discontinued operations, (j) interest accruing on
any Debt of any other Person to the extent such Debt is Guaranteed by the
Company or any Restricted Subsidiary and (k) the cash contributions to any
employee stock ownership plan or similar trust to the extent such contributions
are used by such plan or trust to pay interest or fees to any Person (other than
the Company) in connection with Debt Incurred by such plan or trust.    

                                       74
<PAGE>
 
     "Consolidated Net Income" means, for any period, the net income (loss) of
the Company and its consolidated Subsidiaries; provided, however, that there
shall not be included in such Consolidated Net Income (a) any net income (loss)
of any Person (other than the Company) if such Person is not a Restricted
Subsidiary, except that (i) subject to the exclusion contained in clause (d)
below, the Company's equity in the net income of any such Person for such period
shall be included in such Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate amount of
cash distributed by such Person during such period to the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary as a dividend or other distribution (subject, in the case
of a dividend or other distribution to a Restricted Subsidiary, to the
limitations contained in clause (c) below) and (ii) the Company's equity in a
net loss of any such Person other than an Unrestricted Subsidiary for such
period shall be included in determining such Consolidated Net Income, (b) for
the purposes of the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on
Restricted Payments" only, any net income (loss) of any Person acquired by the
Company or any of its consolidated Subsidiaries in a pooling of interests
transaction for any period prior to the date of such acquisition, (c) any net
income (but not loss) of any Restricted Subsidiary if such Restricted Subsidiary
is subject to restrictions, directly or indirectly, on the payment of dividends
or the making of distributions, directly or indirectly, to the Company, except
that subject to the exclusion contained in clause (d) below, the Company's
equity in the net income of any such Restricted Subsidiary for such period shall
be included in such Consolidated Net Income up to the aggregate amount of cash
distributed by such Restricted Subsidiary during such period to the Company or
another Restricted Subsidiary as a dividend or other distribution (subject, in
the case of a dividend or other distribution to another Restricted Subsidiary,
to the limitation contained in this clause), (d) any gain (or, for purposes of
the covenants described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Company and
Subsidiary Guarantor Debt" and "--Merger, Consolidation and Sale of Property"
only, loss) realized upon the sale or other disposition of any Property of the
Company or any of its consolidated Subsidiaries (including pursuant to any Sale
and Leaseback Transaction) which is not sold or otherwise disposed of in the
ordinary course of business, provided, that any tax benefit or tax liability
resulting therefrom shall be excluded in such Consolidated Net Income, (e) any
extraordinary gain or loss, provided, that any tax benefit or tax liability
resulting therefrom shall be excluded in such Consolidated Net Income, (f) the
cumulative effect of a change in accounting principles and (g) (i) any non-cash
compensation expense realized for grants of performance shares, stock options or
other stock awards to officers, directors and employees of the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary or (ii) compensation expense realized with respect to
periods prior to the Issue Date in respect of payments under the Company's 1994
Amended and Restated Equity Participation Plan or compensation expense, to the
extent accrued in 1998, related to contingent payments to existing managers of
the Company pursuant to the Merger Agreement in an aggregate amount not in
excess of $2.4 million. Notwithstanding the foregoing, for the purposes of the
covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Restricted
Payments" only, there shall be excluded from Consolidated Net Income any
dividends, repayments of loans or advances or other transfers of assets from
Unrestricted Subsidiaries to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary to the
extent such dividends, repayments or transfers increase the amount of Restricted
Payments permitted under such covenant pursuant to clause (c)(iv) thereof.

     "Credit Facility" means, with respect to the Company or any Restricted
Subsidiary, one or more debt or commercial paper facilities with banks or other
institutional lenders (including the New Credit Facility) providing for
revolving credit loans, term loans, receivables or inventory financing
(including through the sale of receivables or inventory to such lenders or to
special purpose, bankruptcy remote entities formed to borrow from such lenders
against such receivables or inventory) or trade letters of credit, in each case
together with any amendments, supplements, modifications (including by any
extension of the maturity thereof), refinancings or replacements thereof by a
lender or syndicate of lenders in one or more successive transactions (including
any such transaction that changes the amount available thereunder, replaces such
agreement or document, or provides for other agents or lenders).

     "Currency Exchange Protection Agreement" means, in respect of a Person, any
foreign exchange contract, currency swap agreement, currency option or other
similar agreement or arrangement designed to protect such Person against
fluctuations in currency exchange rates.

     "Debt" means, with respect to any Person on any date of determination
(without duplication), (a) the principal of and premium (if any) in respect of
(i) debt of such Person for money borrowed and (ii) debt evidenced by notes,
debentures, bonds or other similar instruments for the payment of which such
Person is responsible or liable; (b) all Capital Lease Obligations of such
Person and all Attributable Debt in respect of Sale and Leaseback

                                       75
<PAGE>
 
     
Transactions entered into by such Person; (c) all obligations of such Person
issued or assumed as the deferred purchase price of Property, all conditional
sale obligations of such Person and all obligations of such Person under any
title retention agreement (but excluding trade accounts payable arising in the
ordinary course of business); (d) all obligations of such Person for the
reimbursement of any obligor on any letter of credit, banker's acceptance or
similar credit transaction (other than obligations with respect to letters of
credit securing obligations (other than obligations described in (a) through (c)
above) entered into in the ordinary course of business of such Person to the
extent such letters of credit are not drawn upon or, if and to the extent drawn
upon, such drawing is reimbursed no later than the third Business Day (as
defined) following receipt by such Person of a demand for reimbursement
following payment on the letter of credit); (e) the amount of all obligations of
such Person with respect to the redemption, repayment or other repurchase of any
Disqualified Stock or, with respect to any Subsidiary of such Person, any
Preferred Stock (but excluding, in each case, any accrued dividends); (f) all
obligations of the type referred to in clauses (a) through (e) of other Persons
and all dividends of other Persons for the payment of which, in either case,
such Person is responsible or liable, directly or indirectly, as obligor,
guarantor or otherwise, including by means of any Guarantee; (g) all obligations
of the type referred to in clauses (a) through (f) of other Persons secured by
any Lien on any Property of such Person (whether or not such obligation is
assumed by such Person), the amount of such obligation being deemed to be the
lesser of the value of such Property or the amount of the obligation so secured;
and (h) to the extent not otherwise included in this definition, Hedging
Obligations of such Person. The amount of Debt of any Person at any date shall
be the outstanding balance at such date of all unconditional obligations as
described above and the maximum liability, upon the occurrence of the
contingency giving rise to the obligation, of any contingent obligations at such
date; provided that the amount outstanding at any time of any Debt issued with
original issue discount is the face amount of such Debt less the remaining
unamortized portion of the original issue discount of such Debt at such time as
determined in accordance with GAAP.    

     "Default" means any event which is, or after notice or passage of time or
both would be, an Event of Default.

     "Designated Senior Debt" means any Senior Debt which has, at the time of
determination, an aggregate principal amount outstanding of at least $10.0
million (including the amount of all undrawn commitments and matured and
contingent reimbursement obligations pursuant to letters of credit thereunder)
that is specifically designated in the instrument evidencing such Senior Debt
and is designated in a notice delivered by the Company to the holders or a
Representative of the holders of such Senior Debt and in an Officers'
Certificate delivered to the Trustee as "Designated Senior Debt" of the Company
for purposes of the Indenture; provided that the New Credit Facility shall be
deemed to be Designated Senior Debt under the Indenture.

     "Disqualified Dividends" means, for any dividend with respect to
Disqualified Stock, the quotient of the dividend divided by the difference
between one and the maximum statutory federal income tax rate (expressed as a
decimal number between 1 and 0) then applicable to the issuer of such
Disqualified Stock.
    
     "Disqualified Stock" means, with respect to any Person, Redeemable Stock
(as defined herein) such Person as to which (i) the maturity, (ii) mandatory
redemption or (iii) redemption, repurchase, conversion or exchange at the option
of the holder thereof occurs, or may occur, on or prior to the first anniversary
of the Stated Maturity of the Exchange Notes; provided, however, that Redeemable
Stock of such Person that would not otherwise be characterized as Disqualified
Stock under this definition shall not constitute Disqualified Stock (a) if such
Redeemable Stock is convertible or exchangeable into Debt or Disqualified Stock
solely at the option of the issuer thereof or (b) solely as a result of
provisions thereof giving holders thereof the right to require such Person to
repurchase or redeem such Redeemable Stock upon the occurrence of a "change of
control" occurring prior to the first anniversary of the Stated Maturity of the
Exchange Notes, if (x) such repurchase obligation may not be triggered in
respect of such Redeemable Stock unless a corresponding obligation also arises
with respect to the Exchange Notes and (y) no such repurchase or redemption is
permitted to be consummated unless and until such Person shall have satisfied
all repurchase or redemption obligations with respect to any required purchase
offer made with respect to the Exchange Notes.     
    
     "Domestic Restricted Subsidiary" means any Restricted Subsidiary other than
(a) a Foreign Restricted Subsidiary (as defined herein) or (b) a Subsidiary of a
Foreign Restricted Subsidiary.     

                                       76
<PAGE>
 
     "EBITDA" means, for any period, an amount equal to, for the Company and its
consolidated Restricted Subsidiaries, (a) the sum of Consolidated Net Income for
such period, plus the following to the extent reducing Consolidated Net Income
for such period: (i) the provision for taxes based on income or profits or
utilized in computing net loss, (ii) Consolidated Interest Expense, (iii)
depreciation, (iv) amortization expense and (v) any other non-cash items (other
than any such non-cash item to the extent that it represents an accrual of or
reserve for cash expenditures in any future period), minus (b) all non-cash
items increasing Consolidated Net Income for such period (other than any such
non-cash item to the extent that it will result in the receipt of cash payments
in any future period). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the provision for taxes
based on the income or profits of, and the depreciation and amortization of, a
Restricted Subsidiary shall be added to Consolidated Net Income to compute
EBITDA only to the extent (and in the same proportion) that the net income of
such Restricted Subsidiary was included in calculating Consolidated Net Income
and only if a corresponding amount would be permitted at the date of
determination to be dividended to the Company by such Restricted Subsidiary
without prior approval (that has not been obtained), pursuant to the terms of
its charter and all agreements, instruments, judgments, decrees, orders,
statutes, rules and governmental regulations applicable to such Restricted
Subsidiary or its shareholders.

     "Employee Notes" means promissory notes of employees of the Company,
Holding or any of their Subsidiaries payable to the Company or Holding and
received in connection with the substantially concurrent purchase of common
stock of the Company or Holding by such employees.

     "Event of Default" has the meaning set forth under "-Events of Default".

     "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

     "Fair Market Value" means, with respect to any Property, the price which
could be negotiated in an arm's-length free market transaction, for cash,
between a willing seller and a willing buyer, neither of whom is under undue
pressure or compulsion to complete the transaction. Fair Market Value will be
determined, except as otherwise provided, (a) if such Property has a Fair Market
Value equal to or less than $2.5 million, by any Officer of the Company or (b)
if such Property has a Fair Market Value in excess of $2.5 million, by a
majority of the Board of Directors and evidenced by a Board Resolution, dated
within 30 days of the relevant transaction, delivered to the Trustee.

     "Foreign Restricted Subsidiary" means any Restricted Subsidiary which is
not organized under the laws of the United States of America or any State
thereof or the District of Columbia.

     "GAAP" means United States generally accepted accounting principles as in
effect on the Issue Date, including those set forth (a) in the opinions and
pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute of
Certified Public Accountants, (b) in the statements and pronouncements of the
Financial Accounting Standards Board, (c) in such other statements by such other
entity as approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession and (d)
the rules and regulations of the Commission governing the inclusion of financial
statements (including pro forma financial statements) in periodic reports
required to be filed pursuant to Section 13 of the Exchange Act, including
opinions and pronouncements in staff accounting bulletins and similar written
statements from the accounting staff of the Commission.

     "Guarantee" means any obligation, contingent or otherwise, of any Person
directly or indirectly guaranteeing any Debt of any other Person and any
obligation, direct or indirect, contingent or otherwise, of such Person (a) to
purchase or pay (or advance or supply funds for the purchase or payment of) such
Debt of such other Person (whether arising by virtue of partnership
arrangements, or by agreements to keep-well, to purchase assets, goods,
securities or services, to take-or-pay or to maintain financial statement
conditions or otherwise) or (b) entered into for the purpose of assuring in any
other manner the obligee against loss in respect thereof (in whole or in part);
provided, however, that the term "Guarantee" shall not include endorsements for
collection or deposit in the ordinary course of business. The term "Guarantee"
used as a verb has a corresponding meaning. The term "Guarantor" shall mean any
Person Guaranteeing any obligation.

     "Hedging Obligation" of any Person means any obligation of such Person
pursuant to any Interest Rate Agreement, Currency Exchange Protection Agreement
or any other similar agreement or arrangement.

                                       77
<PAGE>
 
     "Holding" means River Holding Corp., the corporate parent of the Company,
and any successor thereto.

     "Incur" means, with respect to any Debt or other obligation of any Person,
to create, issue, incur (by merger, conversion, exchange or otherwise), extend,
assume, Guarantee or become liable in respect of such Debt or other obligation
or the recording, as required pursuant to GAAP or otherwise, of any such Debt or
obligation on the balance sheet of such Person (and "Incurrence" and "Incurred"
shall have meanings correlative to the foregoing); provided, however, that a
change in GAAP that results in an obligation of such Person that exists at such
time, and is not theretofore classified as Debt, becoming Debt shall not be
deemed an Incurrence of such Debt; provided further, however, that solely for
purposes of determining compliance with "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on
Company and Subsidiary Guarantor Debt" and "--Limitation on Non-Guarantor
Subsidiary Debt", amortization of debt discount shall not be deemed to be the
Incurrence of Debt, provided that in the case of Debt sold at a discount, the
amount of such Debt Incurred shall at all times be the aggregate principal
amount at Stated Maturity.

     "Industrias Hudson" means Industrias Hudson S.A. de C.V.

     "Independent Appraiser" means an investment banking firm of national
standing or any third party appraiser of national standing, provided that such
firm or appraiser is not an Affiliate of the Company.

     "Interest Rate Agreement" means, for any Person, any interest rate swap
agreement, interest rate cap agreement, interest rate collar agreement or other
similar agreement designed to protect against fluctuations in interest rates.

     "Investment" by any Person means any direct or indirect loan (other than
advances to customers in the ordinary course of business that are recorded as
accounts receivable on the balance sheet of such Person), advance or other
extension of credit or capital contribution (by means of transfers of cash or
other Property to others or payments for Property or services for the account or
use of others, or otherwise) to, or Incurrence of a Guarantee of any obligation
of, or purchase or acquisition of Capital Stock, bonds, notes, debentures or
other securities or evidence of Debt issued by, any other Person. For purposes
of the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Restricted
Payments", "--Designation of Restricted and Unrestricted Subsidiaries" and the
definition of "Restricted Payment", "Investment" shall include the portion
(proportionate to the Company's equity interest in such Subsidiary) of the Fair
Market Value of the net assets of any Subsidiary of the Company at the time that
such Subsidiary is designated an Unrestricted Subsidiary; provided, however,
that upon a redesignation of such Subsidiary as a Restricted Subsidiary, the
Company shall be deemed to continue to have a permanent "Investment" in an
Unrestricted Subsidiary equal to an amount (if positive) equal to (a) the
Company's "Investment" in such Subsidiary at the time of such redesignation less
(b) the portion (proportionate to the Company's equity interest in such
Subsidiary) of the Fair Market Value of the net assets of such Subsidiary at the
time of such redesignation. In determining the amount of any Investment made by
transfer of any Property other than cash, such Property shall be valued at its
Fair Market Value at the time of such Investment.

     "Issue Date" means the date on which the Exchange Notes are initially
issued.

     "Lien" means, with respect to any Property of any Person, any mortgage or
deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, assignment, deposit arrangement, security
interest, lien, charge, easement (other than any easement not materially
impairing usefulness or marketability), encumbrance, preference, priority or
other security agreement or preferential arrangement of any kind or nature
whatsoever on or with respect to such Property (including any Capital Lease
Obligation, conditional sale or other title retention agreement having
substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing or any Sale and
Leaseback Transaction).

     "Merger Agreement" means the Amended and Restated Merger Agreement between
Holding, River Acquisition Corp., the Company and shareholders of the Company
dated as of March 15, 1998, as in effect on the Issue Date.

     "Mirror Preferred Stock" means the 11 1/2% Senior PIK Preferred Stock due
2010 of the Company.

                                       78
<PAGE>
 
     "Moody's" means Moody's Investors Service, Inc. or any successor to the
rating agency business thereof.

     "Net Available Cash" from any Asset Sale means cash payments received
therefrom (including any cash payments received by way of deferred payment of
principal pursuant to a note or installment receivable or otherwise, but only as
and when received, but excluding any other consideration received in the form of
assumption by the acquiring Person of Debt or other obligations relating to the
Property that is the subject of such Asset Sale or received in any other noncash
form), in each case net of (a) all legal, title and recording tax expenses,
commissions and other fees and expenses incurred, and all Federal, state,
provincial, foreign and local taxes required to be accrued as a liability under
GAAP, as a consequence of such Asset Sale, (b) all payments made on any Debt
which is secured by any Property subject to such Asset Sale, in accordance with
the terms of any Lien upon or other security agreement of any kind with respect
to such Property, or which must by its terms, or in order to obtain a necessary
consent to such Asset Sale, or by applicable law, be repaid out of the proceeds
from such Asset Sale, (c) all distributions and other payments required to be
made to minority interest holders in Subsidiaries or joint ventures as a result
of such Asset Sale and (d) the deduction of appropriate amounts provided by the
seller as a reserve, in accordance with GAAP, against any liabilities associated
with the Property disposed in such Asset Sale and retained by the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary after such Asset Sale.

     "New Credit Facility" means the credit facilities made available pursuant
to the Credit Agreement dated as of April 7, 1998 among the Company, Holding,
the lenders party thereto, Salomon Smith Barney Inc, as Arranger, Advisor and
Syndication Agent and Bankers Trust Company, as Administrative Agent.

     "Officer" means the Chief Executive Officer, the President, the Chief
Financial Officer or any Executive Vice President of the Company.

     "Officers' Certificate" means a certificate signed by two Officers of the
Company, at least one of whom shall be the principal executive officer or
principal financial officer of the Company, and delivered to the Trustee.

     "Opinion of Counsel" means a written opinion from legal counsel who is
acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or counsel to the
Company or the Trustee.

     "Permitted Holders" means Helen Hudson Lovaas, any member of the senior
management of the Company or Holding on the Issue Date and Freeman Spogli & Co.
Incorporated or any successor entity thereof controlled by the principals of
Freeman Spogli & Co. Incorporated or any entity controlled by, or under common
control with, Freeman Spogli & Co. Incorporated.
    
     "Permitted Investment" means any Investment by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary in (a) any Restricted Subsidiary or any Person that will, upon the
making of such Investment, become a Restricted Subsidiary; provided that the
primary business of such Restricted Subsidiary is a Related Business; (b) any
Person if as a result of such Investment such Person is merged or consolidated
with or into, or transfers or conveys all or substantially all its Property to,
the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary; provided that such Person's primary
business is a Related Business; (c) Temporary Cash Investments (as defined
herein); (d) receivables owing to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary, if
created or acquired in the ordinary course of business and payable or
dischargeable in accordance with customary trade terms; provided, however, that
such trade terms may include such concessionary trade terms as the Company or
such Restricted Subsidiary deems reasonable under the circumstances; (e)
payroll, travel and similar advances to cover matters that are expected at the
time of such advances ultimately to be treated as expenses for accounting
purposes and that are made in the ordinary course of business; (f) (i) loans and
advances to employees made in the ordinary course of business consistent with
past practices of the Company or such Restricted Subsidiary, as the case may be;
provided that such loans and advances do not exceed $1.0 million at any one time
outstanding and (ii) loans and advances to, or the receipt of Employee Notes
from, employees of Holding, the Company or any of their Subsidiaries made or
received in connection with the substantially concurrent purchase of common
stock of Holding or the Company by such employees; provided that the aggregate
principal amount of such loans, advances and notes payable shall not exceed $1.0
million at any one time outstanding; (g) stock, obligations or other securities
received in settlement of debts created in the ordinary course of business and
owing to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary or in satisfaction of judgments;
(h) any Person to the extent such Investment represents the non-cash portion of
the consideration received in connection with an Asset Sale consummated in
compliance with     

                                       79
<PAGE>
 
the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Asset Sales";
and (i) Investments in Persons engaged in a Related Business not to exceed $10.0
million at any one time outstanding (it being agreed that an Investment shall
cease to be outstanding to the extent of dividends, repayments of loans or
advances or other transfers of Property received by the Company or any
Restricted Subsidiary from such Persons, provided that such amounts do not
increase the amount of Restricted Payments which the Company and the Restricted
Subsidiaries may make pursuant to clause (c)(iv)(A) of the covenant described
under "--Certain Covenants--Limitation on Restricted Payments").

     "Permitted Liens" means:

          (a) Liens securing Senior Debt of the Company or any Subsidiary
     Guarantor;

          (b) Liens for taxes, assessments or governmental charges or levies on
     the Property of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary if the same shall
     not at the time be delinquent or thereafter can be paid without penalty, or
     are being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings;

          (c) Liens imposed by law, such as carriers', warehousemen's and
     mechanics' Liens, on the Property of the Company or any Restricted
     Subsidiary arising in the ordinary course of business and securing payment
     of obligations which are not more than 60 days past due or are being
     contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings;

          (d) Liens on the Property of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
     Incurred in the ordinary course of business to secure performance of
     obligations with respect to statutory or regulatory requirements,
     performance or return-of-money bonds, surety or indemnity bonds or other
     obligations of a like nature and Incurred in a manner consistent with
     industry practice, in each case which are not Incurred in connection with
     the borrowing of money, the obtaining of advances or credit or the payment
     of the deferred purchase price of Property and which do not in the
     aggregate impair in any material respect the use of Property in the
     operation of the business of the Company and the Restricted Subsidiaries
     taken as a whole;

          (e) Liens on Property at the time the Company or any Restricted
     Subsidiary acquired such Property, including any acquisition by means of a
     merger or consolidation with or into the Company or any Restricted
     Subsidiary; provided, however, that any such Lien may not extend to any
     other Property of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary; provided
     further, however, that such Liens shall not have been Incurred in
     anticipation of or in connection with the transaction or series of
     transactions pursuant to which such Property was acquired by the Company or
     any Restricted Subsidiary;

          (f) Liens on the Property of a Person at the time such Person becomes
     a Restricted Subsidiary; provided, however, that any such Lien may not
     extend to any other Property of the Company or any other Restricted
     Subsidiary which is not a direct Subsidiary of such Person; provided
     further, however, that any such Lien was not Incurred in anticipation of or
     in connection with the transaction or series of transactions pursuant to
     which such Person became a Restricted Subsidiary;

          (g) pledges or deposits by the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
     under workmen's compensation laws, unemployment insurance laws or similar
     legislation, or good faith deposits in connection with bids, tenders,
     contracts (other than for the payment of Debt) or leases to which the
     Company or any Restricted Subsidiary is party, or deposits to secure public
     or statutory obligations of the Company, or deposits for the payment of
     rent, in each case Incurred in the ordinary course of business;

          (h) utility easements, building restrictions and such other
     encumbrances or charges against real Property as are of a nature generally
     existing with respect to properties of a similar character;

          (i) judgment and attachment Liens in connection with (A) judgments
     that do not constitute an Event of Default so long as the judgment creditor
     is not seeking enforcement thereof and reserves have been established to
     the extent required by GAAP as in effect at such time and (B) litigation
     and legal

                                       80
<PAGE>
 
     proceedings that are being contested in good faith by appropriate
     proceedings (or as to which the Company or Restricted Subsidiary, as the
     case may be, is preparing to promptly initiate appropriate proceedings) so
     long as reserves have been established to the extent required by GAAP as in
     effect at such time and so long as such Liens do not encumber assets by an
     aggregate amount (together with the amount of any unstayed judgments
     against the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary) in excess of $7.5
     million;

          (j) Liens existing on the Issue Date not otherwise described in
     clauses (a) through (i) above; and

          (k) Liens on the Property of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
     to secure any Refinancing, in whole or in part, of any Debt secured by
     Liens referred to in clause (a), (e), (f) or (j) above; provided, however,
     that any such Lien shall be limited to all or part of the same Property
     that secured the original Lien (together with improvements and accessions
     to such Property) and the aggregate principal amount of Debt that is
     secured by such Lien shall not be increased to an amount greater than the
     sum of (i) the outstanding principal amount, or, if greater, the committed
     amount, of the Debt secured by Liens described under clause (a), (e), (f)
     or (j) above, as the case may be, at the time the original Lien became a
     Permitted Lien under the Indenture and (ii) an amount necessary to pay any
     fees and expenses, including premiums and defeasance costs, Incurred by the
     Company or such Restricted Subsidiary in connection with such Refinancing.

     "Permitted Refinancing Debt" means any Debt that Refinances any other Debt,
including any successive Refinancings, so long as (a) such Debt is in an
aggregate principal amount (or if Incurred with original issue discount, an
aggregate issue price) not in excess of the sum of (i) the aggregate principal
amount (or if Incurred with original issue discount, the aggregate accreted
value) then outstanding of the Debt being Refinanced and (ii) an amount
necessary to pay any fees and expenses, including premiums and defeasance costs,
related to such Refinancing, (b) the Average Life of such Debt is equal to or
greater than the Average Life of the Debt being Refinanced, (c) the Stated
Maturity of such Debt is no earlier than the Stated Maturity of the Debt being
Refinanced and (d) such Debt is subordinated in right of payment to Senior Debt
and the Exchange Notes to at least the same extent, if any, as the Debt being
Refinanced; provided, however, that Permitted Refinancing Debt shall not include
(x) Debt of a Subsidiary that Refinances Debt of the Company or (y) Debt of the
Company or a Restricted Subsidiary that Refinances Debt of an Unrestricted
Subsidiary.

     "Person" means any individual, corporation, company (including any limited
liability company), partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated
organization, government or any agency or political subdivision thereof or any
other entity.

     "Preferred Stock" means any Capital Stock of a Person, however designated,
which entitles the holder thereof to a preference with respect to the payment of
dividends, or as to the distribution of assets upon any voluntary or involuntary
liquidation or dissolution of such Person, over shares of any other class of
Capital Stock issued by such Person.

     "pro forma" means, with respect to any calculation made or required to be
made pursuant to the terms hereof, a calculation performed in accordance with
Article 11 of Regulation S-X promulgated under the Securities Act, as
interpreted in good faith by the Board of Directors after consultation with the
independent certified public accountants of the Company, or otherwise a
calculation made in good faith by the Board of Directors after consultation with
the independent certified public accountants of the Company, as the case may be.

     "Property" means, with respect to any Person, any interest of such Person
in any kind of property or asset, whether real, personal or mixed, or tangible
or intangible, including Capital Stock in, and other securities of, any other
Person.

     "Public Equity Offering" means an underwritten public offering of common
stock of the Company pursuant to an effective registration statement under the
Securities Act.

                                       81
<PAGE>
 
     "Purchase Money Debt" means Debt (a) consisting of the deferred purchase
price of property, conditional sale obligations, obligations under any title
retention agreement, other purchase money obligations and obligations in respect
of industrial revenue bonds, in each case where the maturity of such Debt does
not exceed the anticipated useful life of the asset being financed, and (b)
Incurred to finance the acquisition or construction by the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary of such asset, including remodelling thereof and additions
and improvements thereto; provided, however, that such Debt is Incurred within
180 days after such acquisition of such asset by the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary or completion of such construction, remodelling, addition or
improvement, as the case may be.

     "Redeemable Stock" means, with respect to any Person, any Capital Stock
that by its terms (or by the terms of any security into which it is convertible
or for which it is exchangeable, in either case at the option of the holder
thereof) or otherwise (a) matures or is mandatorily redeemable pursuant to a
sinking fund obligation or otherwise, (b) is or may become redeemable or
repurchaseable at the option of the holder thereof, in whole or in part, or (c)
is convertible or exchangeable, in either case at the option of the holder
thereof, for Debt or Disqualified Stock.

     "Refinance" means, in respect of any Debt, to refinance, extend, renew,
refund, repay, prepay, redeem, defease or retire, or to issue other Debt, in
exchange or replacement for, such Debt. "Refinanced" and "Refinancing" shall
have correlative meanings.

     "Related Business" means any business that is related, ancillary or
complementary to the businesses of the Company and the Restricted Subsidiaries
on the Issue Date.

     "Representative" means the trustee, agent or representative expressly
authorized to act in such capacity, if any, for an issue of Senior Debt.

     "Restricted Payment" means (a) any dividend or distribution (whether made
in cash, securities or other Property) declared or paid on or with respect to
any shares of Capital Stock of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary
(including any payment in connection with any merger or consolidation with or
into the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary), except for any dividend or
distribution which is made solely to the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary
(and, if such Restricted Subsidiary is not a Wholly Owned Subsidiary, to the
other shareholders of such Restricted Subsidiary on a pro rata basis or on a
basis that results in the receipt by the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary of
dividends or distributions of greater value than it would receive on a pro rata
basis) or any dividend or distribution payable solely in shares of Capital Stock
(other than Disqualified Stock) of the Company; (b) the purchase, repurchase,
redemption, acquisition or retirement for value of any Capital Stock of the
Company or any Affiliate of the Company (other than from the Company or a
Restricted Subsidiary) or any securities exchangeable for or convertible into
any such Capital Stock, including the exercise of any option to exchange any
Capital Stock (other than for or into Capital Stock of the Company that is not
Disqualified Stock); (c) the purchase, repurchase, redemption, acquisition or
retirement for value, prior to any scheduled maturity, scheduled sinking fund or
mandatory redemption payment, any Subordinated Obligation (other than the
purchase, repurchase or other acquisition of any Subordinated Obligation
purchased in anticipation of satisfying a sinking fund obligation, principal
installment or final maturity, in each case due within one year of the date of
acquisition); or (d) any Investment (other than Permitted Investments) in any
Person.

     "Restricted Subsidiary" means (a) any Subsidiary of the Company unless such
Subsidiary shall have been designated an Unrestricted Subsidiary as permitted or
required pursuant to the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--
Designation of Restricted and Unrestricted Subsidiaries" and (b) an Unrestricted
Subsidiary which is redesignated as a Restricted Subsidiary as permitted
pursuant to the covenant described under "--Certain Covenants--Designation of
Restricted and Unrestricted Subsidiaries".

     "S&P" means Standard & Poor's Ratings Service or any successor to the
rating agency business thereof.

     "Sale and Leaseback Transaction" means any arrangement relating to Property
now owned or hereafter acquired whereby the Company or a Restricted Subsidiary
transfers such Property to another Person and the Company or a Restricted
Subsidiary leases it from such Person.

                                       82
<PAGE>
 
     "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933.

     "Senior Debt" of the Company means (a) all obligations consisting of the
principal, premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest (including interest
accruing on or after the filing of any petition in bankruptcy or for
reorganization relating to the Company to the extent post-filing interest is
allowed in such proceeding) in respect of (i) Debt of the Company for borrowed
money and (ii) Debt of the Company evidenced by notes, debentures, bonds or
other similar instruments permitted under the Indenture for the payment of which
the Company is responsible or liable; (b) all Capital Lease Obligations of the
Company; (c) all obligations of the Company (i) for the reimbursement of any
obligor on any letter of credit, bankers' acceptance or similar credit
transaction, (ii) under Hedging Obligations or (iii) issued or assumed as the
deferred purchase price of Property and all conditional sale obligations of the
Company and all obligations under any title retention agreement permitted under
the Indenture; and (d) all obligations of other Persons of the type referred to
in clauses (a), (b) and (c) for the payment of which the Company is responsible
or liable as Guarantor; provided, however, that Senior Debt shall not include
(A) Debt of the Company that is by its terms subordinate or pari passu in right
of payment to the Exchange Notes, including any Senior Subordinated Debt or any
Subordinated Obligations; (B) any Debt Incurred in violation of the provisions
of the Indenture; (C) accounts payable or any other obligations of the Company
to trade creditors created or assumed by the Company in the ordinary course of
business in connection with the obtaining of materials or services (including
Guarantees thereof or instruments evidencing such liabilities); (D) any
liability for Federal, state, local or other taxes owed or owing by the Company;
(E) any obligation of the Company to any Subsidiary; or (F) any obligations with
respect to any Capital Stock. "Senior Debt" of any Subsidiary Guarantor has a
correlative meaning.

     "Senior Subordinated Debt" of the Company means the Exchange Notes and any
other subordinated Debt of the Company that specifically provides that such Debt
is to rank pari passu with the Exchange Notes and is not subordinated by its
terms to any other subordinated Debt or other obligation of the Company which is
not Senior Debt. "Senior Subordinated Debt" of any Subsidiary Guarantor has a
correlative meaning.

     "Significant Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary that would be a "Significant
Subsidiary" of the Company within the meaning of Rule 1-02 under Regulation S-X
promulgated by the Commission.

     "Stated Maturity" means, with respect to any security, the date specified
in such security as the fixed date on which the payment of principal of such
security is due and payable, including pursuant to any mandatory redemption
provision (but excluding any provision providing for the repurchase of such
security at the option of the holder thereof upon the happening of any
contingency beyond the control of the issuer unless such contingency has
occurred).

     "Subordinated Obligation" means any Debt of the Company or any Subsidiary
Guarantor (whether outstanding on the Issue Date or thereafter Incurred) which
is subordinate or junior in right of payment to the Exchange Notes or the
applicable Subsidiary Guarantee pursuant to a written agreement to that effect.

     "Subsidiary" means, in respect of any Person, any corporation, company,
association, partnership, joint venture or other business entity of which more
than 50% of the total voting power of shares of Capital Stock or other interests
(including partnership interests) entitled (without regard to the occurrence of
any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees
thereof is at the time owned or controlled directly or indirectly, by (a) such
Person, (b) such Person and one or more Subsidiaries of such Person or (c) one
or more Subsidiaries of such Person.

     "Subsidiary Guarantor" means each Domestic Restricted Subsidiary that
becomes a Subsidiary Guarantor pursuant to the covenant described under "--
Certain Covenants--Limitation on Non-Guarantor Subsidiary Debt".

     "Subsidiary Guaranty" means a Guarantee on the terms set forth in the
Indenture by a Subsidiary Guarantor of the Company's obligations with respect to
the Exchange Notes.

     "Temporary Cash Investments" means any of the following: (a) Investments in
U.S. Government Obligations; (b) Investments in time deposit accounts,
certificates of deposit and money market deposits maturing within 90 days of the
date of acquisition thereof issued by a bank or trust company which is organized
under the

                                       83
<PAGE>
 
laws of the United States of America or any state thereof having capital,
surplus and undivided profits aggregating in excess of $500.0 million and whose
long-term debt is rate "A-3" or "A-" or higher according to Moody's or S&P (or
such similar equivalent rating by at least one "nationally recognized
statistical rating organization" (as defined in Rule 436 under the Securities
Act); (c) repurchase obligations with a term of not more than 30 days for
underlying securities of the types described in clause (a) entered into with a
bank meeting the qualifications described in clause (b) above; (d) Investments
in commercial paper, maturing not more than 90 days after the date of
acquisition, issued by a corporation (other than an Affiliate of the Company)
organized and in existence under the laws of the United States of America with a
rating at the time as of which any Investment therein is made of "P-1" (or
higher) according to Moody's or "A-1" (or higher) according to S&P (or such
similar equivalent rating by at least one "nationally recognized statistical
rating organization" (as defined in Rule 436 under the Securities Act); (e)
direct obligations (or certificates representing an ownership interest in such
obligations) of any state of the United States of America (including any agency
or instrumentality thereof) for the payment of which the full faith and credit
of such state is pledged and which are not callable or redeemable at the
issuer's option, provided that (i) the long-term debt of such state is rated "A-
3" or "A-" or higher according to Moody's or S&P (or such similar equivalent
rating by at least one "nationally recognized statistical rating organization"
(as defined in Rule 436 under the Securities Act)) and (ii) such obligations
mature within 180 days of the date of acquisition thereof; and (f) investments
in money market funds which invest substantially all their assets in securities
of the types described in clauses (a) through (e) above.

     "Unrestricted Subsidiary" means (a) any Subsidiary of the Company in
existence on the Issue Date that is not a Restricted Subsidiary; (b) any
Subsidiary of an Unrestricted Subsidiary; and (c) any Subsidiary of the Company
that is designated after the Issue Date as an Unrestricted Subsidiary as
permitted or required pursuant to the covenant described under "--Certain
Covenants--Designation of Restricted and Unrestricted Subsidiaries" and not
thereafter redesignated as a Restricted Subsidiary as permitted pursuant
thereto.

     "U.S. Government Obligations" means direct obligations (or certificates
representing an ownership interest in such obligations) of the United States of
America (including any agency or instrumentality thereof) for the payment of
which the full faith and credit of the United States of America is pledged and
which are not callable or redeemable at the issuer's option.

     "Voting Stock" of a corporation means all classes of Capital Stock of such
corporation then outstanding and normally entitled (without regard to the
occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or
trustees thereof.

     "Wholly Owned Subsidiary" means, at any time, a Restricted Subsidiary all
the Voting Stock of which (except directors' qualifying shares) is at such time
owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company and its other Wholly Owned
Subsidiaries.


BOOK-ENTRY SYSTEM

     The Exchange Notes may be issued in the form of one or more global
securities (collectively, a "Global Security"). A Global Security will be
deposited with, or on behalf of, the DTC and registered in the name of the DTC
or its nominee. Except as set forth below, a Global Security may be transferred,
in whole and not in part, only to the DTC or another nominee of the DTC.
Investors may hold their beneficial interests in a Global Security directly
through the DTC if they have an account with the DTC or indirectly through
organizations which have accounts with the DTC.

     Depository Procedures

     Upon the issuance of a Global Security, DTC or its nominee will credit the
accounts of Persons holding through it with the respective principal amounts of
the Exchange Notes represented by such Global Security purchased by such Persons
in the Offering. Such accounts shall be designated by the Initial Purchasers.
Ownership of beneficial interests in a Global Security will be limited to
Persons that have accounts with DTC ("participants") or Persons that may hold
interests through participants. Any Person acquiring an interest in a Global
Security

                                       84
<PAGE>
 
through an offshore transaction in reliance on Regulation S of the Securities
Act may hold such interest through Cedel or Euroclear. Ownership of beneficial
interests in a Global Security will be shown on, and the transfer of that
ownership interest will be effected only through, records maintained by DTC
(with respect to participants' interests) and such participants (with respect to
the owners of beneficial interests in such Global Security other than
participants). The laws of some jurisdictions require that certain purchasers of
securities take physical delivery of such securities in definitive form. Such
limits and such laws may impair the ability to transfer beneficial interests in
a Global Security.

     Payment of principal of and interest on Exchange Notes represented by a
Global Security will be made in immediately available funds to DTC or its
nominee, as the case may be, as the sole registered owner and the sole holder of
the Exchange Notes represented thereby for all purposes under the Indenture. The
Company has been advised by DTC that upon receipt of any payment of principal of
or interest on any Global Security, DTC will immediately credit, on its book-
entry registration and transfer system, the accounts of participants with
payments in amounts proportionate to their respective beneficial interests in
the principal or face amount of such Global Security as shown on the records of
DTC. Payments by participants to owners of beneficial interests in a Global
Security held through such participants will be governed by standing
instructions and customary practices as is now the case with securities held for
customer accounts registered in "street name" and will be the sole
responsibility of such participants.

     A Global Security may not be transferred except as a whole by DTC or a
nominee of DTC to a nominee of DTC or to DTC. A Global Security is exchangeable
for certificated Exchange Notes only if (a) DTC notifies the Company that it is
unwilling or unable to continue as a depositary for such Global Security or if
at any time DTC ceases to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange
Act, (b) the Company in its discretion at any time determines not to have all
the Exchange Notes represented by such Global Security or (c) there shall have
occurred and be continuing a Default or an Event of Default with respect to the
Exchange Notes represented by such Global Security. Any Global Security that is
exchangeable for certificated Exchange Notes pursuant to the preceding sentence
will be exchanged for certificated Exchange Notes in authorized denominations
and registered in such names as DTC or any successor depositary holding such
Global Security may direct. Subject to the foregoing, a Global Security is not
exchangeable, except for a Global Security of like denomination to be registered
in the name of DTC or any successor depositary or its nominee. In the event that
a Global Security becomes exchangeable for certificated Exchange Notes, (a)
certificated Exchange Notes will be issued only in fully registered form in
denominations of $1,000 or integral multiples thereof, (b) payment of principal
of, and premium, if any, and interest on, the certificated Exchange Notes will
be payable, and the transfer of the certificated Exchange Notes will be
registerable, at the office or agency of the Company maintained for such
purposes and (c) no service charge will be made for any registration of transfer
or exchange of the certificated Exchange Notes, although the Company may require
payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge imposed in
connection therewith.

     So long as DTC or any successor depositary for a Global Security, or any
nominee, is the registered owner of such Global Security, DTC or such successor
depositary or nominee, as the case may be, will be considered the sole owner or
holder of the Exchange Notes represented by such Global Security for all
purposes under the Indenture and the Exchange Notes. Except as set forth above,
owners of beneficial interests in a Global Security will not be entitled to have
the Exchange Notes represented by such Global Security registered in their
names, will not receive or be entitled to receive physical delivery of
certificated Exchange Notes in definitive form and will not be considered to be
the owners or holders of any Exchange Notes under such Global Security.
Accordingly, each Person owning a beneficial interest in a Global Security must
rely on the procedures of DTC or any successor depositary, and, if such Person
is not a participant, on the procedures of the participant through which such
Person owns its interest, to exercise any rights of a holder under the
Indenture. The Company understands that under existing industry practices, in
the event that the Company requests any action of holders or that an owner of a
beneficial interest in a Global Security desires to give or take any action
which a holder is entitled to give or take under the Indenture, DTC or any
successor depositary would authorize the participants holding the relevant
beneficial interest to give or take such action and such participants would
authorize beneficial owners owning through such participants to give or take
such action or would otherwise act upon the instructions of beneficial owners
owning through them.

                                       85
<PAGE>
 
     DTC has advised the Company that DTC is a limited-purpose trust company
organized under the Banking Law of the State of New York, a member of the
Federal Reserve System, a "clearing corporation" within the meaning of the New
York Uniform Commercial Code and a "clearing agency" registered under the
Exchange Act. DTC was created to hold the securities of its participants and to
facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions among its
participants in such securities through electronic book-entry changes in
accounts of the participants, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement
of securities certificates. DTC's participants include securities brokers and
dealers (which may include the Initial Purchasers), banks, trust companies,
clearing corporations and certain other organizations some of whom (or their
representatives) own DTC. Access to DTC's book-entry system is also available to
others, such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies, that clear through
or maintain a custodial relationship with a participant, either directly or
indirectly.

     Although DTC has agreed to the foregoing procedures in order to facilitate
transfers of interests in Global Securities among participants of DTC, it is
under no obligation to perform or continue to perform such procedures, and such
procedures may be discontinued at any time.  None of the Company, the Trustee or
the Initial Purchasers will have any responsibility for the performance by DTC
or its participants or indirect participants of their respective obligations
under the rules and procedures governing their operations.

 

                                       86
<PAGE>
 
                        DESCRIPTION OF OTHER SECURITIES

EXCHANGE PREFERRED STOCK

     In connection with the Recapitalization, Holding issued 300,000 shares of
its 11 1/2% Senior Exchangeable PIK Preferred Stock due 2010, $100 liquidation
preference per share (the "Holding Preferred Stock").  Concurrently with the
Exchange Offer, Holding is offering to exchange the Holding Preferred Stock for
its 11 1/2% Senior Exchangeable PIK Preferred Stock due 2010 (the "Exchange
Preferred Stock"), which Exchange Preferred Stock in being registered pursuant
to the terms of the Exchange Offer Registration Agreement.

     Subject to certain conditions, the Holding Preferred Stock is, and the
Exchange Preferred Stock will be, exchangeable for the Company's 11 1/2%
Subordinated Exchange Debentures due 2010 or the Company's 11 1/2% Senior
Exchangeable PIK Preferred Stock due 2010, $100 liquidation preference per
share, at the option of Holding at any time. When issued, the Exchange Preferred
Stock will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable. The holders of the
Exchange Preferred Stock will have no preemptive or preferential right to
purchase or subscribe to stock, obligations, warrants, or other securities of
Holding of any class.

     Ranking. The Exchange Preferred Stock will, with respect to dividend rights
and rights on liquidation, winding up and dissolution, rank (i) senior to all
classes of common stock and to each other class of capital stock or series of
preferred stock of Holding, the terms of which do not expressly provide that it
ranks senior to, or on a parity with, the Exchange Preferred Stock as to
dividend rights and rights on liquidation, winding-up and dissolution of Holding
("Junior Stock"); and (ii) on a parity with each other class of capital stock or
series of preferred stock of Holding, the terms of which expressly provide that
such class or series will rank on a parity with the Exchange Preferred Stock as
to dividend rights and rights on liquidation, winding-up and dissolution
("Parity Stock"). While any shares of Exchange Preferred Stock are outstanding,
Holding may not authorize, create or increase the authorized amount of any class
or series of capital stock or preferred stock, the terms of which expressly
provide that such class or series will rank senior to the Exchange Preferred
Stock as to dividend rights and rights upon liquidation, winding-up and
dissolution of Holding (collectively referred to as "Senior Stock"), or Parity
Stock, without the consent of the holders of at least 66 2/3% of the outstanding
shares of Exchange Preferred Stock. Creditors of Holding will have priority over
the Exchange Preferred Stock with respect to claims on the assets of Holding. In
addition, creditors and stockholders of Holding's subsidiaries, including the
Company and Industrias Hudson, will have priority over the Exchange Preferred
Stock with respect to claims on the assets of such subsidiaries, including
claims of Holding with respect to the Mirror Preferred Stock.

     Holding will rely upon distributions or advances from the Company and its
subsidiaries to provide the funds necessary to pay cash dividends on the
Exchange Preferred Stock. The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to
contractual and statutory limitations on their ability to make distributions and
advances to Holding. In particular, the New Credit Facility prohibits and the
Indenture governing the Notes and the Exchange Notes restricts the payment of
distributions and advances by the Company and its subsidiaries to Holding and
future agreements may contain similar restrictions.

     Dividends. The holders of shares of Exchange Preferred Stock will be
entitled to receive, when, as and if dividends are declared by the board of
directors of Holding out of funds of Holding legally available therefor,
cumulative preferential dividends from the date of issuance of the Exchange
Preferred Stock accruing at the rate per share of 11 1/2% per annum, payable
semi-annually on April 15 and October 15. Dividends will be payable in cash,
except that on each dividend payment date occurring on or prior to April 15,
2003, dividends may be paid, at Holding's option, by the issuance of additional
shares of Exchange Preferred Stock having an aggregate liquidation preference
equal to the amount of such dividends.

     Optional Redemption. The Exchange Preferred Stock will not be redeemable at
the option of Holding prior to April 15, 2003. Thereafter, the Exchange
Preferred Stock will be redeemable, at Holding's option, in whole or in part, at
any time or from time to time, upon not less than 30 no more than 60 days' prior
notice at the redemption prices set forth in the Certificate of Designation
governing the Exchange Preferred Stock (the "Certificate of Designation") plus
accumulated and unpaid dividends (including an amount in cash equal to a
prorated dividend for any partial dividend). In addition, at any time prior to
April 15, 2001, Holding may redeem,

                                       87
<PAGE>
 
at its option, (i) up to 50% or (ii) all but not less than all of the
outstanding shares of Exchange Preferred Stock with the proceeds of any public
equity offering of common stock of the Company at a redemption price (expressed
as a percentage of the liquidation preference thereof) of 111 1/2% plus
accumulated and unpaid dividends (including an amount in cash equal to a
prorated dividend for any partial dividend period). Any such redemption shall be
made upon consummation of such public equity offering upon not less than 30 nor
more than 60 days' notice.

    
     Exchange for Company Exchange Debentures or Company Preferred Stock.
Holding may, at its option, subject to certain conditions, exchange the Exchange
Preferred Stock at any time, in whole but not in part, for either Hudson RCI's
11-1/2% Subordinated Exchange Debentures due 2010 (the "Company Exchange
Debentures") or Hudson RCI's 11-1/2% Senior PIK Preferred Stock due 2010 (the
"Company Preferred Stock"); provided, however, that (i) on the date of such
exchange there are no accumulated and unpaid dividends on the Exchange Preferred
Stock (including the dividend payable on such date) or other contractual
impediments to such exchange; (ii) the exchange is permitted under applicable
laws; (iii) immediately after giving effect to such exchange, no Default (as
defined in the Company Exchange Indenture) or Voting Rights Triggering Event (as
defined in the Company Certificate of Designation), as applicable, shall have
occurred and be continuing; and (iv) the Company shall have delivered to the
Trustee under the Company Exchange Indenture or the transfer agent for the
Company Preferred Stock, as applicable, an opinion of counsel with respect to
the due authorization and issuance of the Company Exchange Debentures or Company
Preferred Stock, as applicable. The exchange of the Exchange Preferred Stock for
Company Exchange Debentures or Company Preferred Stock is prohibited by the
terms of the New Credit Facility and the exchange of Exchange Preferred Stock
for Company Exchange Debentures is limited by the terms of the Indenture
governing the Notes and the Exchange Notes. See "Description of the Exchange
Notes" and "Description of New Credit Facility."     

     Upon any exchange of Exchange Preferred Stock for Company Exchange
Debentures, holders of outstanding shares of Exchange Preferred Stock will be
entitled to receive $1.00 principal amount of Company Exchange Debentures for
each $1.00 liquidation preference of Exchange Preferred Stock held by them and
an amount in cash equal to a prorated dividend for any partial dividend period;
provided, however, that Holding may pay cash in lieu of issuing a Company
Exchange Debenture in a principal amount less than $1,000. Upon any exchange of
Exchange Preferred Stock for Company Preferred Stock holders of outstanding
shares of Exchange Preferred Stock will be entitled to receive shares of Company
Preferred Stock with an aggregate liquidation preference equal to the aggregate
liquidation preference of the shares of Exchange Preferred Stock so exchanged
and an amount in cash equal to a prorated dividend for any partial dividend
period. Holding may pay cash in lieu of issuing a fractional share of Company
Preferred Stock.

     Mandatory Redemption. On April 15, 2010, Holding will be required to redeem
(subject to the legal availability of funds therefor) all outstanding shares of
Exchange Preferred Stock at a price in cash equal to the liquidation preference
thereof, plus accumulated and unpaid dividends (including an amount in cash
equal to a prorated dividend for any partial dividend period), if any, to the
date of redemption. Holding will not be required to make sinking fund payments
with respect to the Exchange Preferred Stock.

     Liquidation Preference. Upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation,
dissolution or winding-up of Holding, each holder of Exchange Preferred Stock
will be entitled to be paid, out of the assets of Holding available for
distribution to stockholders, an amount equal to the liquidation preference per
share of Exchange Preferred Stock held by such holder, plus accumulated and
unpaid dividends thereon to the date fixed for liquidation, dissolution or
winding-up.

     Voting Rights. The holders of Exchange Preferred Stock, except as otherwise
required under Delaware law or as provided in the Certificate of Designation,
shall not be entitled or permitted to vote on any matter required or permitted
to be voted upon by the stockholders of Holding. The Certificate of Designation
will provide that if (i) dividends on the Exchange Preferred Stock are in
arrears and unpaid (and, in the case of dividends payable after April 15, 2003,
are not paid in cash) for six or more dividend periods (whether or not
consecutive), (ii) Holding fails to redeem the Exchange Preferred Stock on April
15, 2010, or fails to otherwise discharge any redemption obligation with respect
to the Exchange Preferred Stock, (iii) Holding fails to make an offer to
purchase all of the outstanding shares of Exchange Preferred Stock following a
change of control (whether or not Holding is permitted to do so by the terms of
the Indenture, the New Credit Facility or any other obligation of Holding), (iv)
a breach or violation of any covenant contained in the Certificate of
Designation occurs and, subject to certain exceptions, continues for a period of
30 days or more after Holding receives notice thereof specifying the default
from the

                                       88
<PAGE>
 
holders of at least 25% of the shares of Exchange Preferred Stock then
outstanding, (v) a breach or violation of any of the provisions of the Mirror
Preferred Stock occurs, or (vi) Holding fails to pay at final maturity (giving
effect to any applicable grace period) the principal amount of any indebtedness
of Holding or any subsidiary of Holding or the stated maturity of any such
indebtedness of Holding or any subsidiary of Holding is accelerated because of a
default and the total amount of such indebtedness exceeds $7.5 million
(individually, a "Voting Rights Triggering Event"), then the holders of the
outstanding shares of Exchange Preferred Stock, voting together as a class with
the holders of any other series of preferred stock upon which like rights have
been conferred and are exercisable, will be entitled to elect two additional
members to the board of directors of Holding to serve on such board of
directors, and the number of members of such board of directors will be
immediately and automatically increased by two.

     Repurchase at the Option of Holders Upon a Change of Control. Upon the
occurrence of certain events constituting a change of control of Holding, each
holder of Exchange Preferred Stock shall have the right to require Holding to
repurchase all or any part of such holder's Exchange Preferred Stock at a
purchase price equal to 101% of the liquidation preference thereof, plus accrued
and unpaid dividends thereon, if any, to the purchase date. Since the New Credit
Facility prohibits the Company from paying or making, and the Indenture limits
the ability of the Company to pay or make dividends or loans to Holding,
Holding's ability to pay cash to holders of Exchange Preferred Stock upon a
repurchase will be limited. See "Description of New Credit Facility" and
"Description of the Exchange Notes."

     Certain Covenants. The Certificate of Designation contains covenants
restricting the ability of Holding, the Company and the Company's restricted
subsidiaries to, among others, (i) incur additional debt, (ii) make certain
restricted payments and investments, (iii) issue or sell capital stock of
certain restricted subsidiaries, (iv) restrict distributions from certain
restricted subsidiaries, (v) enter into transactions with affiliates and (vi)
engage in certain consolidations, mergers or transfers of assets. In addition,
the Certificate of Designation restricts the ability of Holding to engage in any
business or activity other than those relating to the ownership of capital stock
of the Company. All of these restrictions will be subject to a number of
important qualifications.

     The preceding discussion of certain provisions of the Exchange Preferred
Stock is not intended to be exhaustive and is qualified in its entirety by
reference to the provisions of the Certificate of Designation governing the
Exchange Preferred Stock, copies of which are available upon request from
Holding.


MIRROR PREFERRED STOCK

     In connection with the Recapitalization, Holding acquired 300,000 shares of
the Company's 11 1/2% Senior PIK Preferred Stock due 2010 (the "Mirror Preferred
Stock"). Dividends on the Mirror Preferred Stock accrue from the date of
issuance and are payable semiannually in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of
each year (each a "Dividend Payment Date"), commencing October 15, 1998, at a
rate per annum of 11 1/2% of the liquidation preference per share. The
liquidation preference of each share of Mirror Preferred Stock is $100 (the
"Liquidation Preference"). Dividends are payable in cash, except that on each
Dividend Payment Date occurring on or prior to April 15, 2003, dividends may be
paid, at the Company's option, by the issuance of additional shares of Mirror
Preferred Stock (including fractional shares) having an aggregate liquidation
preference equal to the amount of such dividends. The Company is required to
redeem the Mirror Preferred Stock on April 15, 2010, at a redemption price equal
to 100% of the liquidation preference thereof plus accumulated and unpaid
dividends, if any, to the date of redemption.

     The Mirror Preferred Stock ranks (i) senior to all existing and future
Junior Stock of the Company and (ii) on a parity with all existing and future
Parity Stock of the Company. In addition, the Mirror Preferred Stock will rank
junior in right of payment to all obligations of the Company and its
subsidiaries, including Industrias Hudson. The Mirror Preferred will be entitled
to one half a vote per share on all matters submitted to the Company's common
shareholders and will vote as a class with the Common Stock. Upon consummation
of the Recapitalization, the Company amended the Mirror Preferred Stock to
contain additional provisions substantially similar to the Exchange Preferred
Stock, except that the Mirror Preferred Stock will not be exchangeable.

                                       89
<PAGE>
 
COMPANY PREFERRED STOCK

     If Holding elects to exchange any Exchange Preferred Stock for Company
Preferred Stock, holders of outstanding shares of Exchange Preferred Stock will
be entitled to receive shares of Company Preferred Stock with an aggregate
liquidation preference equal to the aggregate liquidation preference of the
shares of Exchange Preferred Stock so exchanged and an amount in cash equal to a
prorated dividend for any partial dividend period. Holding may pay cash in lieu
of a fractional share of Company Preferred Stock. If issued in exchange for the
Exchange Preferred Stock, the Company Preferred Stock will be validly issued,
fully paid and nonassessable. The holders of the Company Preferred Stock will
have no preemptive or preferential right to purchase or subscribe to stock,
obligations, warrants, or other securities of the Company of any class. The
Company Preferred Stock is expected to be eligible for trading in the Portal
Market.

     Ranking. The Company Preferred Stock will, with respect to dividend rights
and rights on liquidation, winding up and dissolution, rank (i) senior to all
existing and future Parity Stock of the Company and (ii) on a parity with all
existing and future Parity Stock of the Company. While any shares of Company
Preferred Stock are outstanding, the Company may not authorize, create or
increase the authorized amount of any class or series of Senior Stock or Parity
Stock without the consent of the holders of a least 66 2/3% of the outstanding
shares of Company Preferred Stock. Creditors of the Company, including the
lenders under the New Credit Facility and holders of the Notes, will have
priority over the Company Preferred Stock with respect to claims on the assets
of the Company. In addition, creditors and stockholders of the Company's
subsidiaries, including Industrias Hudson, will have priority over the Company
Preferred Stock with respect to claims on the assets of such subsidiaries.

     Dividends. The holders of shares of the Company Preferred Stock will be
entitled to receive, when, as and if dividends are declared by the board of
directors of the Company out of funds of the Company legally available therefor,
cumulative preferential dividends from the date of issuance of the Company
Preferred Stock accruing at the rate per share of 11 1/2% per annum, payable
semiannually. Dividends will be payable in cash, except that on each dividend
payment date occurring on or prior to April 15, 2003, dividends may be paid, at
the Company's option, by the issuance of additional shares of the Company
Preferred Stock (including fractional shares) having an aggregate liquidation
preference equal to the amount of such dividends.

     Optional Redemption. The Company Preferred Stock will not be redeemable at
the option of the Company prior to April 15, 2003. Thereafter, the Company
Preferred Stock will be redeemable, at the Company's option, in whole or in
part, at any time or from time to time, upon not less than 30 no more than 60
days' prior notice at the redemption prices set forth in the Certificate of
Designation governing the Company Preferred Stock (the "Company Exchange
Certificate of Designation") plus accumulated and unpaid dividends (including an
amount in cash equal to a prorated dividend for any partial dividend). In
addition, at any time prior to April 15, 2001, the Company may redeem, at its
option, (i) up to 50% or (ii) all but not less than all of the outstanding
shares of Company Preferred Stock with the proceeds of any public equity
offering of common stock of the Company at a redemption price (expressed as a
percentage of the liquidation preference thereof) of 111 1/2% plus accumulated
and unpaid dividends (including an amount in cash equal to a prorated dividend
for any partial dividend period). Any such redemption shall be made upon
consummation of such public equity offering upon not less than 30 nor more than
60 days' notice.

     Exchange for Company Exchange Debentures. The Company may, at its option,
subject to certain conditions, exchange the Company Preferred Stock, in whole
but not in part, for Company Exchange Debentures at any time; provided, however,
that (i) on the date of such exchange there are no accumulated and unpaid
dividends on the Company Preferred Stock (including the dividend payable on such
date) or other contractual impediments to such exchange; (ii) the exchange is
permitted under applicable laws; (iii) immediately after giving effect to such
exchange, no Default (as defined in the Company Exchange Indenture) shall have
occurred and be continuing; and (iv) the Company shall have delivered to the
Trustee under the Company Exchange Indenture an opinion of counsel with respect
to the due authorization and issuance of the Company Exchange Debentures. The
exchange of the Company Preferred Stock for Company Exchange Debentures is
limited by the terms of the New Credit Facility and the Indenture governing the
Notes and the Exchange Notes. See "Description of New Credit Facility" and
"Description of the Exchange Notes." Upon any exchange of Company Preferred
Stock for Company Exchange Debentures, holders of outstanding shares of Company
Preferred Stock will be entitled to receive $1.00 principal

                                       90
<PAGE>
 
amount of Company Exchange Debentures for each $1.00 liquidation preference of
Company Preferred Stock held by them and an amount in cash equal to a prorated
dividend for any partial dividend period; provided, however, that the Company
may pay cash in lieu of issuing a Company Exchange Debenture in a principal
amount less than $1,000.

     Mandatory Redemption. On April 15, 2010, the Company will be required to
redeem (subject to the legal availability of funds therefor) all outstanding
shares of Company Preferred Stock at a price in cash equal to the liquidation
preference thereof, plus accumulated and unpaid dividends (including an amount
in cash equal to a prorated dividend for any partial dividend period), if any,
to the date of redemption. The Company will not be required to make sinking fund
payments with respect to the Company Preferred Stock.

     Liquidation Preference. Upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation,
dissolution or winding-up of the Company, each holder of Company Preferred Stock
will be entitled to be paid, out of the assets of the Company available for
distribution to stockholders, an amount equal to the liquidation preference per
share of Company Preferred Stock held by such holder, plus accumulated and
unpaid dividends thereon to the date fixed for liquidation, dissolution or
winding-up.

     Voting Rights. The holders of Company Preferred Stock, except as otherwise
required under California law or as provided in the Company Exchange Certificate
of Designation, shall not be entitled or permitted to vote on any matter
required or permitted to be voted upon by the stockholders of the Company. The
Company Exchange Certificate of Designation will provide that if (i) dividends
on the Company Preferred Stock are in arrears and unpaid (and, in the case of
dividends payable after April 15, 2003, are not paid in cash) for six or more
dividend periods (whether or not consecutive), (ii) the Company fails to redeem
the Company Preferred Stock on April 15, 2010, or fails to otherwise discharge
any redemption obligation with respect to the Company Preferred Stock, (iii) the
Company fails to make an offer to purchase all of the outstanding shares of
Company Preferred Stock following a change of control (whether or not the
Company is permitted to do so by the terms of the Indenture, the New Credit
Facility or any other obligation of the Company), (iv) a breach or violation of
any covenant contained in the Certificate of Designation occurs and, subject to
certain exceptions, continues for a period of 30 days or more after the Company
receives notice thereof specifying the default from the holders of at least 25%
of the shares of Company Preferred Stock then outstanding, (v) a breach or
violation of any of the provisions of the Mirror Preferred Stock occurs, or (vi)
the Company fails to pay at final maturity (giving effect to any applicable
grace period) the principal amount of any indebtedness of the Company or any
subsidiary of the Company or the stated maturity of any such indebtedness of the
Company or any subsidiary of the Company is accelerated because of a default and
the total amount of such indebtedness exceeds $7.5 million, then the holders of
the outstanding shares of Company Preferred Stock, voting together as a class
with the holders of any other series of preferred stock upon which like rights
have been conferred and are exercisable, will be entitled to elect two
additional members to the board of directors of the Company to serve on such
board of directors, and the number of members of such board of directors will be
immediately and automatically increased by two.

     Repurchase at the Option of Holders Upon a Change of Control. Upon the
occurrence of certain events constituting a change of control of the Company,
each holder of Company Preferred Stock shall have the right to require the
Company to repurchase all or any part of such holder's Company Preferred Stock
at a purchase price equal to 101% of the liquidation preference thereof, plus
accrued and unpaid dividends thereon, if any, to the purchase date. The
indenture governing the Notes limits the ability of the Company to repurchase
the Company Preferred Stock.

     Certain Covenants. The Company Exchange Certificate of Designation contains
covenants restricting the ability of the Company and the Company's subsidiaries
to, among others, (i) incur additional debt, (ii) make certain restricted
payments and investments, (iii) issue or sell capital stock of certain
restricted subsidiaries, (iv) restrict distributions from certain restricted
subsidiaries, (v) enter into transactions with affiliates and (vi) engage in
certain consolidations, mergers or transfers of assets. All of these
restrictions will be subject to a number of important qualifications.

                                       91
<PAGE>
 
     The preceding discussion of certain provisions of the Company Preferred
Stock is not intended to be exhaustive and is qualified in its entirety by
reference to the provisions of the Company Exchange Certificate of Designation
governing the Company Preferred Stock, copies of which are available upon
request from the Company.

COMPANY EXCHANGE DEBENTURES

     The Company Exchange Debentures, if issued, will be issued under the
Exchange Indenture dated as of April 7, 1998 (the "Company Exchange Indenture").
The Company Exchange Debentures are expected to be eligible for trading in the
Portal Market.

     The Company Exchange Debentures will mature on April 15, 2010 and will be
limited in aggregate principal amount to the liquidation preference of the
Exchange Preferred Stock or Company Preferred Stock, as the case may be, plus
without duplication, accumulated and unpaid dividends on the exchange date of
the Exchange Preferred Stock into Company Exchange Debentures (plus any
additional Company Exchange Debentures issued in lieu of cash interest as
described herein).

     Interest. The Company Exchange Debentures will bear interest at the rate of
11 1/2% per annum from the most recent date on which interest has been paid or,
if no interest has been paid from the Exchange Date, payable semiannually in
cash (or, on or prior to April 15, 2003, in additional Company Exchange
Debentures, at the option of Company) in arrears. Interest will be computed on
the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months.

     Optional Redemption. The Company Exchange Debentures will not be redeemable
at the option of Company prior to April 15, 2003. Thereafter, the Company
Exchange Debentures will be redeemable, at the Company's option, in whole or in
part at any time or from time to time, upon not less than 30 no more than 60
days' prior notice at the redemption prices set forth in the Company Exchange
Indenture plus accrued interest to the redemption date (subject to the right of
holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the
relevant interest payment date). In addition, at any time prior to April 15,
2001, the Company may redeem, at its option, (i) up to 50% or (ii) all but not
less than all of the outstanding Company Exchange Debentures with the proceeds
of any public equity offering of common stock of the Company at a redemption
price (expressed as a percentage of principal amount) of 111 1/2% plus accrued
interest to the redemption date (subject to the right of holders of record on
the relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest
payment date). Any such redemption shall be made upon consummation of such
public equity offering upon not less than 30 nor more than 60 days' notice.

     Subordination. The Company Exchange Debentures will be subordinated,
unsecured obligations of the Company. The payment of the principal of, and
premium, if any, and interest on, the Company Exchange Debentures will be
subordinated in right of payment to the payment when due of all Senior Debt
(including senior subordinated indebtedness) of the Company. The Company
Exchange Debentures will rank pari passu in right of payment with any future
subordinated obligations of the Company. The Company Exchange Debentures will be
effectively subordinated to creditors (including trade creditors) and preferred
stockholders, if any, of subsidiaries of the Company. Since a portion of the
operations of the Company are conducted through subsidiaries, the Company's
ability to service its debt, including the Company Exchange Debentures, is
partially dependent upon the earnings of any such Subsidiaries and the
distribution of those earnings to, or upon loans or other payments of funds by
those Subsidiaries to, the Company. The payment of dividends and the making of
loans and advances to the Company by such Subsidiaries are subject to statutory
restrictions.

     The Company may not pay principal of, or premium, if any, or interest on,
or defease, the Company Exchange Debentures and may not repurchase, redeem or
otherwise retire any Company Exchange Debentures (collectively, "pay the Company
Exchange Debentures"), if (a) any principal, premium or interest in respect of
any Senior Debt (as defined), including the New Credit Facility and the Notes
and Exchange Notes, is not paid within any applicable grace period (including at
maturity) or (b) any other default on Senior Debt occurs and the maturity of
such Senior Debt is accelerated in accordance with its terms unless, in either
case, (i) the default has been cured or waived and any such acceleration has
been rescinded or (ii) such Senior Debt has been paid in full in cash; provided,
however, that the Company may pay the Company Exchange Debentures without regard
to the foregoing

                                       92
<PAGE>
 
if the Company and the Trustee receive written notice approving such payment
from the Representative of each issue of Designated Senior Debt (as defined).
During the continuance of any default (other than a default described in clause
(a) or (b) of the preceding sentence) with respect to any Designated Senior Debt
pursuant to which the maturity thereof may be accelerated immediately without
further notice or the expiration of any applicable grace period, the Company may
not pay the Company Exchange Debentures for a period (a "Payment Blockage
Period") commencing upon the receipt by the Company and the Exchange Trustee of
written notice of such default from the Representative of the holders of such
Designated Senior Debt specifying an election to effect a Payment Blockage
Period and ending 179 days thereafter.

     Upon any payment or distribution of the assets of the Company upon a total
or partial liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company or in a
bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, receivership or similar proceeding
relating to the Company or its property, the holders of Senior Debt, including
the New Credit Facility and the Notes or Exchange Notes, will be entitled to
receive payment in full in cash before the holders of the Company Exchange
Debentures are entitled to receive any payment of principal of or interest on
the Company Exchange Debentures, except that holders of Company Exchange
Debentures may receive and retain shares of stock and any debt securities that
are subordinated to Senior Debt to at least the same extent as the Company
Exchange Debentures.

     Repurchase at the Option of the Holders Upon a Change of Control. Upon the
occurrence of certain events constituting a change of control of the Company,
each holder of Company Exchange Debentures shall have the right to require the
Company to repurchase all or any part of such holder's Company Exchange
Debentures at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof,
plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon, if any, to the purchase date (subject
to the right of holders of record on the relevant record date to receive
interest due on the relevant interest payment date). The New Credit Facility
prohibits, and the indenture governing the Notes and Exchange Notes limits, the
ability of the Company to repurchase the Company Exchange Debentures.

     Certain Covenants. The Company Exchange Indenture contains covenants
restricting the ability of the Company and certain of the Company's subsidiaries
to, among others, (i) incur additional debt, (ii) make certain restricted
payments and investments, (iii) create certain liens, (iv) issue or sell capital
stock of restricted subsidiaries, (v) make certain asset sales, (vi) restrict
distributions from restricted subsidiaries, (vii) enter into transactions with
affiliates, and (viii) engage in certain consolidations, mergers and transfers
of assets. All of these restrictions will be subject to a number of important
qualifications.

     Events of Default. Events of Default in respect of the Company Exchange
Debentures as set forth in the Company Exchange Indenture include: (i) failure
to make the payment of any interest on the Company Exchange Debentures when the
same becomes due and payable, and such failure continues for a period of 30
days, (ii) failure to make the payment of any principal of, or premium, if any,
on, any of the Company Exchange Debentures when the same becomes due and payable
at its stated maturity, upon acceleration, redemption, optional redemption,
required repurchase or otherwise, (iii) failure to comply with any other
covenant or agreement in the Company Exchange Debentures or in the Company
Exchange Indenture, subject in certain cases, to applicable grace periods, (iv)
cross-acceleration to any debt of the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary (as
defined) in an aggregate amount greater than $7.5 million, (v) entering of any
judgment or judgments for the payment of money in an aggregate amount in excess
of $7.5 million against the Company or any Restricted Subsidiary, and (vi)
certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or reorganization of the Company
or any Significant Subsidiary (as defined).

          The preceding discussion of certain provisions of the Company Exchange
Debentures is not intended to be exhaustive and is qualified in its entirety by
reference to the provisions of the Company Exchange Indenture, copies of which
are available upon request from the Company.

                                       93
<PAGE>
 
                MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES     
    
     Riordon & McKinzie, a Professional Law Corporation, has rendered its 
opinion to the Company that the following general discussion accurately 
summarizes the material U.S. federal income tax aspects of the exchange of
Exchange Notes for Notes in the Exchange Offer and the ownership and disposition
of the Exchange Notes received in exchange therefor. This discussion is a
summary for general information only and does not consider all aspects of U.S.
federal income taxation that may be relevant to the acquisition, ownership and
disposition of the Exchange Notes by a holder in light of such holder's
individual circumstances. This discussion also does not address the U.S. federal
income tax consequences of ownership of the Notes and, the Exchange Notes
received in exchange therefor, not held as capital assets within the meaning of
Section 1221 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"),
or the U.S. federal income tax consequences to holders subject to special
treatment under the U.S. federal income tax laws, such as dealers in securities
or foreign currency, tax-exempt entities, financial institutions, insurance
companies, persons that hold the Exchange Notes as part of a "straddle," a
"hedge" or a "conversion transaction," persons that have a "functional currency"
other than the U.S. dollar, and investors in pass-through entities. In addition,
this discussion does not describe any tax consequences arising under U.S.
federal gift and estate taxes (except to the limited extent set forth below
under "Non-U.S. Holders") or under the tax laws of any state, local or foreign
jurisdiction.     
    
     This discussion is based upon the Code, existing regulations thereunder,
and current administrative rulings and court decisions. All of the foregoing is
subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis, and any such change could
affect the continuing validity of this discussion.     
    
     Persons considering the exchange of Notes for Exchange Notes should consult
their own tax advisors concerning the application of federal income tax laws, as
well as the laws of any state, local or foreign taxing jurisdiction, to their
particular situations.     
                                     
                                 U.S. Holders     
    
     The following discussion is limited to the U.S. federal income tax
consequences relevant to a holder of an Exchange Note that is (i) a citizen or
resident (as defined in Section 7701(b)(1) of the Code) of the United States,
(ii) a corporation or other entity taxable as a corporation organized under the
laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof or therein, (iii)
an estate, the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless
of the source, (iv) a trust, with respect to which a court within the United
States is able to exercise primary supervision over its administration and one
or more United States persons have the authority to control all its substantial
decisions or (v) a person whose worldwide income or gain is subject to U.S.
federal income tax on a net income basis (a "U.S. Holder"). Certain U.S.
federal income tax consequences relevant to a holder other than a
U.S. Holder are discussed separately below.     

                                       94
<PAGE>
 
     
Exchange Offer     
    
     The exchange of a Note for an Exchange Note pursuant to the Exchange Offer
will not constitute a recognition event for federal income tax purposes.
Consequently, no gain or loss will be recognized by a holder on the exchange.
Immediately after the exchange, the holding period of the Exchange Notes will
include the holding period of the Notes exchanged therefor, and the adjusted tax
basis of the Exchange Notes will be the same as the adjusted tax basis of the
Notes exchanged therefor immediately before the exchange.
    
     Upon failure to comply with certain of its obligations under the
Registration Rights Agreement, the Company would be required to pay special
interest on the Notes. Although the matter is not free from doubt, if special
interest becomes payable on the Notes, such special interest should be treated
in the same manner as stated interest on the Notes.     
    
Stated Interest     
    
     Interest on an Exchange Note will be taxable to a U.S. Holder as ordinary
interest income at the time it accrues or is received in accordance with such
Holder's method of accounting for U.S. federal income tax purposes.     
    
Market Discount     
    
     U.S. Holders who exchange Notes for Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange
Offer will be taxable on "market discount," if any, in accordance with such
holder's treatment of "market discount" in connection with the Notes exchanged
therefor. For this purpose, "market discount" is the excess, if any, of the
stated redemption price at maturity over the purchase price of the Notes,
subject to a statutory de minimis exception.    
    
Bond Premium     
    
     U.S. Holders who exchange Notes for Exchange Notes pursuant to the Exchange
Offer will amortize "bond premium," if any, in accordance with such holder's
treatment of "bond premium" in connection with the Notes exchanged therefor. For
this purpose, "bond premium" is the excess of the adjusted tax basis of the Note
immediately after the purchase over the sum of all amounts payable on the
instrument after the purchase date (other than qualified stated interest).    
    
Sale, Exchange or Redemption of the Exchange Notes     
    
     Upon the disposition of an Exchange Note by sale, exchange or redemption, a
U.S. Holder will generally recognize capital gain or loss equal to the
difference between (i) the amount realized on the disposition (other than
amounts attributable to accrued interest not yet taken into income) and (ii) the
U.S. Holder's adjusted tax basis in the Exchange Note. A U.S. Holder's adjusted
tax basis in an Exchange Note generally will equal the cost of the Exchange Note
to the U.S. Holder increased by amounts includable in income as market discount
(if the U.S. Holder elects to include market discount on a current basis) and
reduced by the amount of any payments, other than qualified stated interest
payments, received and any bond premium amortized by any U.S. Holder.     

                                       95
<PAGE>
 
     
Backup Withholding and Information Reporting     
    
     Under the Code, a U.S. Holder of an Exchange Note may be subject, under
certain circumstances, to information reporting and or backup withholding at a
31% rate with respect to cash payments in respect of interest on, or the gross
proceeds from disposition of, an Exchange Note thereof. This withholding
applies, only if a U.S. Holder (i) fails to furnish its social security or other
taxpayer identification number ("TIN") within a reasonable time after a request
therefor, (ii) furnishes an incorrect TIN, (iii) fails to report interest
properly, or (iv) fails, under certain circumstances to provide a certified
statement, signed under penalty of perjury, that the TIN provided is its correct
number and that it is not subject to backup withholding. Any amount withheld
from a payment to a U.S. Holder under the backup withholding rules is allowable
as a credit and (and may entitle such holder to a refund) against such Holder's
U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is
furnished to the IRS. Certain persons are exempt from backup withholding,
including corporations and certain financial institutions. Holders of Exchange
Notes should consult their tax advisors as to their qualification for exemption
from withholding and the procedure for obtaining such exemption.     
                                   
                               Non-U.S. Holders     
    
     The following discussion is limited to certain material U.S. federal income
and estate tax consequences relevant to a holder of an Exchange Note that is not
a U.S. Holder (a "Non-U.S. Holder"). This discussion does not deal with all
aspects of U.S. federal income and estate taxation that may be relevant to the
purchase, ownership or disposition of the Exchange Notes by any particular
Non-U.S. Holder in light of such Holder's personal circumstances.     
    
     For purposes of the following discussion, interest and gain on the sale,
exchange or other disposition of the Exchange Note will be considered "U.S.
trade or business income" if such income or gain is (i) effectively connected
with the conduct of a U.S. trade or business or (ii) in the case of a treaty
resident, attributable to a United States permanent establishment (or to a fixed
base) in the United States.     
    
Stated Interest     
    
     Generally, any interest paid to a Non-U.S. Holder of an Exchange Note
that is not U.S. trade or business income will not be subject to U.S. federal
income or withholding tax if the interest qualifies as "portfolio interest."
Interest on the Exchange Notes will qualify as portfolio interest if (i) the
Non-U.S. Holder does not actually or constructively own 10% or more of the total
voting power of all voting stock of the Company and is not a "controlled foreign
corporation" with respect to which the Company is a "related person" within the
meaning of the Code, and (ii) the Non-U.S. Holder, under penalties of perjury,
certifies that the Non-U.S. Holder is not a U.S. person and such certificate
provides the Non-U.S. Holder's name and address.     

                                       96
<PAGE>
 
     
     The gross amount of payments to a Non-U.S. Holder of interest that do not
qualify for the portfolio interest exemption and that are not U.S. trade or
business income will be subject to U.S. withholding tax at the rate of 30%,
unless a U.S. income tax treaty applies to reduce or eliminate withholding. U.S.
trade or business income will be taxed on a net basis at regular U.S. federal
income tax rates rather than the 30% or lower treaty rate, and, if such Non-U.S.
Holder is a foreign corporation, it may be subject to a branch profits tax equal
to 30% (or such lower rate as may be specified by law or applicable income tax
treaty) of its U.S. effectively connected earnings and profits that are actually
or deemed to have been repatriated. To claim the benefit of a tax treaty or to
claim exemption from withholding because the income is U.S. trade or business
income, the Non-U.S. Holder must provide a properly executed Form 1001 or 4224
(or such successor forms as the IRS designates), as applicable, prior to payment
of interest. These forms must be periodically updated. On October 6, 1997, the
Treasury Department issued final regulations relating to withholding,
information reporting and backup withholding that unify current certification
procedures and forms and clarify reliance standards (the "Final Regulations").
The Final Regulations generally will be effective with respect to payments made
after December 31, 1999. Under the Final Regulations, Form 1001 is replaced by
Form W-8. Also under the Final Regulations, a Non-U.S. Holder who is claiming
the benefits of a tax treaty or exemption from withholding from U.S. trade or
business income may be required to obtain a U.S. taxpayer identification number
and to provide certain documentary evidence issued by foreign governmental
authorities to prove residence in the foreign country. Certain special
procedures are provided in the Final Regulations for payments through qualified
intermediaries.     
    
Sale, Exchange or Redemption of Exchange Notes     
    
     Except as described below and subject to the discussion concerning backup
withholding, any gain realized by a Non-U.S. Holder on the sale, exchange or
redemption of an Exchange Note generally will not be subject to U.S. federal
income tax, unless (i) such gain is U.S. trade or business income, (ii) subject
to certain exceptions, the Non-U.S. Holder is an individual who holds the
Exchange Note as a capital asset and is present in the United States for 183
days or more in the taxable year of the disposition or (iii) the Non-U.S. Holder
is subject to tax pursuant to the provisions of the United States federal income
tax laws applicable to certain United States expatriates.     
    
Federal Estate Tax     
    
     Exchange Notes held (or treated as held) by an individual who is a Non-U.S.
Holder at the time of his or her death will not be subject to U.S. federal
estate tax, provided that the individual did not actually or constructively own
10% or more of the total voting power of all voting stock of the Company, and
income on the Exchange Notes was not U.S. trade or business income.     
    
Information Reporting and Backup Withholding     
    
     The Company must report annually to the IRS and to each Non-U.S. Holder any
interest that is subject to federal withholding tax, regardless of whether any
tax was actually withheld. Copies of these information returns may also be made
available under the provisions of a specific treaty or agreement to the tax
authorities of the country in which the Non-U.S. Holder resides.     

                                       97
<PAGE>
 
     
     The regulations provide that backup withholding and information reporting
generally will not apply to payments of principal or interest on the Exchange
Notes by the Company to a Non-U.S. Holder, if the holder certifies as to its 
non-U.S. status under penalties of perjury or otherwise establishes an
exemption, provided that neither the Company nor its paying agent has actual
knowledge that the holder is a U.S. Holder or that the conditions of any other
exemption are not, in fact, satisfied.     
    
     The payment of the proceeds from the disposition of Exchange Notes to or
through the U.S. office of any broker, U.S. or foreign, will be subject to
information reporting and possible backup withholding unless the Non-U.S. Holder
certifies as to its non-U.S. status under penalties of perjury or otherwise
establishes an exemption from such information reporting and backup withholding,
provided that the broker does not have actual knowledge that the holder is a
U.S. Holder or that the conditions of any other exemption are not, in fact,
satisfied.     
    
     The payment of proceeds from the disposition of Exchange Notes to or
through a non-U.S. office of a broker that is (i) a U.S. person, (ii) a
"controlled foreign corporation" for U.S. federal income tax purposes, (iii) a
foreign person 50% or more of whose gross income from all sources for the three-
year period ending with the close of its taxable year preceding the payment (or
for such part of the period that the broker has been in existence) is derived
from activities that are effectively connected with the conduct of a U.S. trade
or business) or (iv) after December 31, 1999, a foreign partnership if either
(A) more than 50% of the income or capital interest is owned by U.S. Holders or
(B) such partnership has certain connections to the United States, will be
subject to information reporting, unless the broker has documentary evidence in
its files that the Non-U.S. Holder is a non-U.S. person and the broker has no
actual knowledge to the contrary. Before January 1, 2000, the payment of the
proceeds from the disposition of Exchange Notes to or through a non-U.S. office
of a broker generally will not be subject to backup withholding. After December
31, 1999, such payment will be subject to backup withholding if information
reporting is required.     
    
     After December 31, 1999, payments through a non-U.S. intermediary
satisfying certain requirements will not be subject to either backup withholding
or information reporting. Holders should consult with their own tax advisors
regarding these rules.    
    
     Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the
backup withholding rules from a payment to a Non-U.S. Holder may be allowed as a
refund or a credit against such Non-U.S. Holder's U.S. federal income tax
liability, provided the required information is furnished to the IRS.     

                                       98
<PAGE>
 
                             PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

    
     Each broker-dealer that receives Exchange Notes for its own account
pursuant to the Exchange Offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a
prospectus in connection with any resale of such Exchange Notes.  This
Prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used
by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of Exchange Notes received in
exchange for Notes where such Notes were acquired as a result of market-making
activities or other trading activities and not acquired directly from the
Company.  The Company and Holding have agreed that for a period of 180 days 
after the Expiration Date they will make this Prospectus, as amended or
supplemented, available to any broker-dealer for use in connection with any such
resale. In addition, until November 24, 1998, all dealers effecting transactions
in the Exchange Notes may be required to deliver a prospectus.

     The Company will not receive any proceeds from any sale of Exchange Notes
by broker-dealers.  Exchange Notes received by broker-dealers for their own
account pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be sold from time to time in one or
more transactions in the over-the-counter market, in negotiated transactions,
through the writing of options on the Exchange Notes or a combination of such
methods of resale, at market prices prevailing at the time of resale, at prices
related to such prevailing market prices or negotiated prices.  Any such resale
may be made directly to purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may
receive compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from any such
broker-dealer and/or purchasers of any such Exchange Notes.  Any broker-dealer
that resells Exchange Notes that were received by it for its own account
pursuant to the Exchange Offer and any broker or dealer that participates in a
distribution of such Exchange Notes may be deemed to be an "underwriter" within
the meaning of the Securities Act, and any profit on any such resale of Exchange
Notes and any commissions or concessions received by any such persons may be
deemed to be underwriting compensation under the Securities Act.  The Letter of
Transmittal states that by acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering
a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an
"underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.

    
     For a period of 180 days after the Expiration Date, the Company or Holding
will promptly send additional copies of this Prospectus and any amendment or
supplement to this Prospectus to any broker-dealer that requests such documents
in the Letter of Transmittal. The Company and Holding have agreed to pay all
expenses incident to the Exchange Offer (including the expenses of one counsel
for the holders of the Notes) other than commissions or concessions of any
brokers or dealers and will indemnify the Holders of the Notes (including any
broker-dealers) against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the
Securities Act, in connection with the Exchange Offer. Insofar as
indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be
permitted to directors, officers and persons controlling the Registrant pursuant
to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that
in the opinion of the Commission such indemnification is against public policy
as expressed in the Securities Act and is therefore unenforceable. In the event
that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the
payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or
controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action,
suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person
in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless
in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling
precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether
such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the
Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
    

                                    EXPERTS

     The audited financial statements and schedules included in this
Registration Statement have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent
public accountants, as indicated in their reports with respect thereto, and are
included herein in reliance upon the authority of said firm in giving said
reports.

                                      99
<PAGE>
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS

     Certain legal matters with respect to the legality of the Exchange Notes
offered hereby will be passed upon for the Company by Riordan & McKinzie, a
Professional Corporation, Los Angeles, California.  Certain principals and
employees of Riordan & McKinzie are limited partners in a partnership which is a
limited partner of an FS&Co. investment fund that owns a majority of Holding's
(and indirectly the Company's) equity interests.

                                      100
<PAGE>
 
                   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
<TABLE>   
<CAPTION>
                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
<S>                                                                         <C>
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Report of Independent Public Accountants..................................   F-2
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997.   F-3
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 29,
 1995, December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997............................   F-4
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity for Years Ended December
 29, 1995 and December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997.....................   F-5
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for Years Ended December 29, 1995,
 December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997..................................   F-6
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements................................   F-7
Consolidated Balance Sheet as of June 26, 1998 (unaudited)................  F-14
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 27,
 1997 and June 26, 1998 (unaudited).......................................  F-15
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Six Months Ended June 27,
 1997 and June 26, 1998 (unaudited).......................................  F-16
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements................................  F-17
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Pro Forma Consolidated Statement of Operations for the Year Ended December
 26, 1997 and the Six Months Ended June 26, 1998..........................   P-1
Notes to the Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements..................   P-3
</TABLE>    
 
                                      F-1
<PAGE>
 
                   REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To the Board of Directors of
Hudson Respiratory Care Inc.:
 
  We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of HUDSON
RESPIRATORY CARE INC. (a California corporation) and subsidiaries as of
December 26, 1997 and December 27, 1996, and the related consolidated
statements of operations, stockholder's equity and cash flows for the years
ended December 26, 1997, December 27, 1996 , and December 29, 1995. These
financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on
our audits.
 
  We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.
 
  In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of Hudson Respiratory Care
Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 26, 1997 and December 27, 1996, and the
results of their operations and their cash flows for the years ended December
26, 1997, December 27, 1996 and December 29, 1995 in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.
 
                                          Arthur Andersen LLP
 
Orange County, California
February 27, 1998 (except with respect to the matter discussed in Note 11, as
 to which the date is April 7, 1998)
 
                                      F-2
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
                    DECEMBER 27, 1996 AND DECEMBER 26, 1997
                             (AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                            ASSETS                              1996     1997
                            ------                             -------  -------
<S>                                                            <C>      <C>
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and short-term investments............................  $ 1,420  $   470
  Accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts
   of $111 and $258 at December 27, 1996 and December 26,
   1997, respectively........................................   20,732   21,282
  Inventories................................................   14,017   16,613
  Other assets...............................................    1,247    1,151
                                                               -------  -------
   Total current assets......................................   37,416   39,516
                                                               -------  -------
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT, at cost:
  Land.......................................................    2,172    2,044
  Buildings..................................................   13,284   13,369
  Leasehold improvements.....................................    1,315    1,322
  Machinery and equipment....................................   54,751   61,316
  Furniture and fixtures.....................................    1,941    2,128
  Construction in progress...................................    5,457    1,592
                                                               -------  -------
                                                                78,920   81,771
  Less--Accumulated depreciation and amortization............   45,453   48,728
                                                               -------  -------
                                                                33,467   33,043
                                                               -------  -------
OTHER ASSETS:
  Intangible assets, net.....................................    5,640    4,436
  Other assets...............................................      387      559
                                                               -------  -------
                                                                 6,027    4,995
                                                               -------  -------
                                                               $76,910  $77,554
                                                               =======  =======
<CAPTION>
             LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY
             ------------------------------------
<S>                                                            <C>      <C>
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable to bank......................................  $ 4,000  $ 4,000
  Accounts payable...........................................    3,854    3,842
  Accrued liabilities........................................    5,374    5,244
  Management bonus...........................................      --    20,000
                                                               -------  -------
   Total current liabilities.................................   13,228   33,086
                                                               -------  -------
NOTES PAYABLE TO BANK, net of current portion................   24,146   16,250
                                                               -------  -------
ACCRUED EQUITY PARTICIPATION PLAN............................   19,664    5,703
                                                               -------  -------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 4)
STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY:
  Common stock, no par value:
  Authorized--15,000,000 shares
  Issued and outstanding--14,468,720 shares
   at December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997................    3,789    3,789
  Cumulative translation adjustment..........................     (197)    (345)
  Retained earnings..........................................   16,280   19,071
                                                               -------  -------
                                                                19,872   22,515
                                                               -------  -------
                                                               $76,910  $77,554
                                                               =======  =======
</TABLE>
 
   The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated balance
                                    sheets.
 
                                      F-3
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
 
 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 29, 1995, DECEMBER 27, 1996 AND DECEMBER 26, 1997
                             (AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       1995     1996     1997
                                                      -------  -------  -------
<S>                                                   <C>      <C>      <C>
NET SALES...........................................  $86,825  $93,842  $99,509
COST OF SALES.......................................   47,582   49,405   51,732
                                                      -------  -------  -------
Gross profit........................................   39,243   44,437   47,777
                                                      -------  -------  -------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
  Selling...........................................    8,283    8,961    9,643
  Distribution......................................    4,595    4,829    5,240
  General and administrative........................    9,769   11,277   11,456
  Research and development..........................    2,064    2,253    1,845
PROVISION FOR EQUITY PARTICIPATION PLAN AND BONUSES.   11,415    8,249    6,954
                                                      -------  -------  -------
Income from operations..............................    3,117    8,868   12,639
                                                      -------  -------  -------
OTHER INCOME AND (EXPENSES):
  Interest expense..................................   (2,424)  (2,177)  (1,834)
  Other, net........................................     (811)     463      638
                                                      -------  -------  -------
                                                      (3,235)   (1,714)  (1,196)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
Income (loss) before provision for income taxes.....     (118)   7,154   11,443
PROVISION FOR STATE INCOME TAXES....................      280       73      150
                                                      -------  -------  -------
Net income (loss)...................................  $  (398) $ 7,081  $11,293
                                                      =======  =======  =======
Pro forma net income (loss) assuming conversion to C
 corporation for income tax purposes (Note 5).......  $  (111) $ 4,292  $ 6,866
                                                      =======  =======  =======
</TABLE>
 
 
 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated statements.
 
                                      F-4
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY
 
 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 29, 1995, DECEMBER 27, 1996 AND DECEMBER 26, 1997
                         (DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                  COMMON STOCK
                                ----------------- CUMULATIVE
                                  NUMBER          TRANSLATION RETAINED
                                OF SHARES  AMOUNT ADJUSTMENT  EARNINGS   TOTAL
                                ---------- ------ ----------- --------  -------
<S>                             <C>        <C>    <C>         <C>       <C>
BALANCE, December 30, 1994..... 14,468,720 $3,789    $(204)   $21,684   $25,269
  Stockholder distributions....        --     --       --      (5,637)   (5,637)
  Foreign currency translation
   loss (Note 1)...............        --     --      (122)       --       (122)
  Net loss.....................        --     --       --        (398)     (398)
                                ---------- ------    -----    -------   -------
BALANCE, December 29, 1995..... 14,468,720  3,789     (326)    15,649    19,112
  Stockholder distributions....        --     --       --      (6,450)   (6,450)
  Foreign currency translation
   gain (Note 1)...............        --     --       129        --        129
  Net income...................        --     --       --       7,081     7,081
                                ---------- ------    -----    -------   -------
BALANCE, December 27, 1996..... 14,468,720  3,789     (197)    16,280    19,872
  Stockholder distributions....        --     --       --      (8,502)   (8,502)
  Foreign currency translation
   loss (Note 1)...............        --     --      (148)       --       (148)
  Net income...................        --     --       --      11,293    11,293
                                ---------- ------    -----    -------   -------
BALANCE, December 26, 1997..... 14,468,720 $3,789    $(345)   $19,071   $22,515
                                ========== ======    =====    =======   =======
</TABLE>
 
 
 
 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated statements.
 
                                      F-5
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 29, 1995, DECEMBER 27, 1996 AND DECEMBER 26, 1997
                             (AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                     1995      1996      1997
                                                   --------  --------  --------
<S>                                                <C>       <C>       <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income (loss)..............................  $   (398) $  7,081  $ 11,293
  Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to
   net cash provided by operating activities--
    Depreciation and amortization................     6,820     6,133     5,847
    Gain on disposal of equipment................       (20)     (872)     (618)
    Increase in accounts receivable..............    (2,430)   (3,503)     (550)
    (Increase) decrease in inventories...........     1,777    (1,223)   (2,596)
    (Increase) decrease in other current assets..         1      (311)       96
    Increase in other assets.....................       (23)     (152)     (100)
    Increase (decrease) in accounts payable......      (283)      564       (12)
    Increase (decrease) in accrued liabilities...      (920)      167      (130)
    Increase (decrease) in accrued equity
     participation plan..........................    11,415     8,249   (13,961)
    Increase in management bonus accrual.........       --        --     20,000
                                                   --------  --------  --------
      Net cash provided by operating activities..    15,939    16,133    19,269
                                                   --------  --------  --------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property, plant and equipment.....    (5,850)   (6,395)   (4,659)
  Proceeds from sale of property, plant and
   equipment.....................................        33     1,058     1,068
  Increase in notes receivable...................       (18)       (2)      (67)
  Increase in cash surrender value of life
   insurance.....................................        (5)       (5)       (5)
  Additions of intangible assets.................      (248)      (10)      (10)
  Purchase of Artema (Note 9)....................       --     (6,000)      --
                                                   --------  --------  --------
      Net cash used in investing activities......    (6,088)  (11,354)   (3,673)
                                                   --------  --------  --------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Repayment of notes payable to bank.............    (6,743)   (4,000)  (14,396)
  Borrowings on notes payable to bank............       500     6,782     6,500
  Stockholder distributions......................    (5,637)   (6,450)   (8,502)
                                                   --------  --------  --------
      Net cash used in financing activities......   (11,880)   (3,668)  (16,398)
                                                   --------  --------  --------
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash..........      (122)      129      (148)
                                                   --------  --------  --------
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND SHORT-TERM
 INVESTMENTS.....................................    (2,151)    1,240      (950)
CASH AND SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS, beginning of
 year............................................     2,331       180     1,420
                                                   --------  --------  --------
CASH AND SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS, end of year.....  $    180  $  1,420  $    470
                                                   ========  ========  ========
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the year for--
    Interest.....................................  $  2,441  $  1,688  $  1,969
                                                   ========  ========  ========
    Income taxes.................................  $    155  $     94  $    243
                                                   ========  ========  ========
</TABLE>
 
 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated statements.
 
                                      F-6
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
                               DECEMBER 26, 1997
 
1. COMPANY BACKGROUND
 
  Hudson Respiratory Care Inc. (Hudson or the Company), founded in 1945, is a
manufacturer and marketer of disposable medical products utilized in the
respiratory care and anesthesia segments of the domestic and international
health care markets. The Company's respiratory care and anesthesia product
lines include such products as oxygen masks, humidification systems,
nebulizers, cannulae and tubing. In the United States, the Company markets its
products to a variety of health care providers, including hospitals and
alternate site service providers such as outpatient surgery centers, long-term
care facilities, physician offices and home health care agencies.
Internationally, the Company sells its products to distributors that market to
hospitals and other health care providers. The Company's products are sold to
distributors and alternate site service providers throughout the United States
and internationally. The Company's operations are conducted from its primary
facility in Temecula, California, facilities in Arlington Heights and Elk
Grove, Illinois, and a facility in Ensenada, Mexico.
 
2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
 a. Principles of Consolidation
 
  The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Hudson and
subsidiaries, Industrias Hudson and Oxy Air LLC (Oxy). Hudson owns 79 percent
and 99 percent of Industrias Hudson and Oxy, respectively. Hudson's sole
stockholder owns the remaining 21 percent and 1 percent of Industrias Hudson
and Oxy, respectively. Accordingly, the accompanying financial statements have
been prepared on a consolidated basis assuming 100 percent ownership, since
all of the issued and outstanding common shares are owned either directly or
indirectly by the same stockholder. The minority interests in Industrias
Hudson and Oxy not owned by Hudson are not material to the consolidated
financial position or results of operations of the Company.
 
  All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated.
Hudson and subsidiaries are collectively referred to herein as the Company.
 
 b. Use of Estimates in the Financial Statements
 
  The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
 c. Revenue Recognition
 
  Revenue is recognized upon shipment of product and satisfaction of any other
performance requirements. The Company provides in the period that the related
revenue is recognized, allowances for returns and rebates based upon
historical experience and analysis of other factors.
 
 d. Cash and Short-Term Investments
 
  The Company's policy is to invest cash in excess of operating requirements
in income-producing short-term instruments. Short-term investments are stated
at cost plus accrued interest, which approximates market value. For purposes
of the consolidated statements of cash flows, the Company considers all highly
liquid debt instruments purchased with an original maturity of three months or
less to be cash equivalents.
 
 e. Inventories
 
  Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market. Effective January 1,
1996, the Company changed its method of pricing inventory from the last-in,
first-out (LIFO) method to the first-in, first-out (FIFO) method. In
 
                                      F-7
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
accordance with APB Opinion No. 20, the Company has restated all prior periods
to reflect the conversion to the FIFO method. The effect of the change was not
material to the balance sheet or statement of operations. The change in method
was made to improve comparability of the Company's financial statements and
report inventory balances that more closely reflect the inventory's current
cost.
 
  At December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997, inventories consisted of the
following (amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  1996    1997
                                                                 ------- -------
     <S>                                                         <C>     <C>
     Raw materials.............................................. $ 3,962 $ 4,802
     Work-in-process............................................   4,531   4,681
     Finished goods.............................................   5,524   7,130
                                                                 ------- -------
                                                                 $14,017 $16,613
                                                                 ======= =======
</TABLE>
 
  Work-in-process and finished goods include raw materials, labor and
overhead. Certain finished goods are purchased for resale and are not
manufactured.
 
 f. Depreciation and Amortization Methods
 
  Depreciation of property, plant and equipment is provided using both the
straight-line and declining-balance methods over the following estimated
useful lives:
 
<TABLE>
     <S>                                                            <C>
     Buildings.....................................................  31.5 years
     Leasehold improvements........................................  31.5 years
     Machinery and equipment....................................... 5 to 7 years
     Furniture and fixtures........................................   7 years
     Heaters.......................................................   5 years
</TABLE>
 
  Upon retirement or disposal of depreciable assets, the cost and related
accumulated depreciation are removed and the resulting gain or loss is
reflected in income from operations. Major renewals and betterments are
capitalized while maintenance costs and repairs are expensed in the year
incurred.
 
 g. Intangible Assets
 
  Amortization of intangible assets is provided using the straight-line method
over the applicable amortization period. The following is a summary of the
components of intangible assets as of fiscal 1996 and 1997 (amounts in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 AMORTIZATION
                                                    PERIOD      1996     1997
                                                -------------- -------  -------
     <S>                                        <C>            <C>      <C>
     Covenant not-to-compete...................  5 to 7 years  $ 6,525  $ 3,500
     Patents...................................    10 years      3,183    3,183
     Loan acquisition costs....................   Loan term        258      268
     Goodwill.................................. 15 to 20 years   1,920    1,920
     Other..................................... 5 to 20 years      233      133
                                                -------------- -------  -------
                                                                12,119    9,004
     Less--Accumulated amortization............                 (6,479)  (4,568)
                                                               -------  -------
                                                               $ 5,640  $ 4,436
                                                               =======  =======
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-8
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
 h. Foreign Currency Translation
 
  The Company follows the principles of Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards (SFAS) No. 52, "Foreign Currency Translation", using the local
currency as the functional currency of its operating subsidiaries.
Accordingly, all assets and liabilities outside the United States are
translated into U.S. dollars at the rate of exchange in effect at the balance
sheet date. Income and expense items are translated at the weighted average
exchange rate prevailing during the period. Since January 1, 1997, Mexico's
currency has been considered highly inflationary, and Industrias Hudson
continues to use the Mexican peso, not the U.S. dollar, as its functional
currency. This approach has an immaterial impact on the Company's financial
statements versus using the U.S. dollar as the functional currency of
Industrias Hudson.
 
 i. Fiscal Year-End
 
  The Company reports its operations on a 52-53 week fiscal year ending on the
Friday closest to December 31. The fiscal years ended December 29, 1995,
December 27, 1996, and December 26, 1997, were all comprised of 52 week years.
 
 j. Post-employment and Post-retirement Benefits
 
  The Company does not provide post-employment or post-retirement benefits to
employees. Accordingly, SFAS No. 112, "Employers' Accounting for Post-
employment Benefits", and SFAS No. 106, "Employers' Accounting for Post-
retirement Benefits", have no impact on the Company's financial statements.
 
 k. Long-Lived Assets
 
  The Company adopted SFAS No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-
Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed of", on January 1, 1996.
This standard requires that long-lived assets and certain identifiable
intangibles held and used by an entity be reviewed for impairment whenever
events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an
asset may not be recoverable. The adoption of this standard did not have a
material effect on the consolidated financial statements.
 
 l. New Accounting Pronouncements
 
  In June 1997, FASB issued SFAS No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income".
This Statement requires that all items that meet the definition of components
of comprehensive income be reported in a financial statement for the period in
which they are recognized. Components of comprehensive income include
revenues, expenses, gains, and losses that under generally accepted accounting
principles are included in comprehensive income but excluded from net income.
This Statement is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15,
1997. Management believes that adoption of this Statement will not have a
material effect on the Company's consolidated financial statements.
 
  In June 1997, FASB also issued SFAS No. 131, "Disclosures about Segments of
an Enterprise and Related Information". This Statement requires that a public
business enterprise report financial and descriptive information about its
reportable operating segments. Financial information is required to be
reported on the same basis that it is used internally for evaluating segment
performance and deciding how to allocate resources to segments. This Statement
is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 1997. Management
believes that the adoption of this Statement will not have a material effect
on the Company's consolidated financial statements.
 
 m. Reclassifications
 
  Certain reclassifications have been made in the 1995 and 1996 statements to
conform with the 1997 presentation.
 
                                      F-9
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
3. NOTES PAYABLE TO BANK
 
  The Company has a credit agreement with a bank which provides for borrowings
of up to approximately $37,250,000. Total borrowings as of fiscal 1995, 1996
and 1997 were approximately $25,364,000, $28,146,000 and, $20,250,000
respectively. This agreement consists of two separate facilities which are
summarized as follows:
 
    Revolving line of credit--maximum borrowings of $15,000,000 limited to 85
  percent of qualified accounts receivable and 50 percent of qualified
  inventories, maturing on March 31, 2000. The agreement provides for the
  issuance of letters of credit, not to exceed the maximum borrowings nor to
  expire later than the maturity date, to beneficiaries designated by the
  Company, limited to $2,000,000 and a one year term. Interest on outstanding
  borrowings is at the Company's option of the bank's base rate plus one-
  quarter of one percent (8.75 percent at December 26, 1997) or a eurodollar
  rate plus one and three-quarters percent (7.47 percent at December 26,
  1997). The agreement, as amended, also provides for a one-half of one
  percent per year facility fee on the difference of the maximum borrowings
  and the sum of the daily averages of the outstanding revolving credit loan
  and the issued and outstanding letters of credit during the period.
 
    Term loan--maximum borrowings of $22,250,000, maturing on March 31, 2000.
  The agreement, as amended, calls for quarterly principal payments of
  $1,000,000 with a final payment of $5,500,000 or the aggregate outstanding
  balance on March 31, 2000. Interest on the borrowings is at the bank's base
  rate plus one-half of one percent or a eurodollar rate plus two percent
  (7.72 percent at December 26, 1997).
 
  The agreement gives the bank a first security interest in all assets of the
Company. The agreement also requires the Company to maintain certain financial
ratios and financial covenants, as defined in the amendment, the most
restrictive of which prohibit additional indebtedness and limits payments to
the Company's stockholder, other than for income tax payments. As of December
26, 1997 the Company was in compliance with all covenants.
 
  As of December 26, 1997, future minimum principal payments on the
aforementioned debt, in accordance with the amended agreement, are as follows
(amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
     FISCAL YEAR
       ENDING
     -----------
       <S>                                                               <C>
       1998............................................................  $ 4,000
       1999............................................................    5,000
       2000............................................................   11,250
                                                                         -------
                                                                         $20,250
                                                                         =======
</TABLE>
 
4. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
  The Company leases certain facilities, automobiles and office equipment
under noncancellable leases, with the majority of the automobile leases having
a term of one year with annual renewal provisions. All of these leases have
been classified as operating leases. As of December 26, 1997, the Company had
future obligations under operating leases as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
     FISCAL YEAR
       ENDING
     -----------
       <S>                                                               <C>
        1998............................................................ $  941
        1999............................................................    921
        2000............................................................    335
                                                                         ------
                                                                         $2,197
                                                                         ======
</TABLE>
 
                                     F-10
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
  Rental expense for all leases classified as operating leases was
approximately $1,065,000, $1,106,000 and $1,132,000 in fiscal 1995, 1996 and
1997, respectively.
 
  The Company self-insures the majority of its medical benefit programs.
Reserves for losses are established currently based upon estimated
obligations. The Company maintains excess coverage on an aggregate claim
basis.
 
  The Company is party to lawsuits and other proceedings, including suits
relating to product liability and patent infringement. While the results of
such lawsuits and other proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty,
management does not expect that the ultimate liabilities, if any, will have a
material adverse effect on the financial position or results of operations of
the Company.
 
5. INCOME TAXES
 
  Effective November 1, 1987, the stockholder of Hudson elected S corporation
status under the Internal Revenue Code, such that income of the Company is
taxed directly to the stockholder for both federal and state income tax
purposes. Hudson and Industrias Hudson will file separate federal income tax
returns for 1997.
 
  Under the S corporation election, the stockholder of Hudson includes her
share of Hudson's taxable income on her individual federal and state income
tax returns. Hudson's provision for income taxes and income taxes payable is
limited to the California S corporation tax of 2.5 percent for 1995, and 1.5
percent for both 1996 and 1997.
 
  The provision for state income taxes consists of the following (amounts in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                1995 1996   1997
                                                                ---- -----  ----
     <S>                                                        <C>  <C>    <C>
     Current................................................... $280 $ 200  $ 74
     Deferred..................................................  --   (127)   76
                                                                ---- -----  ----
                                                                $280 $  73  $150
                                                                ==== =====  ====
</TABLE>
 
  As of December 26, 1997, the Company has recorded a net deferred tax asset
of $76,000 primarily related to its Equity Participation Plan (see Note 7),
which in management's opinion is more likely than not to be realized.
 
  The Company will become a C corporation upon consummation of the transaction
discussed in Note 10. Accordingly, the Company has presented pro forma net
income (loss) amounts to reflect a provision for income taxes at a combined
effective rate of approximately 40%, after consideration of permanent
differences between financial reporting and income tax amounts. The pro forma
amounts presented do not include the one-time effect of conversion to C
corporation status which will be reflected in the 1998 financial statements.
 
6. RELATED-PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
  Amounts included in the consolidated financial statements with respect to
transactions with companies controlled by officers, the stockholder or members
of their immediate families are as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               1995  1996  1997
                                                              ------ ---- ------
     <S>                                                      <C>    <C>  <C>
     Purchases............................................... $1,524 $557 $1,465
                                                              ====== ==== ======
     Notes receivable........................................ $   88 $ 91 $  157
                                                              ====== ==== ======
</TABLE>
 
                                     F-11
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
7. DEFERRED COMPENSATION AND BENEFIT PLANS
 
 a. Pension Plan
 
  The Company has a defined-contribution pension plan covering substantially
all its employees. Amounts charged to expense relating to this plan totaled
approximately $810,000, $767,000 and $836,000 for the fiscal years ended 1995,
1996 and 1997, respectively.
 
 b. Deferred Compensation
 
  Effective December 1, 1994, the Company established a deferred compensation
plan for certain key employees. As of December 27, 1996 and December 26, 1997
no material amount of compensation has been deferred.
 
 c. Equity Participation Plan
 
  Effective January 1, 1994, the Company's Board of Directors adopted the
Equity Participation Plan, as amended (the Plan). This Plan provides certain
key employees and independent contractors deferred compensation based upon the
Company's value, as defined in the agreement. Benefits earned by participants
are based upon a formula with a specified minimum benefit accruing each year
for each participant. Benefits are accrued and charged to compensation in the
year earned. Payments are subject to an installment period of five years with
an annual maximum limit of $1,000,000. As of fiscal year ended 1995, 1996 and
1997 the Company has recorded $11,415,000, $19,664,000 and $5,703,000,
respectively, related to accrued amounts earned by the Plan participants.
 
  In fiscal 1997, the Company declared bonuses totaling $20 million which will
result in a corresponding decrease in amounts payable under the Plan. The
effect of the bonuses is to accelerate the timing of payments to the
participants. This management bonus accrual is included in current liabilities
on the accompanying balance sheet.
 
8. MAJOR CUSTOMERS AND SALES BY GEOGRAPHIC REGION
 
  The Company sells respiratory care products to distributors and medical
facilities throughout the United States and internationally. During 1995, 1996
and 1997, the Company had foreign sales of approximately $12,843,000,
$16,077,000 and $19,008,000, respectively, which constituted approximately 15
percent, 17 percent and 19 percent of total sales, respectively. The Company's
percentage of sales by geographic region for the fiscal years ended 1995, 1996
and 1997 were as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           1995   1996   1997
                                                           -----  -----  -----
     <S>                                                   <C>    <C>    <C>
     Domestic.............................................  85.2%  82.8%  80.9%
     Europe...............................................   5.6    6.6    7.5
     Pacific Rim (Japan, Southeast Asia, Australia/New
      Zealand)............................................   4.6    5.7    5.7
     Canada...............................................   2.3    1.9    1.8
     Other international..................................   2.3    3.0    4.1
                                                           -----  -----  -----
       Total.............................................. 100.0% 100.0% 100.0%
                                                           =====  =====  =====
</TABLE>
 
  For the fiscal years ended 1995, 1996 and 1997, the Company had sales of 31
percent, 32 percent and 30 percent, respectively, to one distributor.
 
                                     F-12
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
9. ACQUISITION
 
  During 1996, the Company acquired substantially all the assets of the Artema
Medical AB corporation ("Artema") for a purchase price of $6,000,000. Artema
engaged primarily in the business of manufacturing, marketing, and selling
hygroscopic condenser humidifiers. The acquisition was accounted for as a
purchase and the purchase price was allocated as follows (amounts in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
     <S>                                                                 <C>
     Covenant not-to-compete............................................ $3,500
     Goodwill...........................................................  1,743
     Machinery and equipment............................................    757
                                                                         ------
                                                                         $6,000
                                                                         ======
</TABLE>
 
10. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS (UNAUDITED)
 
  In February 1998, the Company announced the intent to sell a majority of the
Company pursuant to an agreement and plan of merger (the Recapitalization).
 
  Key components of the Recapitalization include:
  (1) common and preferred equity investments in consideration for an 80.8%
  ownership in the Company's common stock and 100.0% ownership in the
  Company's preferred stock with an initial liquidation preference of $30.0
  million
  (2) issuance of senior subordinated notes
  (3) execution of a new term loan facility and revolving loan facility
  (4) repayment of existing indebtedness
  (5) payment of amounts due under the Equity Participation Plan
  (6) payment for common shares acquired from the existing shareholder; this
  shareholder will retain a 19.2% interest in the common shares outstanding.
  (7) Potential contingent payments based on 1998 performance, payable to the
  Continuing Shareholder and former participants in the Equity Participation
  Plan.
 
  The Company will also terminate the Equity Participation Plan and adopt a
stock option plan and a stock purchase plan. Additionally, Hudson's sole
shareholder, who owns the remaining 21 percent of Industrias Hudson, will
transfer this interest to the Company in consideration of one dollar.
 
11. SUBSEQUENT EVENT--STOCK SPLIT
 
  The Company effected a 245:1 stock split concurrent with the
Recapitalization. The stock split has been reflected in the stock amounts
shown herein.
 
                                     F-13
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                           CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                  
                               JUNE 26, 1998     
                          
                       (DOLLAR AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)     
 
<TABLE>   
<S>                                                                    <C>
                               ASSETS
                               ------
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and short-term investments....................................  $  5,667
  Accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $347..    16,957
  Inventories........................................................    15,125
  Other assets.......................................................       880
                                                                       --------
   Total current assets..............................................    38,629
                                                                       --------
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT, at cost:
  Land...............................................................     2,044
  Buildings..........................................................    13,369
  Leasehold improvements.............................................     1,322
  Machinery and equipment............................................    60,922
  Furniture and fixtures.............................................     2,223
  Construction in progress...........................................     1,620
                                                                       --------
                                                                         81,500
  Less--Accumulated depreciation and amortization....................    49,583
                                                                       --------
                                                                         31,917
                                                                       --------
OTHER ASSETS:
  Deferred tax asset.................................................    78,526
  Deferred financing costs, net......................................    11,436
  Intangible assets, net.............................................     4,186
  Other assets.......................................................       338
                                                                       --------
                                                                         94,486
                                                                       --------
                                                                       $165,032
                                                                       ========
           LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT)
           ----------------------------------------------
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Notes payable to bank..............................................  $  1,000
  Accounts payable...................................................     4,401
  Accrued liabilities................................................     9,719
  Management bonus...................................................       --
                                                                       --------
   Total current liabilities.........................................    15,120
                                                                       --------
SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES PAYABLE....................................   115,000
                                                                       --------
NOTES PAYABLE TO BANK, net of current portion........................    37,000
                                                                       --------
ACCRUED EQUITY PARTICIPATION PLAN COSTS..............................       --
                                                                       --------
   Total liabilities.................................................   167,120
                                                                       --------
MANDATORILY REDEEMABLE PREFERRED STOCK, $.01 par value: Authorized--
 600,000 shares; issued and outstanding--300,000 shares; liquidation 
 preference: $100 per share..........................................    29,000
                                                                       -------- 
Accrued preferred stock dividend, payable-in-kind....................       776
                                                                       --------
                                                                         29,776
                                                                       --------
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT):
  Common stock, $.01 par value:
   Authorized--15,000,000 shares, issued and outstanding--7,800,000
    shares...........................................................    63,410
  Cumulative translation adjustment..................................      (464)
  Retained deficit...................................................   (94,810)
                                                                       --------
                                                                        (31,864)
                                                                       --------
                                                                       $165,032
                                                                       ========
</TABLE>    
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of this consolidated balance sheet.
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>
 
                  
               HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES     
                      
                   CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS     
                             
                          (AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)     
 
<TABLE>   
<CAPTION>
                                                              SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                              ----------------
                                                                        JUNE
                                                              JUNE 26,   27,
                                                                1998    1997
                                                              -------- -------
                                                                 (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                            <C>      <C>
NET SALES..................................................... $46,697  $49,093
COST OF SALES.................................................  25,142   25,388
                                                               -------  -------
Gross profit..................................................  21,555   23,705
                                                               -------  -------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
  Selling.....................................................   4,691    4,789
  Distribution................................................   2,698    2,547
  General and administrative..................................   5,676    5,498
  Research and development....................................     940      895
</TABLE>    
 
<TABLE>   
<S>                                                            <C>       <C>
PROVISION FOR EQUITY PARTICIPATION PLAN .....................    63,939   3,654
PROVISION FOR RETENTION PAYMENTS.............................     4,754     --
                                                               --------  ------
Income (loss) from operations................................   (61,143)  6,322
                                                               --------  ------
OTHER INCOME AND (EXPENSES):
  Interest expense...........................................    (3,640)   (950)
  Other, net.................................................      (254)    645
                                                               --------  ------
                                                                 (3,894)   (305)
                                                               --------  ------
Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes....   (65,037)  6,017
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME TAXES (Note 5)................   (76,978)    260
                                                               --------  ------
Income before extraordinary items............................    11,941   5,757
EXTRAORDINARY ITEM--loss on extinguishment of debt (Note 7)..       104     --
                                                               --------  ------
Net income...................................................    11,837   5,757
Preferred stock dividends....................................       776     --
                                                               --------  ------
Net income available to common shareholders..................  $ 11,061  $5,757
                                                               ========  ======
Pro forma net income (loss) assuming C corporation status for
 income tax purposes (Note 5)................................  $(39,556) $3,610
                                                               ========  ======
</TABLE>    
    
 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated statements.
    
                                      F-15
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                             (AMOUNTS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                            SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                           -------------------
                                                           JUNE 26,   JUNE 27,
                                                             1998       1997
                                                           ---------  --------
                                                              (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                        <C>        <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income.............................................. $  11,837  $  5,937
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided
   by (used in) operating activities--
    Depreciation and amortization.........................     2,992     2,901
    Writeoff of deferred financing fees...................       104       --
    Gain on disposal of equipment.........................       (54)     (630)
    Deferred tax asset benefit............................   (78,450)      --
    Provision for equity participation plan (EPP).........    63,939     3,654
    (Increase) decrease in accounts receivable............     4,325     3,763
    (Increase) decrease in inventories....................     1,488    (1,571)
    Decrease in other current assets......................       195        61
    (Increase) decrease in other assets...................       221      (192)
    Increase (decrease) in accounts payable...............       559      (787)
    Increase (decrease) in accrued liabilities............     4,475      (863)
    Payments of EPP liabilities...........................   (89,642)      --
                                                           ---------  --------
      Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities.   (78,011)   12,273
                                                           ---------  --------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property, plant and equipment..............    (1,646)   (2,049)
  Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment.....       --      1,060
  Increase in cash surrender value of life insurance......       --         (5)
                                                           ---------  --------
      Net cash used in investing activities...............    (1,646)     (994)
                                                           ---------  --------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Repayment of notes payable to bank......................   (43,250)   (6,602)
  Proceeds from borrowings on bank credit facility........    61,000       --
  Additions to deferred financing costs...................   (11,920)      --
  Redemption of stockholder interest......................  (128,321)      --
  Shareholder distributions...............................       --     (7,143)
  Proceeds from senior subordinated debt..................   115,000       --
  Sale of common and preferred stock, net of transaction
   costs..................................................    92,000       --
                                                           ---------  --------
      Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities.    84,509   (13,745)
                                                           ---------  --------
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash...................       345         7
                                                           ---------  --------
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND SHORT-TERM
 INVESTMENTS..............................................     5,197    (2,459)
CASH AND SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS, beginning of period......       470     1,419
                                                           ---------  --------
CASH AND SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS, end of quarter........... $   5,667  $ (1,040)
                                                           =========  ========
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
Cash paid during the quarter for:
  Interest................................................ $   1,399  $  1,053
                                                           =========  ========
  Income taxes............................................ $      66  $    117
                                                           =========  ========
</TABLE>
 
 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated statements.
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
                                 JUNE 26, 1998
                                  (UNAUDITED)
 
1. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
  The condensed consolidated financial statements included herein have been
prepared by the Company, without audit, and include all adjustments which are,
in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair presentation of the
financial position at June 26, 1998, the results of operations for the six-
month periods ended June 27, 1997 and June 26, 1998, and the cash flows for
the six-month periods ended June 27, 1997 and June 26, 1998 pursuant to the
rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). All
such adjustments are of a normal recurring nature. Certain information and
footnote disclosures normally included in financial statements prepared in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles have been condensed
or omitted pursuant to such rules and regulations. Although the Company
believes that the disclosures in such financial statements are adequate to
make the information presented not misleading, these consolidated financial
statements should be read in conjunction with the Company's 1997 audited
financial statements and the notes thereto included in its Form S-4 filed with
the SEC. The results of operations for the six-month periods ended June 27,
1997 and June 26, 1998 are not necessarily indicative of the results for a
full year.
 
2. RECAPITALIZATION
 
  In April 1998, the Company consummated a plan pursuant to which a majority
of the Company was sold in accordance with an agreement and plan of merger
(the Recapitalization).
 
  Key components of the Recapitalization include:
 
    (1) common and preferred equity investments in consideration for an 80.8%
  ownership in the Company's common stock and preferred stock with an initial
  liquidation preference of $30.0 million
 
    (2) issuance of 9 1/8% senior subordinated notes with a par value of
  $115.0 million, maturing in 2008 (see Note 8)
 
    (3) execution of a new term loan facility and revolving loan facility
  (see Note 8)
 
    (4) repayment of existing indebtedness (5) payment of amounts due under
  the Equity Participation Plan (see Note 6)
 
    (6) payment for common shares acquired from the existing shareholder;
  this shareholder retained a 19.2% interest in the common shares
  outstanding.
 
    (7) potential contingent payments based on 1998 performance, payable to
  the continuing shareholder and former participants in the Equity
  Participation Plan.
 
  The Company has terminated the Equity Participation Plan and has adopted a
stock purchase plan. The Company also plans to adopt a stock option plan.
Additionally, Hudson's sole shareholder, who owned the remaining 21 percent of
Industrias Hudson, transferred this interest to the Company in consideration
of one dollar. Because of the commonality of ownership, the 21 percent
minority interest has been included in the financial statements for all
periods presented.
 
  The Company effected a 245:1 stock split concurrent with the
Recapitalization. The stock split has been reflected in the stock amounts
shown herein.
 
  The Recapitalization resulted in no change to the carrying amounts of the
Company's assets and liabilities.
 
                                     F-17
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
3. INVENTORIES
 
  Inventories consisted of the following (amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          JUNE
                                                                           26,
                                                                          1998
                                                                         -------
       <S>                                                               <C>
       Raw materials.................................................... $ 3,602
       Work-in-process..................................................   3,819
       Finished goods...................................................   7,704
                                                                         -------
                                                                         $15,125
                                                                         =======
</TABLE>
 
4. COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
 
  In June 1997, FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS)
No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income". This Statement requires that all
items that meet the definition of components of comprehensive income be
reported in a financial statement for the period in which they are recognized.
This Statement is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 1997
and was adopted by the Company in the quarter ended March 27, 1998.
 
  The Company had comprehensive income for the six-month periods ended June
27, 1997 and June 26, 1998 as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                SIX MONTHS ENDED
                                                                -----------------
                                                                 JUNE
                                                                  26,    JUNE 27,
                                                                 1998      1997
                                                                -------  --------
     <S>                                                        <C>      <C>
     Net income................................................ $11,837   $5,757
     Other comprehensive income:
       Foreign currency translation gain (loss)................    (119)       7
                                                                -------   ------
     Comprehensive income...................................... $11,718   $5,764
                                                                =======   ======
</TABLE>
 
5. INCOME TAXES
 
  The Company became a C corporation upon consummation of the transaction
discussed in Note 2. Accordingly, the Company has presented pro forma net
income (loss) amounts to reflect a provision for income taxes at a combined
effective rate of approximately 40%, after consideration of permanent
differences between financial reporting and income tax amounts. The pro forma
amounts presented do not include the one-time effect of the conversion to C
corporation status reflected in the June 1998 financial statements.
 
  The actual provision for income taxes for the six-month period in 1998
reflect that the Company was a C corporation for a portion of the period
presented. The conversion from S corporation to C corporation resulted in a
one-time benefit of $78,526,000 in the six months ended June 26, 1998.
 
  The tax provision (benefit) for the six-month period ended June 26, 1998
consists of the following (amounts in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
     <S>                                                               <C>
     Income taxes at combined statutory rate of 40 percent...........  $(26,370)
     Effect of earnings during S corporation period and S corporation
      state income tax liability arising from Section 338(h)(10)
      election.......................................................    27,918
     Benefit of recordation of deferred tax asset upon conversion to
      C corporation status...........................................   (78,526)
                                                                       --------
                                                                       $(76,978)
                                                                       ========
</TABLE>
 
 
                                     F-18
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
6. EQUITY PARTICIPATION PLAN
 
  In March 1998, the Company paid previously-accrued bonuses totaling $20
million, plus related payroll taxes. These payments were funded by additional
borrowings under the existing credit facility. The provision for equity
participation plan costs on an interim basis is based upon the expected
provision for the year as a percentage of income before the provision for
Equity Participation Plan costs.
 
  In conjunction with the Recapitalization discussed in Note 2 the Company
paid additional amounts pursuant to the Equity Participation Plan. This plan
has now been terminated.
 
7. EXTRAORDINARY ITEM
 
  In accordance with the Recapitalization, the Company recorded an
extraordinary loss on the extinguishment of the existing debt related to the
write-off of unamortized deferred finance fees of $104,000.
 
8. LONG-TERM DEBT
 
 New Credit Facility
 
  In connection with the Recapitalization, the Company has entered into a new
credit agreement with a bank which provides for borrowings of up to
$100,000,000. This agreement consists of two separate facilities as follows:
 
    Revolving credit--maximum borrowings of $60,000,000 with a letter of
  credit sublimit of $7,500,000. This facility must be prepaid upon payment
  in full of the Term Loan facility.
 
    Term loan--maximum borrowings of $40,000,000, with quarterly installments
  to be made through maturity.
 
  Interest on the New Credit Facility is based, at the option of the Company,
upon either a eurodollar rate plus 2.25 percent, or a base rate plus 1.25
percent per annum. A commitment fee of 0.50 percent per annum will be charged
on the unused portion of the New Credit Facility.
 
  The agreement provides the bank a first security interest in substantially
all of the properties and assets of the Company and a pledge of 65% of the
stock of Industrias Hudson, the Company's principal subsidiary. The agreement
also requires the Company to maintain certain financial ratios and financial
covenants, as defined in the agreement, the most restrictive of which prohibit
additional indebtedness and limit dividend payments to the Company's
stockholders.
 
  Total borrowings as of June 26, 1998 were $38,000,000 under the Term Loan
Facility and bear interest at 7.875 percent per annum. The New Credit Facility
will mature on the sixth anniversary of the closing of the Recapitalization.
 
  As of June 26, 1998, the Company was not in compliance with certain
financial covenants of the New Credit Facility. The Company and lenders have
subsequently amended the applicable covenants.
 
 Senior Subordinated Notes
 
  Also related to the Recapitalization, the Company issued under an Indenture
$115,000,000 of senior subordinated notes (the Notes). The Notes are fully
transferable and are general unsecured obligations of the Company,
subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future senior debt, as
defined, of the Company.
 
                                     F-19
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
 
 
  Interest on the Notes bear interest at a rate equal to 9 1/8 percent per
annum from their date of issuance. Interest is payable semi-annually on April
15 and October 15 of each year, commencing October 15, 1998. The Notes will
mature on April 15, 2008 and will be redeemable at the option of the Company,
in whole or in part, on or after April 15, 2003.
 
 9. PREFERRED STOCK
 
  Upon consummation of the Recapitalization, the Company issued 300,000 shares
of Senior Exchangeable Payable-In-Kind (PIK) Preferred Stock subject to
mandatory redemption at a liquidation preference of $100 per share, plus
accumulated and unpaid dividends, if any, on April 15, 2010.
 
  Dividends on the preferred stock will accrue at the rate per share of 11 1/2
percent per annum. Amounts due will be payable in cash, except that on each
dividend payment date occurring on or prior to April 15, 2003, dividends may
be paid at the Company's option, by the issuance of additional shares of
preferred stock (including fractional shares). Dividends will be payable semi-
annually in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year commencing October
15, 1998. The preferred stock will rank junior in right of payment to all
obligations of the Company and its subsidiaries.
 
10. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT)
 
  Stockholders' equity (deficit) reflects the following (dollar amounts only
in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                             COMMON STOCK
                          --------------------  CUMULATIVE
                           NUMBER OF            TRANSLATION RETAINED
                            SHARES     AMOUNT   ADJUSTMENT  EARNINGS     TOTAL
                          -----------  -------  ----------- ---------  ---------
<S>                       <C>          <C>      <C>         <C>        <C>
BALANCE, December 26,
 1997...................   14,468,720  $ 3,789     $(345)   $  19,071  $  22,515
Foreign currency
 translation adjustment.          --       --       (119)         --        (119)
Stockholder redemption..  (12,968,720)  (3,379)      --      (124,942)  (128,321)
Recapitalization
 investment.............    6,300,000   63,000       --           --      63,000
Net income..............          --       --        --        11,061     11,061
                          -----------  -------     -----    ---------  ---------
BALANCE, June 26, 1998..    7,800,000  $63,410     $(464)   $ (94,810) $ (31,864)
                          ===========  =======     =====    =========  =========
</TABLE>
 
                                     F-20
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                         YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 26, 1997
                                (IN THOUSANDS)


    
<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 ADJUSTMENTS (NOTE 2)
                                                                        --------------------------------------
                                                                                                                    PRO
                                                             ACTUAL        RECAPITALIZATION         OTHER          FORMA
                                                           ----------   ---------------------     ---------     -----------

<S>                                                       <C>           <C>                       <C>            <C>
Net sales..............................................   $   99,509         $   --                 $    --      $   99,509
Cost of sales..........................................       51,732             --                      --          51,732
                                                          ----------        ----------              --------     ----------
      Gross profit.....................................       47,777             --                      --          47,777
Operating expenses:
  Selling expenses.....................................        9,643             --                      --           9,643
  Distribution expenses................................        5,240             --                      --           5,240
  General and administrative expenses..................       11,456             --                    (839)(c)      10,617
  Research and development expenses....................        1,845             --                      --           1,845

Provision for equity participation plan................        6,954           (6,954)(a)               --             --
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
      Operating income.................................       12,639            6,954                    839         20,432
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
Other (income) and expenses:                             
  Interest expense.....................................        1,834           13,265 (b)               --           15,099
  Other (income)/expense...............................         (638)            --                     --             (638)
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
      Total other (income) and expenses................        1,196           13,265                   --           14,461
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
      Income before provision for income taxes.........       11,443           (6,311)                  839           5,971
Provision for state income taxes.......................          150            1,903 (d)               336 (d)       2,389
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
  Net income (loss)....................................       11,293           (8,214)                  503           3,582
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
Preferred Stock Dividends..............................         --              3,549 (e)               --            3,549
                                                          ----------        ----------            ----------     ----------
  Net income available to common shareholders..........      $11,293         $(11,763)              $   503      $       33 
                                                          ==========        ==========            ==========     ==========
</TABLE>     
     

    The accompanying notes are an integral part of this financial statement.


                                      P-1
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

                 PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                            
                        SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 26, 1998     
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)


<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 ADJUSTMENTS (NOTE 2)
                                                                             ---------------------------                PRO
                                                              ACTUAL       RECAPITALIZATION         OTHER              FORMA
                                                           -----------   --------------------     --------            -------

<S>                                                           <C>            <C>                     <C>               <C>  
Net sales.................................................    $46,697        $     --                $  --              $46,697
Cost of sales.............................................     25,142              --                   --               25,142
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------   
    Gross profit..........................................     21,555              --                   --               21,555
Operating expenses:
  Selling expenses........................................      4,691              --                   --                4,691
  Distribution expenses...................................      2,698              --                   --                2,698
  General and administrative expenses.....................      5,676              --                 (172)(c)            5,504
  Research and development expenses.......................        940              --                   --                  940

Provision for equity participation plan...................     63,939         (63,939)(a)               --                   --
Provision for retention payments..........................      4,754          (4,754)(a)               --                   --
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
    Operating income......................................    (61,143)         68,693                  172                7,722
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
Other (income) and expenses:
  Interest expense........................................      3,640           3,910(b)                --                7,550
  Other (income)/expense..................................        254              --                   --                  254
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
     Total other (income) and expenses....................      3,894           3,910                   --                7,804
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
     Income (loss) before provision for income taxes......    (65,037)         64,783                  172                  (82)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes......................    (76,978)         76,876(d)                69(d)               (33)
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
Net income (loss) before extraordinary item...............     11,941              --                   --                  (49)
Extraordinary item-loss on extinguishment of debt.........       (104)            104                   --                   --
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
Net income (loss).........................................     11,837         (12,093)                 103                  (49)

Preferred Stock Dividends.................................        776             949(e)                 --                1,725
                                                              -------        --------                -----              -------     
  Net income (loss) available to common shareholders......    $11,061        $(13,042)               $ 103              $(1,774)
                                                              =======        ========                =====              =======
</TABLE>     

    The accompanying notes are an integral part of this financial statement. 

                                      P-2
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

              NOTES TO PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                    
                                 JUNE 26, 1998     


1.  TRANSACTION

  In connection with the completion of an offering to sell $115.0 million 9%
Senior Subordinated Notes due 2008 (the "Offering"), Hudson Respiratory Care
Inc. (the "Company") consummated a recapitalization pursuant to an Agreement and
Plan of Merger (the "Recapitalization").  Under the terms of the
Recapitalization, River Acquisition Corp., a wholly-owned subsidiary of River
Holding Corp. ("Holding"), merged with and into the Company, with the Company
surviving as a majority-owned subsidiary of Holding.

  Pursuant to the Recapitalization, Holding contributed approximately $93.0
million in equity capital into the Company (the "Holding Equity Investment") and
the current shareholder of the Company (the "Continuing Shareholder") retained
common stock of the Company.  The Holding Equity Investment is comprised of
$63.0 million of common equity and $30.0 million of preferred equity and,
following the Holding Equity Investment, Holding owns 80.8% of the outstanding
Common Stock of the Company and 100.0% of the outstanding Preferred Stock of the
Company and the Continuing Shareholder owns 19.2% of the outstanding Common
Stock. The common equity investment in Holding is comprised of a $55.0 million
investment by affiliates of Freeman Spogli & Co. Incorporated ("FS&Co.") and
$8.0 million by management of the Company. Upon consummation of the
Recapitalization, FS&Co. beneficially owns approximately 87.3% of the
outstanding common stock of Holding and management of the Company owns the
remaining 12.7%. Preferred stock of the Company provides for dividends payable
in cash commencing on the fifth anniversary of issuance and will be redeemable
at the option of the holders thereof upon the occurrence of certain events
constituting change in control of the Company. In addition, in connection with
the Recapitalization the Company has made payments to certain employees of $88.3
million under the Equity Participation Plan.

  The Company also entered into an agreement (the "New Credit Facility") that
provides a $40.0 million secured term loan facility (the "Term Loan Facility"),
which was funded in connection with the consummation of the Recapitalization,
and a $60.0 million revolving loan facility (the "Revolving Loan Facility")
which is available for the Company's future capital requirements and to finance
acquisitions.
    
  The Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Statements give effect to the Offering
and the Recapitalization as if these transactions occurred as of the beginning
of the period for purposes of the consolidated statements of operations. The Pro
Forma Consolidated Financial Statements do not give effect to any transactions
other than the Offering, the Recapitalization and those discussed in the
accompanying notes. The objective of this pro forma financial information is to
show what the significant effects on the historical financial information might
have been had the transaction occurred at an earlier date. However, the Pro
Forma Consolidated Financial Statements are not necessarily indicative of the
results of operations or related effects on financial position that would have
been attained had the above-mentioned transaction actually occurred 
earlier.     

  The Recapitalization also provides for additional payments of up to an
aggregate of $5.7 million payable to the Continuing Shareholder and participants
in the Equity Participation Plan upon achievement by the Company of certain
operating performance targets for fiscal 1998.  This amount will be recorded
when and if earned.  No recognition of the contingent payments is provided in
these pro forma financial statements.

  The historical Consolidated Financial Statements and accompanying notes,
included elsewhere in this Prospectus, should be read in conjunction with these
financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto.

                                      P-3
<PAGE>
 
                 HUDSON RESPIRATORY CARE INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

       NOTES TO PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)
                                    
                                 JUNE 26, 1998      

    
2.   PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS ASSUMPTIONS      

     The pro forma adjustments reflecting the transaction described in Note 1,
and the application of those adjustments to the historical amounts, were made
under the following assumptions:

        
(a)  These adjustments reflect the elimination of the Equity Participation 
     Plan since the Plan terminated upon the Recapitalization and the
     elimination of retention bonuses which were paid to employees of the
     Company in connection with the Recapitalization.     
(b)  The pro forma adjustments to interest expense and amortization of deferred
     financing fees reflect the following (amounts in thousands):

<TABLE>     
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              DECEMBER 26,        JUNE 26,
                                                                                                 1997               1998
                                                                                              -------------       ---------
          <S>                                                                                 <C>                 <C>
          Elimination of interest expense on existing debt...............................      $(1,834)            $(3,640)
          Interest expense on bank facility at an assumed composite interest rate of                             
               8.00%.....................................................................        3,200               1,600
          Interest expense on Senior Subordinated Notes at an assumed interest rate            
               of 9.125%.................................................................       10,494               5,247
          Amortization of deferred finance fees..........................................        1,405                 703
                                                                                               -------             -------
          Total..........................................................................      $13,265             $ 3,910
                                                                                               =======             =======
</TABLE>      

(c)  The pro forma adjustments to general and administrative expense reflect the
     following (amounts in thousands):
<TABLE>     
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              DECEMBER 26,         JUNE 26,
                                                                                                  1997               1998
                                                                                              -------------       ----------
          <S>                                                                                 <C>                 <C>
 
          Elimination of Continuing Shareholder salary, bonus and fringe                       
             benefits (1)................................................................      $(455)              $ (87)
          Elimination of expenses related to OxyAir (2)..................................       (384)                (85)
                                                                                               -----               -----
          Total..........................................................................      $(839)              $(172)
                                                                                               =====               =====
</TABLE>      
______________________
   (1)  The Company will not continue to pay Continuing Shareholder salary,
        bonus and related fringe benefits. The adjustment is to eliminate such
        expenses.
   (2)  Reflects the elimination of expense related to OxyAir since OxyAir will
        be transferred to the Continuing Shareholder.
        
        
(d)  Reflects the income tax effect of the net changes described above, using an
     effective rate of 40%.  Concurrent with the Recapitalization, the Company
     became a C corporation for income tax purposes.          
    
(e)  Reflects pay-in-kind preferred stock dividends at 11.50% due 
     semi-annually.     
    
3.   USE OF ESTIMATES IN THE PRO FORMA FINANCIAL STATEMENTS      

     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the
reporting period.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.


                                      P-4
<PAGE>
 
================================================================================
 
    
     NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATION OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATION MUST NOT
BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES
NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY THE
EXCHANGE NOTES BY ANYONE IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH THE PERSON MAKING THE
OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO OR TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM IT IS
UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS
PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE
HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY SINCE THE DATE HEREOF OR THAT
THE INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS CORRECT AS OF ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT TO THE
DATE HEREOF. UNTIL NOVEMBER 24, 1998 ALL DEALERS EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN THE
EXCHANGE NOTES, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE
REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS. THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF
DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO
THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.     

                               -----------------

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
<TABLE>    
<CAPTION>
                                          PAGE
                                          ----
<S>                                     <C>
Summary................................     1
Risk Factors...........................    11
Use of Proceeds........................    19
Capitalization.........................    20
The Exchange Offer.....................    21
Selected Historical and Pro Forma
 Consolidated Financial Information....    28
Management's Discussion and Analysis
  of Financial Condition and
 Results of Operations.................    31
Business...............................    39
Management.............................    48
Security Ownership of Certain
 Beneficial Owners.....................    52
Certain Transactions...................    52
Description of New Credit Facility.....    54
Description of the Exchange Notes......    56
Description of Other Securities........    87
Material U.S. Federal Income Tax
 Consequences..........................    94
Plan of Distribution...................    99
Experts................................    99
Legal Matters..........................   100
Index to Consolidated Financial
 Statements............................   F-1
Pro Forma Consolidated Financial
 Statements............................   P-1
</TABLE>     

================================================================================

================================================================================

                                  $115,000,000


                               Hudson Respiratory
                                   Care Inc.

                            9 1/8% Senior Subordinated
                                 Notes due 2008


                             Dated August 26, 1998

================================================================================



© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission